FORM 10-K
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON D.C.20549

 

 

FORM 10-K

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d)

OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011

Commission File Number: 001-32550

 

 

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

 

Nevada   88-0365922

(State or Other Jurisdiction of

Incorporation or Organization)

 

 

(I.R.S. Employer

I.D. Number)

One E. Washington Street Suite 1400, Phoenix, AZ   85004
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)   (Zip Code)

(602)-389-3500

(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OF THE ACT:

 

Title of Each Class

 

Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered

Common Stock, $0.0001 Par Value   New York Stock Exchange

SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(g) OF THE ACT:

None

 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities

Act.     Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the

Act     Yes  ¨     No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.     Yes  x     No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate website, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).     Yes  x     No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large accelerated filer   ¨    Accelerated filer   x
Non-accelerated filer   ¨    Smaller reporting company   ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).      Yes  ¨     No  x

The aggregate market value of the registrant’s voting stock held by non-affiliates was approximately $266.8 million based on the June 30, 2011 closing price of said stock on the New York Stock Exchange ($7.10 per share).

As of February 29, 2012, 83,132,092 shares of the registrant’s common stock were outstanding.

Portions of the registrant’s definitive proxy statement for its 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders are incorporated by reference into Part III of this report.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

INDEX

 

         Page  

PART I

  

Forward-Looking Statements

     3   

Item 1.

  Business      3   

Item 1A.

  Risk Factors      13   

Item 1B.

  Unresolved Staff Comments      24   

Item 2.

  Properties      24   

Item 3.

  Legal Proceedings      24   

Item 4.

  Mine Safety Disclosures      25   

PART II

  

Item 5.

 

Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

     26   

Item 6.

  Selected Financial Data      27   

Item 7.

  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations      29   

Item 7A.

  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk      71   

Item 8.

  Financial Statements and Supplementary Data      71   

Item 9.

  Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure      134   

Item 9A.

  Controls and Procedures      134   

Item 9B.

  Other Information      136   

PART III

  

Item 10.

  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance      136   

Item 11.

  Executive Compensation      136   

Item 12.

  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters      136   

Item 13.

  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence      136   

Item 14.

  Principal Accountant Fees and Services      136   

PART IV

  

Item 15.

  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules      137   

SIGNATURES

     141   

CERTIFICATIONS

     152   

 

2


Table of Contents

PART I

Forward-Looking Statements

Certain statements contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K (“Form 10K”) are “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. The Company intends such forward-looking statements be covered by the safe harbor provisions for forward-looking statements. All statements other than statements of historical fact are “forward-looking statements” for purposes of Federal and State securities laws, including statements that related to or are dependent on estimates or assumptions relating to expectations, beliefs, projections, future plans and strategies, anticipated events or trends and similar expressions concerning matters that are not historical facts.

The forward-looking statements contained in this Form 10K reflect our current views about future events and financial performance and involve certain risks, uncertainties, assumptions and changes in circumstances that may cause our actual results to differ significantly from historical results and those expressed in any forward-looking statement, including those risks discussed under the heading “Risk Factors” in this 2011 Form 10K. Risks and uncertainties include those set forth in our filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission and the following factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those presented: 1) dependency on real estate and events that negatively impact real estate; 2) high concentration of commercial real estate, construction and development and commercial and industrial loans; 3) actual credit losses may exceed expected losses in the loan portfolio; 4) possible need for a valuation allowance against deferred tax assets; 5) stock transactions could require revalue of deferred tax assets; 6) exposure of financial instruments to certain market risks may cause volatility in earnings; 7) dependence on low-cost deposits; 8) ability to borrow from Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) or Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”); 9) events that further impair goodwill; 10) increase in the cost of funding as the result of changes to our credit rating; 11) expansion strategies may not be successful; 12) our ability to control costs; 13) risk associated with changes in internal controls and processes; 14) our ability to compete in a highly competitive market; 15) our ability to recruit and retain qualified employees, especially seasoned relationship bankers; 16) the effects of terrorist attacks or threats of war; 17) risk of audit of U.S. federal tax deductions; 18) perpetration of internal fraud; 19) risk of operating in a highly regulated industry and our ability to remain in compliance; 20) the effects of interest rates and interest rate policy; 21) exposure to environmental liabilities related to the properties we acquire title; 22) recent legislative and regulatory changes including Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008, or EESA, the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009, or ARRA, and the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 and the rules and regulations that might be promulgated thereunder; 23) cyber security risks; and 24) risks related to ownership and price of our common stock.

For more information regarding risks that may cause our actual results to differ materially from any forward-looking statements, see “Risk Factors” beginning on page 13. Forward-looking statements speak only as of the date they are made, the Company does not undertake any obligations to update forward-looking statements to reflect circumstances and or events that occur after the date the forward-looking statements are made.

Purpose

The following discussion is designed to provide insight on the financial condition and results of operations of Western Alliance Bancorporation and its subsidiaries. Unless otherwise stated, “the Company” or “WAL” refers to this consolidated entity. This discussion should be read in conjunction with the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements and notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, herein referred to as “the Consolidated Financial Statements”. These Consolidated Financial Statements are presented beginning on page 71 of this Form 10-K.

 

ITEM 1. BUSINESS

Organization Structure and Description of Services

Western Alliance Bancorporation (“WAL” or “the Company”), is a multi-bank holding company headquartered in Phoenix, Arizona that provides full service banking and lending to locally owned businesses, professional firms, real estate developers and investors, local non-profit organizations, high net worth individuals and other consumers through its three wholly owned subsidiary banks (the “Banks”): Bank of Nevada (“BON”), operating in Southern Nevada, Western Alliance Bank (“WAB”), operating in Arizona and Northern Nevada, and Torrey Pines Bank (“TPB”), operating in California. On December 31, 2010, the Company merged its former Alta Alliance Bank (“AAB”) subsidiary into its Torrey Pines Bank subsidiary, and its former First Independent Bank of Nevada subsidiary into its Alliance Bank of Arizona subsidiary. As part of the latter merger, Alliance Bank of Arizona (“ABA”) was renamed Western Alliance Bank doing business as Alliance Bank of Arizona (in Arizona) and First Independent Bank (“FIB”) (in Nevada). In addition, the Company’s non-bank subsidiaries, Shine Investment Advisory Services, Inc. (“Shine”) and Western Alliance Equipment Finance (“WAEF”), offer an array of financial products and services aimed at satisfying the needs of small to mid-sized businesses and their proprietors, including financial planning, custody and investments, and equipment leasing nationwide. These entities are collectively referred to herein as the Company. The Company divested its wholly owned subsidiary Premier Trust, Inc. (“Premier Trust”) as of September 1, 2010.

 

3


Table of Contents

WAL also has six unconsolidated subsidiaries used as business trusts in connection with issuance of trust-preferred securities as described in Note 11, “Junior Subordinated and Subordinated Debt” beginning on page 114 of this Form 10-K.

Bank Subsidiaries

 

Bank

Name

   Headquarters    Year
Founded
   Number of
Locations
   Location Cities    Total
Assets
   Net
Loans
   Deposits
                              (in millions)     

BON (1)

   Las Vegas, Nevada    1994    11    Las Vegas, North Las
Vegas, Henderson, and
Mesquite
   $2,877.6    $1,798.1    $2,377.3

WAB (2)

   Phoenix, Arizona    2003    16    Phoenix, Tucson,
Scottsdale, Sedona, Mesa,
Flagstaff, Reno, Sparks,
Fallon, and Carson City
   $2,234.7    $1,623.2    $1,877.5

TPB (3)

   San Diego, CA    2003    12    San Diego, La Mesa,
Carlsbad, Los Angeles,
Oakland, Piedmont, Walnut
Creek and Los Altos
   $1,728.4    $1,302.4    $1,416.8

 

(1) BON commenced operations in 1994 as BankWest of Nevada (“BWN”). In 2006, BWN merged with Nevada First Bank and Bank of Nevada. As part of the mergers, BWN changed its name to BON. BON has three wholly-owned subsidiaries: BW Real Estate, Inc. which operates as a real estate investment trust and holds certain of BON’s real estate loans and related securities; BON Investments, Inc., which holds certain securities; and BW Nevada Holdings, LLC, which owns the Company’s 2700 West Sahara Avenue, Las Vegas, Nevada location.
(2) WAB commenced operations in 2003 as Alliance Bank of Arizona, and subsequently changed its name to WAB on December 31, 2010 as part of the merger between ABA and FIB. WAB has one wholly-owned subsidiary, WAB Investments, Inc., which holds certain securities.
(3) TPB commenced operations in 2003. On December 31, 2010, AAB merged into TPB. TPB has one wholly-owned subsidiary, TPB Investments, Inc., which holds certain securities.

Our subsidiary banks are state-chartered and are subject to primary regulation and examination by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) and, in addition, are regulated and examined by their respective state banking agencies.

Non-Bank Subsidiaries and Affiliates

The Company provides a full range of banking services, as well as investment advisory services, through its consolidated subsidiaries. Applicable accounting guidance provides for the identification of reportable segments on the basis of discreet business units and their financial information to the extent such units are reviewed by an entity’s chief operating decision maker.

WAL owns an 80 percent interest investment in Shine, a registered investment advisor purchased in July 2007.

WAL maintains a 24.9 percent interest in Miller/Russell & Associates, Inc. (“MRA”), an Arizona registered investment advisor. MRA provides investment advisory services to individuals, foundations, retirement plans and corporations.

Market Segments

The Company had four reportable operating segments at December 31, 2011 and 2010. The Company’s reporting segments were modified in the fourth quarter of 2010 to reflect the way the Company manages and assesses the performance of the business as a result of the strategic mergers and divestitures of subsidiaries. The Company previously reported the banking operations on a state-by-state basis but due to the bank mergers now reports based on bank entity and other.

The Company adjusted segment reporting composition during 2010 to more accurately reflect the way the Company manages and assesses the performance of the business. During 2010, the Company sold its wholly-owned trust subsidiary, discontinued a portion of its credit card services and merged from five bank subsidiaries to three.

The re-defined structure consists of the following four reportable operating segments: “Bank of Nevada”, “Western Alliance Bank”, “Torrey Pines Bank” and “Other” (Western Alliance Bancorporation holding company, Western Alliance Equipment Finance, Shine, Inc, Premier Trust until September 1, 2010 and the discontinued operations portion of the credit card services). All prior period balances were reclassified to reflect the change in structure.

 

4


Table of Contents

Management has determined the operating segments using a combination of factors primarily driven by legal entity. Management determined that the legal entities that contributed less than the quantitative thresholds for separate management reporting be combined into the Other segment.

The accounting policies of the reported segments are the same as those of the Company as described in Note 1, “Nature of Operation and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” beginning on page 81. Transactions between segments consisted primarily of borrowings, loan participations and shared services. All intercompany transactions are eliminated for reporting consolidated results of operations. Loan participations are recorded at par value with no resulting gain or loss. The Company allocated centrally-provided services to the operating segments based upon estimated usage of those services. Please refer to Note 19, “Segments” in our Consolidated Financial Statements for financial information regarding segment reporting beginning on page 130.

The bank operating segments derive a majority of their revenues from net interest income generated from quality loan growth offset by deposit costs. The Company’s chief executive officer relies primarily on the success of loan and deposit growth while maintaining net interest margin and net profits from these efforts to assess the performance of these segments. The other segment derives a majority of its revenue from fees based on assets under management and interest income from investments. The Company’s chief executive officer relies primarily on costs and strategic initiative needs when assessing the performance of and allocating resources to this segment.

Lending Activities

Through its banking segments, the Company provides a variety of financial services to customers, including commercial real estate loans, construction and land development loans, commercial loans, and consumer loans. The Company’s lending has focused primarily on meeting the needs of business customers. Loans to businesses comprised 89.2% and 85.9% of the total loan portfolio at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

Commercial Real Estate (“CRE”): Loans to finance the purchase or refinancing of CRE and loans to finance inventory and working capital that are additionally secured by CRE make up the majority of our loan portfolio. These CRE loans are secured by apartment buildings, professional offices, industrial facilities, retail centers and other commercial properties. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, 49.0% and 54.1% of our CRE loans were owner-occupied. Owner-occupied commercial real estate loans are loans secured by owner-occupied nonfarm nonresidential properties for which the primary source of repayment (more than 50%) is the cash flow from the ongoing operations and activities conducted by the borrower who owns the property. Non-owner-occupied commercial real estate loans are commercial real estate loans for which the primary source of repayment is nonaffiliated rental income associated with the collateral property.

Construction and Land Development: Construction and land development loans include multi-family apartment projects, industrial/warehouse properties, office buildings, retail centers and medical facilities. These loans are primarily originated to experienced local developers with whom the Company has a satisfactory lending history. An analysis of each construction project is performed as part of the underwriting process to determine whether the type of property, location, construction costs and contingency funds are appropriate and adequate. Loans to finance commercial raw land are primarily to borrowers who plan to initiate active development of the property within two years.

Commercial and Industrial: Commercial and industrial loans include working capital lines of credit, inventory and accounts receivable lines, mortgage warehouse lines, equipment loans and leases, and other commercial loans. Commercial loans are primarily originated to small and medium-sized businesses in a wide variety of industries. WAB is designated a “Preferred Lender” in Arizona with the Small Business Association (“SBA”) under its “Preferred Lender Program.”

Residential real estate: In 2010 the Company discontinued residential real estate loan origination as a primary business line.

Consumer: Consumer loans are offered to meet customer demand and to respond to community needs. Consumer loans are generally offered at a higher rate and shorter term than residential mortgages. Examples of our consumer loans include: home equity loans and lines of credit; home improvement loans; credit card loans; and personal lines of credit.

 

5


Table of Contents

As of December 31, 2011, our loan portfolio totaled $4.68 billion, or approximately 68.4% of our total assets. The following table sets forth the composition of our loan portfolio as of the periods presented.

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     Amount     Percent     Amount     Percent  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Commercial real estate-owner occupied

   $ 1,252,182        26.1   $ 1,223,150        28.8

Commercial real estate-non-owner occupied

     1,301,172        27.2     1,038,488        24.5

Commercial and industrial

     1,120,107        23.4     744,659        17.5

Residential real estate

     443,020        9.3     527,302        12.4

Construction and land development

     381,676        8.0     451,470        10.6

Commercial leases

     216,475        4.5     189,968        4.5

Consumer

     72,504        1.5     71,545        1.7
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total loans

     4,787,136        100.0     4,246,582        100.0
    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Net deferred fees

     (7,067       (6,040  
  

 

 

     

 

 

   

Total loans, net of deferred loan fees

   $ 4,780,069        $ 4,240,542     
  

 

 

     

 

 

   

For additional information concerning loans, refer to Note 4, “Loans, Leases and Allowance for Credit Losses” of the Consolidated Financial Statements or see the “Management Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Financial Condition—Loans” discussions.

General

The Company adheres to a specific set of credit standards across its bank subsidiaries that ensure the proper management of credit risk. Furthermore, our holding company’s management team plays an active role in monitoring compliance with such standards by our banks.

Loan originations are subject to a process that includes the credit evaluation of borrowers, utilizing established lending limits, analysis of collateral, and procedures for continual monitoring and identification of credit deterioration. Loan officers actively monitor their individual credit relationships in order to report suspected risks and potential downgrades as early as possible. The respective boards of directors of each of our banking subsidiaries approve their own loan policies, as well as loan limit authorizations. Except for variances to reflect unique aspects of state law and local market conditions, our lending policies generally incorporate consistent underwriting standards. The Company monitors all changes to each respective bank’s loan policy to ensure this consistency. Our credit culture has helped us to identify troubled credits early, allowing us to take corrective action when necessary.

Loan Approval Procedures and Authority

Our loan approval procedures are executed through a tiered loan limit authorization process, which is structured as follows:

 

   

Individual Authorities. The chief credit officer (“CCO”) of each subsidiary bank sets the authorization levels for individual loan officers on a case-by-case basis. Generally, the more experienced a loan officer, the higher the authorization level. The maximum approval authority for a loan officer is $2.0 million for real estate secured loans and $750,000 for other loans.

 

   

Management Loan Committees. Credits in excess of individual loan limits are submitted to the appropriate bank’s Management Loan Committee. The Management Loan Committees consist of members of the senior management team of that bank and are chaired by that bank’s chief credit officer. The Management Loan Committees have approval authority up to $7.0 million.

 

   

Credit Administration. Credits in excess of the affiliate banks’ Management Loan Committee authority are submitted by the bank subsidiary to Western Alliance Bancorporation’s Credit Committee (“WALCC”). WALCC has approval authority up to established house concentration limits, which range from $15.0 million to $35.0 million, depending on risk grade. WALCC approval is additionally required for new relationships of $12.5 million or greater to borrowers within market footprint, and $5.0 million outside market footprint. WALCC also reviews all affiliate loan approvals to any one borrower of $5.0 million or greater. WALCC is chaired by the Western Alliance Bancorporation Chief Credit Officer and includes the Company’s CEO and COO.

 

   

Board of Directors Oversight. The chief executive officer (“CEO”) of Western Alliance Bancorporation acting with the Chairman of the Board of Directors of Bank of Nevada has approval authority for any credit extension greater than $30.0 million at December 31, 2011.

 

6


Table of Contents

The Company’s credit administration department works independent of loan production.

Loans to One Borrower. In addition to the limits set forth above, subject to certain exceptions, state banking law generally limits the amount of funds that a bank may lend to a single borrower. Under Nevada law, the combination of investments in private securities and total amount of outstanding loans that a bank may make to a single borrower generally may not exceed 25% of stockholders’ tangible equity. Under Arizona law, the obligations of one borrower to a bank generally may not exceed 20% of the bank’s capital, plus an additional 10% of its capital if the additional amounts are fully secured by readily marketable collateral. Under California law, the unsecured obligations of any one borrower to a bank generally may not exceed 15% of the sum of the bank’s shareholders’ equity, allowance for credit losses, capital notes and debentures; and the secured and unsecured obligations of any one borrower to a bank generally may not exceed 25% of the sum of the bank’s shareholders’ equity, allowance for credit losses, capital notes and debentures.

Concentrations of Credit Risk. Our lending policies also establish customer and product concentration limits to control single customer and product exposures. Our lending policies have several different measures to limit concentration exposures. Set forth below are the primary segmentation limits and actual measures as of December 31, 2011:

 

     Percent of Total Capital     Percent of Total Loans  
     Policy Limit     Actual     Policy Limit     Actual  

Commercial Real Estate-Term (including owner-occupied)

     435     352     65     53

Commercial and Industrial

     225        185        30        28   

Construction /Land

     80        53        30        8   

Residential Real Estate

     75        61        65        9   

Consumer

     20        10        15        2   

Asset Quality

General

To measure asset quality, the Company has instituted a loan grading system consisting of nine different categories. The first five are considered “satisfactory.” The other four grades range from a “watch” category to a “loss” category and are consistent with the grading systems used by Federal banking regulators. All loans are assigned a credit risk grade at the time they are made, and each originating loan officer reviews the credit with his or her immediate supervisor on a quarterly basis to determine whether a change in the credit risk grade is warranted. In addition, the grading of our loan portfolio is reviewed on a test basis, at minimum, annually by an external, independent loan review firm.

Collection Procedure

If a borrower fails to make a scheduled payment on a loan, the bank attempts to remedy the deficiency by contacting the borrower and seeking payment. Contacts generally are made within 15 business days after the payment becomes past due. Each of the bank affiliates maintains a Special Assets Department, which generally services and collects loans rated substandard or worse. Each bank’s CCO is responsible for monitoring activity that may indicate an increased risk rating, such as past-dues, overdrafts, loan agreement covenant defaults, etc. All charge-offs in excess of $100,000 are reported to each bank’s respective board of directors. Loans deemed uncollectible are proposed for charge-off at each respective bank’s board meeting.

Nonperforming Assets

Nonperforming assets include loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing interest, nonaccrual loans, troubled debt restructured loans, and repossessed assets including other real estate owned (“OREO”). In general, loans are placed on nonaccrual status when we determine timely collection of interest to be in doubt due to the borrower’s financial condition and collection efforts. A troubled debt restructured loan is a loan on which the Bank, for reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, grants a concession to the borrower that the Bank would not otherwise consider. Other repossessed assets resulted from loans where we have received title or physical possession of the borrower’s assets. Generally, the Company re-appraises OREO and collateral dependent loans every six months. Net losses on sales/valuations of repossessed assets were $24.6 million and $28.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. These losses may continue in future periods.

Criticized Assets

Federal regulations require that each insured bank classify its assets on a regular basis. In addition, in connection with examinations of insured institutions, examiners have authority to identify problem assets, and, if appropriate, re-classify them. Loan grades six through nine of our loan grading system are utilized to identify potential problem assets.

 

7


Table of Contents

The following describes the potential problem assets in our loan grading system:

 

   

“Watch List/Special Mention.” Generally these are assets that require more than normal management attention. These loans may involve borrowers with adverse financial trends, higher debt to equity ratios, or weaker liquidity positions, but not to the degree of being considered a “problem loan” where risk of loss may be apparent. Loans in this category are usually performing as agreed, although there may be some minor non-compliance with financial covenants.

 

   

“Substandard.” These assets contain well-defined credit weaknesses and are characterized by the distinct possibility that the bank will sustain some loss if such weakness or deficiency is not corrected. These loans generally are adequately secured and in the event of a foreclosure action or liquidation, the bank should be protected from loss. All loans 90 days or more past due and all loans on nonaccrual are considered at least “substandard,” unless extraordinary circumstances would suggest otherwise.

 

   

“Doubtful.” These assets have an extremely high probability of loss, but because of certain known factors which may work to the advantage and strengthening of the asset (for example, capital injection, perfecting liens on additional collateral and refinancing plans), classification as an estimated loss is deferred until a more precise status may be determined.

 

   

“Loss.” These assets are considered uncollectible, and of such little value that their continuance as assets is not warranted. This classification does not mean that the loan has absolutely no recovery or salvage value, but rather that it is not practicable or desirable to defer writing off the asset, even though partial recovery may be achieved in the future.

Allowance for Credit Losses

Like other financial institutions, the Company must maintain an adequate allowance for credit losses. The allowance for credit losses is established through a provision for credit losses charged to expense. Loans are charged against the allowance for credit losses when Management believes that collectability of the contractual principal or interest is unlikely. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. The allowance is an amount believed adequate to absorb probable losses on existing loans that may become uncollectable, based on evaluation of the collectability of loans and prior credit loss experience, together with the other factors. For a detailed discussion of the Company’s methodology see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis and Financial Condition—Critical Accounting Policies—Allowance for Credit Losses” beginning on page 52.

Investment Activities

Each of our banking subsidiaries and the holding company has its own investment policy, which is approved by each respective bank’s board of directors. These policies dictate that investment decisions will be made based on the safety of the investment, liquidity requirements, potential returns, cash flow targets, and consistency with our interest rate risk management. Each bank’s asset and liability committee is responsible for making securities portfolio decisions in accordance with established policies. The Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer have the authority to purchase and sell securities within specified guidelines established by the Company’s accounting and investment policies. All transactions for a specific bank or for the holding company are reviewed by the respective asset and liability management committee and/or board of directors.

Generally the bank’s investment policies limit securities investments to securities backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. government, including U.S. treasury bills, notes, and bonds, and direct obligations of Ginnie Mae; mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”) or collateralized mortgage obligations (“CMO”) issued by a government-sponsored enterprise (“GSE”) such as Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac; debt securities issued by a government-sponsored enterprise (“GSE”) such as Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac, and the FHLB; municipal securities with a rating of “Single-A” or higher; adjustable-rate preferred stock (“ARPS”) where the issuing company is rated “BBB” or higher; corporate debt with a rating of “Single-A” or better; investment grade corporate bond mutual funds; private label collateralized mortgage obligations with a rating of “AAA”; commercial mortgage backed securities with a rating of “AAA”; and mandatory purchases of equity securities of the FRB and FHLB. Adjustable rate preferred stock (“ARPS”) holdings are limited to no more than 15% of a bank’s tier 1 capital; municipal securities are limited to no more than 5% of assets; investment grade corporate bond mutual funds are limited to no more than 5% of Tier 1 capital; corporate debt holdings are limited to no more than 2.5% of a bank’s assets; and commercial mortgage backed securities are limited to an aggregate purchase limit of $50 million.

The Company no longer purchases (although we may continue to hold previously acquired) collateralized debt obligations. Our policies also govern the use of derivatives, and provide that the Company and its banking subsidiaries are to prudently use derivatives as a risk management tool to reduce the Bank’s overall exposure to interest rate risk, and not for speculative purposes.

All of our investment securities are classified as available-for-sale (“AFS”), held-to-maturity (“HTM”) or measured at fair value (“trading”) pursuant to Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 320, “Investments” and FASB ASC Topic 825, “Financial Instruments”. Available-for -sale securities are reported at fair value in accordance with FASB Topic 820, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures.” For additional information regarding the Company’s accounting policy for investment securities, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Critical Accounting Policies—Investment Securities” beginning on page 53.

 

8


Table of Contents

As of December 31, 2011, the Company had an investment securities portfolio of $1.48 billion, representing approximately 21.7% of our total assets, with the majority of the portfolio invested in AAA/AA+-rated securities. The average duration of our investment securities was 2.74 years as of December 31, 2011.

The following table summarizes the investment securities portfolio as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     Amount      Percent     Amount      Percent  
     (dollars in millions)  

U.S. Government sponsored agency securities

   $ 156.2         10.5   $ 280.1         22.7

Municipal obligations

     187.5         12.7     1.7         0.1

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     54.7         3.7     67.2         5.4

Mutual funds

     28.8         1.9     0.0         0.0

Corporate bonds

     107.4         7.2     49.9         4.0

Direct U.S. obligation and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     871.1         58.8     781.2         63.2

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     25.8         1.7     8.1         0.7

CRA investments

     25.0         1.7     23.9         2.0

Trust preferred securities

     21.2         1.4     23.0         1.9

Private label commercial mortgage-backed securities

     5.4         0.4     0.0         0.0

Collateralized debt obligations

     0.1         0.0     0.3         0.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,483.2         100.0   $ 1,235.4         100.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had an investment in bank-owned life insurance (“BOLI”) of $133.9 million and $129.8 million, respectively. The BOLI was purchased to help offset employee benefit costs. For additional information concerning investments, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Financial Condition—Investments.”

Deposit Products

The Company offers a variety of deposit products including checking accounts, savings accounts, money market accounts and other types of deposit accounts, including fixed-rate, fixed maturity retail certificates of deposit. The Company has historically focused on growing its lower cost core customer deposits. As of December 31, 2011, the deposit portfolio was comprised of 27.5% non-interest bearing deposits and 72.5% interest-bearing deposits.

Non-interest bearing deposits consist of non-interest bearing checking account balances. The Company considers these deposits to be core deposits.

The competition for deposits in our markets is strong. The Company has historically been successful in attracting and retaining deposits due to several factors, including: (1) focus on a high quality of customer service; (2) our experienced relationship bankers who have strong relationships within their communities; (3) the broad selection of cash management services we offer; and (4) incentives to employees for business development. The Company intends to continue its focus on attracting deposits from our business lending relationships in order to maintain low cost of funds and improve net interest margin. The loss of low-cost deposits could negatively impact future profitability.

Deposit balances are generally influenced by national and local economic conditions, changes in prevailing interest rates, internal pricing decisions, perceived stability of financial institutions and competition. The Company’s deposits are primarily obtained from communities surrounding our branch offices. In order to attract and retain quality deposits, we rely on providing quality service and introducing new products and services that meet the needs of customers.

The Company’s deposit rates are determined by each individual bank through an internal oversight process under the direction of its asset and liability committee. The banks consider a number of factors when determining deposit rates, including:

 

   

current and projected national and local economic conditions and the outlook for interest rates;

 

   

local competition;

 

   

loan and deposit positions and forecasts, including any concentrations in either; and

 

   

FHLB advance rates and rates charged on other funding sources.

 

9


Table of Contents

The following table shows our deposit composition:

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     Amount      Percent     Amount      Percent  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Non-interest bearing demand

   $ 1,558,211         27.5   $ 1,443,251         27.0

Interest-bearing demand

     482,729         8.5     523,827         9.8

Savings and money market

     2,166,639         38.3     1,926,060         36.1

Time certificates of $100,000 or more

     1,288,681         22.8     1,276,369         23.9

Other time deposits

     162,252         2.9     168,934         3.2
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deposits

   $ 5,658,512         100.0 %    $ 5,338,441         100.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

In addition to our deposit base, we have access to other sources of funding, including FHLB and FRB advances, repurchase agreements and unsecured lines of credit with other financial institutions. Previously, we have also accessed the capital markets through trust preferred offerings. For additional information concerning our deposits see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Balance Sheet Analysis—Deposits.”

Financial Products and Services

In addition to traditional commercial banking activities, the Company offers other financial services to customers, including: internet banking, wire transfers, electronic bill payment, lock box services, courier, and cash management services.

Through Shine, a full service financial advisory firm, the Company offers financial planning and investment management.

Customer, Product and Geographic Concentrations

Approximately 61.3% and 63.9% of the loan portfolio at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, consisted of commercial real estate secured loans, including commercial real estate loans and construction and land development loans. The Company’s business is concentrated in the Las Vegas, Los Angeles, Oakland, Phoenix, Reno, San Diego and Tucson metropolitan areas. Consequently, the Company is dependent on the trends of these regional economies. The Company is not dependent upon any single or limited number of customers, the loss of which would have a material adverse effect on the Company. No material portion of the Company’s business is seasonal.

Foreign Operations

The Company has no foreign operations. The bank subsidiaries provide loans, letters of credit and other trade-related services to commercial enterprises that conduct business outside the United States.

Customer Concentration

Neither the Company nor any of its reportable segments has any customer relationships that individually account for 10% of consolidated or segment revenues, respectively.

Competition

The financial services industry is highly competitive. Many of our competitors are much larger in total assets and capitalization, have greater access to capital markets, and offer a broader range of financial services than we can offer and may have lower cost structures.

This increasingly competitive environment is primarily a result of long term changes in regulation that made mergers and geographic expansion easier; changes in technology and product delivery systems and web-based tools; the accelerating pace of consolidation among financial services providers; and the flight of deposit customers to perceived increased safety. We compete for loans, deposits and customers with other banks, credit unions, securities and brokerage companies, mortgage companies, insurance companies, finance companies, and other non-bank financial services providers. This strong competition for deposit and loan products directly affects the rates of those products and the terms on which they are offered to consumers.

Technological innovation continues to contribute to greater competition in domestic and international financial services markets.

Mergers between financial institutions have placed additional pressure on banks to consolidate their operations, reduce expenses and increase revenues to remain competitive. The competitive environment is also significantly impacted by federal and state legislation that makes it easier for non-bank financial institutions to compete with the Company.

 

10


Table of Contents

Employees

As of December 31, 2011, the Company had 942 full-time equivalent team members. The Company’s employees are not represented by a union or covered by a collective bargaining agreement. Management believes that its employee relations are good.

Recent Developments and Company Response

The global and U.S. economies, and the economies of the local communities in which we operate, experienced a rapid decline in 2008. The financial markets and the financial services industry in particular suffered unprecedented disruption, causing many major institutions to fail or require government intervention to avoid failure. These conditions were brought about largely by the erosion of U.S. and global credit markets, including a significant and rapid deterioration of the mortgage lending and related real estate markets. Despite these conditions, in 2011, we continued to grow net interest income to $257.7 million, up 10.8% from $232.6 million in 2010. However, as with many financial institutions in our markets, we continued to suffer losses resulting primarily from provisions and charge-offs for credit losses, and net losses on sales/valuations of other repossessed assets, though not at the same levels as 2010, resulting in a lower provision for credit losses in 2011 compared to 2010. As a result our net interest income after provision for credit loss in 2011 was $211.5 million, up 51.8% from $139.3 million in 2010.

The United States, state and foreign governments have taken extraordinary actions in an attempt to deal with the worldwide financial crisis and the severe decline in the economy. On July 21, 2010, President Obama signed the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, or the Dodd-Frank Act, into law. The Dodd-Frank Act has had, and will continue to have, a broad impact on the financial services industry. The SEC and the Federal banking agencies, including the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (or the Federal Reserve) and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (or the FDIC), have issued a number of requests for public comment, proposed rules and final regulations to implement the requirements of the Dodd-Frank Act. The following items provide a brief description of the impact of the Dodd-Frank Act on the operations and activities, both currently and prospectively, of the Company and its subsidiaries.

 

   

Deposit Insurance. The Dodd-Frank Act and implementing final rules from the FDIC make permanent the $250,000 deposit insurance limit for insured deposits. The assessment base against which an insured depository institution’s deposit insurance premiums paid to the FDIC’s Deposit Insurance Fund (or the DIF) has been revised to use the institution’s average consolidated total assets less its average equity rather than its deposit base. Although we do not expect these provisions to have a material effect on our deposit insurance premium expense, in the future, they could increase the FDIC deposit insurance premiums paid by our insured depository institution subsidiaries.

 

   

Increased Capital Standards and Enhanced Supervision. The federal banking agencies are required to establish minimum leverage and risk-based capital requirements for banks and bank holding companies. These new standards will be no lower than existing regulatory capital and leverage standards applicable to insured depository institutions and may, in fact, be higher when established by the agencies. Compliance with heightened capital standards may reduce our ability to generate or originate revenue-producing assets and thereby restrict revenue generation from banking and non-banking operations. The Dodd-Frank Act also increases regulatory oversight, supervision and examination of banks, bank holding companies and their respective subsidiaries by the appropriate regulatory agency. Compliance with new regulatory requirements and expanded examination processes could increase our cost of operations.

 

   

Trust Preferred Securities. Under the increased capital standards established by the Dodd-Frank Act, bank holding companies are prohibited from including in their regulatory Tier 1 capital hybrid debt and equity securities issued on or after May 19, 2010. Among the hybrid debt and equity securities included in this prohibition are trust preferred securities, which the Company has used in the past as a tool for raising additional Tier 1 capital and otherwise improving its regulatory capital ratios. Although the Company may continue to include our existing trust preferred securities as Tier 1 capital, the prohibition on the use of these securities as Tier 1 capital going forward may limit the Company’s ability to raise capital in the future.

 

   

The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau. The Dodd-Frank Act creates a new, independent Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (or the Bureau) within the Federal Reserve that is tasked with establishing and implementing rules and regulations under certain federal consumer protection laws. These consumer protection laws govern the manner in which we offer many of our financial products and services. On July 21, 2011, the rulemaking and certain enforcement authority for enumerated federal consumer financial protection laws was transferred to the Bureau. As a result of this transfer, the Bureau now has significant interpretive and enforcement authority with respect to many of the federal laws and regulations under which we operate. In accordance with this authority, the Bureau has officially transferred many of the regulations formally maintained by the Federal Reserve and the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development, to a new chapter of Title 12 of the Code of Federal Regulations maintained by the Bureau, many of which deal with consumer credit,

 

11


Table of Contents
 

account disclosures and residential mortgage lending. Although the Bureau did not make significant or substantive changes to the rules during this transfer, it now has authority to promulgate guidance and interpretations of these rules and regulations in a manner that could differ from prior interpretations from other federal regulatory bodies.

 

   

State Enforcement of Consumer Financial Protection Laws. The Dodd-Frank Act permits states to adopt consumer protection laws and regulations that are stricter than those regulations promulgated by the Bureau. State attorneys general are permitted to enforce consumer protection rules adopted by the Bureau against certain state-chartered institutions. Although consumer products and services represent a relatively small part of our business, compliance with any such new regulations would increase our cost of operations and, as a result, could limit our ability to expand these products and services.

 

   

Transactions with Affiliates and Insiders. The Dodd-Frank Act enhances the requirements for certain transactions with affiliates under Section 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, including an expansion of the definition of “covered transactions” and an increase in the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered transactions must be maintained. Additionally, limitations on transactions with insiders are expanded through the (i) strengthening on loan restrictions to insiders; and (ii) expansion of the types of transactions subject to the various limits, including derivative transactions, repurchase agreements, reverse repurchase agreements and securities lending or borrowing transactions. Restrictions are also placed on certain asset sales to and from an insider to an institution, including requirements that such sales be on market terms and, in certain circumstances, approved by the institution’s board of directors.

 

   

Corporate Governance. The Dodd-Frank Act addresses many corporate governance and executive compensation matters that will affect most U.S. publicly traded companies, including us. The Dodd-Frank Act (1) grants shareholders of U.S. publicly traded companies an advisory vote on executive compensation; (2) enhances independence requirements for compensation committee members; (3) requires companies listed on national securities exchanges to adopt incentive-based compensation claw-back policies for executive officers; and (4) provides the SEC with authority to adopt proxy access rules that would allow shareholders of publicly traded-companies to nominate candidates for election as a director and have those nominees included in a company’s proxy materials. The SEC recently adopted final rules implementing rules for the shareholder advisory vote on executive compensation and golden parachute payments.

 

   

Debit Interchange Fees and Routing. The Dodd-Frank Act changed the manner in which certain fees could be charged or received by banks with respect to electronic debit transactions. The so-called Durbin Amendment, and the Federal Reserve’s implementing regulations, require that, unless exempt, bank issuers may only receive an interchange fee from merchants that is reasonable and proportional to the cost of clearing the transaction. Although this limitation only applies to banks with total assets, when aggregated or consolidated with the assets of all their affiliates, of $10 billion or more, other provisions of the Durbin Amendment and the Federal Reserve’s regulations also require that banks enable all debit cards with two or more unaffiliated payment networks. Moreover, banks are prohibited from placing restrictions or limiting a merchant’s ability to route an electronic debit transaction initiated through a debit card through any enabled network. These rules became effective on October 1, 2011.

Additional regulations called for in the Dodd-Frank Act, including regulations dealing with the risk retention requirements for, and disclosures required from, residential mortgage originators will be implemented over time. Although the Dodd-Frank Act contains some specific timelines for the Federal regulatory agencies to follow, it remains unclear whether the agencies will be able to meet these deadlines and when rules will be proposed and finalized. We continue to monitor the rulemaking process and, while our current assessment is that the Dodd-Frank Act and the implementing regulations will not have a material effect on the Company, given the uncertainty associated with the manner in which the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act will be implemented, the full extent of the impact such requirements will have on our operations is unclear. The changes resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act may impact the profitability of our business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. These changes may also require us to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any changes necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements. Failure to comply with the new requirements would negatively impact our results of operations and financial condition. While we cannot predict what effect any presently contemplated or future changes in the laws or regulations or their interpretations would have on us, these changes could be materially adverse to our investors.

The Company was a participant in programs established by the U.S. Treasury Department under the authority contained in the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 (enacted on October 3, 2008) and the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (enacted on February 17, 2009). Among other matters, these laws:

 

   

provide for the government to invest additional capital into banks and otherwise facilitate bank capital formation (commonly referred to as the Troubled Asset Relief Program or TARP);

 

   

increase the limits on federal deposit insurance; and

 

12


Table of Contents
   

provide for various forms of economic stimulus, including to assist homeowners in restructuring and lowering mortgage payments on qualifying loans.

Other laws, regulations, and programs at the federal, state and even local levels are under consideration that seek to address the economic climate and/or the financial institutions industry. The effect of these initiatives cannot be predicted.

During 2008, in addition to two private offerings raising a total of approximately $80 million in capital, the Company also took advantage of TARP Capital Purchase Program (“CPP”) to raise $140 million of new capital and strengthen its balance sheet.

The Small Business Lending Fund, or SBLF, is a dedicated investment fund that encourages lending to small businesses by providing capital to qualified community banks with assets of less than $10 billion. Enacted into law as part of the Small Business Jobs Act of 2010, under the SBLF Treasury makes a capital investment into community banks the dividend payment on which is adjusted depending on the growth in the bank’s qualifying small business lending. On September 27, 2011, as part of the SBLF program, the Company sold $141 million of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B (the “SBLF Preferred Stock”), to the Secretary of the Treasury (the “Secretary”), and used approximately $140.8 million of the proceeds from the sale of the SBLF Preferred Stock to redeem the 140,000 shares of the Company’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A (the “CPP Preferred Stock”), issued in 2008 to the Treasury under the CPP, plus the accrued and unpaid dividends owed on the CPP Preferred Stock. As a result of its redemption of the CPP Preferred Stock, the Company is no longer subject to the limits on executive compensation and other restrictions stipulated under CPP. The Company will be subject to all terms, conditions and other requirements for participation in SBLF for as long as any SBLF Preferred Stock remains outstanding.

The previously disclosed Consent Order between the FDIC and Torrey Pines Bank, dated November 16, 2009, was terminated on October 20, 2010 and replaced with a memorandum of understanding (“MOU”). This MOU, as well as the MOU at our Western Alliance Bank subsidiary, both were terminated by the FDIC and respective state banking agencies following regulatory examinations conducted during the third quarter of 2011.

The Company’s Bank of Nevada subsidiary has been placed under informal supervisory oversight by banking regulators in the form of a memorandum of understanding. The oversight requires enhanced supervision by the Board of Directors of the bank, and the adoption or revision of written plans and/or policies addressing such matters as asset quality, credit underwriting and administration, the allowance for loan and lease losses, loan and investment portfolio risks, asset-liability management and loan concentrations, as well as the formulation and adoption of comprehensive strategic plans. The bank is also prohibited from paying dividends or making other distributions to the Company without prior regulatory approval and is required to maintain higher levels of Tier 1 capital than otherwise would be required to be considered well-capitalized under federal capital guidelines. In addition, the bank is required to provide regulators with prior notice of certain management and director changes and, in certain cases, to obtain their non-objection before engaging in a transaction that would materially change its balance sheet composition. The Company believes Bank of Nevada is in full compliance with the requirements of the applicable memorandum of understanding.

Supervision and Regulation

The Company and its subsidiaries are extensively regulated and supervised under both Federal and State laws. A summary description of the laws and regulations which relate to the Company’s operations are discussed beginning on page 59.

Additional Available Information

The Company maintains an Internet website at http://www.westernalliancebancorp.com. The Company makes available its annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to such reports filed or furnished pursuant to Sections 13(a) and 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”) and other information related to the Company free of charge, through this site as soon as reasonably practicable after it electronically files those documents with, or otherwise furnishes them to the Securities Exchange Commission (“SEC”). The SEC maintains an Internet site, http://www.sec.gov, in which all forms filed electronically may be accessed. The Company’s internet website and the information contained therein are not intended to be incorporated in this Form 10-K.

In addition, copies of the Company’s annual report will be made available, free of charge, upon written request.

 

ITEM IA. RISK FACTORS

Investing in our common stock involves various risks which are specific to the Company. Several of these risks and uncertainties, are discussed below and elsewhere in this report. This listing should not be considered as all-inclusive. These factors represent risks and uncertainties that could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. Other risks that we do not know about now, or that we do not believe are significant, could negatively impact our business or the trading price of our securities. In addition to common business risks such as

 

13


Table of Contents

theft, loss of market share and disasters, the Company is subject to special types of risk due to the nature of its business. See additional discussions about credit, interest rate, market and litigation risks in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” section of this report beginning on page 29 and additional information regarding legislative and regulatory risks in the “Supervision and Regulation” section beginning on page 59.

Risks Relating to Our Business

Our financial performance may be adversely affected by conditions in the financial markets and economic conditions generally

Our financial performance generally, and in particular the ability of borrowers to pay interest on and repay principal of outstanding loans and the value of collateral securing those loans, is highly dependent upon the business environment in the markets where we operate and in the United States as a whole. A favorable business environment is generally characterized by, among other factors, economic growth, efficient capital markets, low inflation, high business and investor confidence, and strong business earnings. Unfavorable or uncertain economic and market conditions can be caused by declines in economic growth, business activity or investor or business confidence, limitations on the availability or increases in the cost of credit and capital, increases in inflation or interest rates, natural disasters or a combination of these or other factors.

Since mid-2007, the financial services industry and the securities markets generally have been materially and adversely affected by significant declines in the values of nearly all asset classes and by a serious lack of liquidity. The global markets have been characterized by substantially increased volatility and an overall loss of investor confidence. Market conditions have led to the failure or merger of a number of prominent financial institutions. Financial institution failures or near-failures have resulted in further losses as a consequence of defaults on securities issued by them and defaults under contracts entered into with such entities as counterparties. Furthermore, declining asset values, defaults on mortgages and consumer loans, and the lack of market and investor confidence, as well as other factors, have all combined to increase credit default swap spreads and to cause rating agencies to lower credit ratings. Despite recent stabilization in asset prices, economic performance and significant declines in Federal Reserve borrowing rates, there remains a risk of continued asset and economic deterioration, which may increase the cost and decrease the availability of liquidity. Additionally, some banks and other lenders have suffered significant losses and they have become reluctant to lend, even on a secured basis, because of capital limitations, potentially increased risks of default and the impact of declining asset values on collateral. The foregoing has significantly weakened the strength and liquidity of some financial institutions worldwide.

It is possible that the business environment in the United States will continue to deteriorate for the foreseeable future. There can be no assurance that these conditions will improve in the near term. Such conditions could adversely affect the credit quality of our loans, our results of operations and our financial condition.

The Company is highly dependent on real estate and events that negatively impact the real estate market will hurt our business and earnings

The Company is located in areas in which economic growth is largely dependent on the real estate market, and a substantial majority of our loan portfolio is secured or otherwise dependent on real estate. Real estate values have been declining in our markets, in some cases in a material and even dramatic fashion, which affects collateral values and has resulted in increased provisions for credit losses. We expect the weakness in these portions of our loan portfolio to continue through 2012. Accordingly, it is anticipated that our nonperforming asset and charge-off levels will remain elevated.

Further, the effects of recent mortgage market challenges, combined with the ongoing decrease in residential real estate market prices and demand, could result in further price reductions in home values, adversely affecting the value of collateral securing the residential real estate and construction loans that we hold, as well as loan originations and gains on sale of real estate and construction loans. A further decline in real estate activity would likely cause a further decline in asset and deposit growth and further negatively impact our earnings and financial condition.

The Company’s high concentration of commercial real estate, construction and land development and commercial and industrial loans expose us to increased lending risks

Commercial real estate, construction and land development and commercial and industrial loans, comprised approximately 85% of our total loan portfolio as of December 31, 2011, and expose the Company to a greater risk of loss than residential real estate and consumer loans, which comprised a smaller percentage of the total loan portfolio at December 31, 2011. Commercial real estate and land development loans typically involve larger loan balances to single borrowers or groups of related borrowers compared to residential loans. Consequently, an adverse development with respect to one commercial loan or one credit relationship exposes us to a significantly greater risk of loss compared to an adverse development with respect to one residential mortgage loan. In addition, these real estate construction, acquisition and development loans have certain risks that are not present in other types of loans. The primary credit risks

 

14


Table of Contents

associated with real estate construction, acquisition and development loans are underwriting, project risks and market risks. Project risks include cost overruns, borrower credit risk, project completion risk, general contractor credit risk and environmental and other hazard risks. Market risks are risks associated with the sale of the completed residential and commercial units. They include affordability risk, which means the risk that borrowers cannot obtain affordable financing, product design risk, and risks posed by competing projects. Real estate construction, acquisition and development loans also involve additional risks because funds are advanced upon the security of the project, which is of uncertain value prior to its completion, and costs may exceed realizable values in declining real estate markets.

Because of the uncertainties inherent in estimating construction costs and the realizable market value of the completed project and the effects of governmental regulation of real property, it is relatively difficult to evaluate accurately the total funds required to complete a project and the related loan-to-value ratio. As a result, real estate construction, acquisition and development loans often involve the disbursement of substantial funds with repayment dependent, in part, on the success of the ultimate project and the ability of the borrower to sell or lease the property, rather than the ability of the borrower or guarantor to repay principal and interest. If our appraisal of the value of the completed project proves to be overstated or market values or rental rates decline, we may have inadequate security for the repayment of the loan upon completion of construction of the project. If we are forced to foreclose on a project prior to or at completion due to a default, there can be no assurance that we will be able to recover all of the unpaid balance and accrued interest on the loan as well as related foreclosure and holding costs. In addition, we may be required to fund additional amounts to complete the project and may have to hold the property for an unspecified period of time while we attempt to dispose of it. The adverse effects of the foregoing matters upon our real estate construction, acquisition and development portfolio could lead to a further increase in non-performing loans related to this portfolio and these non-performing loans may result in a material level of charge-offs, which may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Actual credit losses may exceed the losses that we expect in our loan portfolio, which could require us to raise additional capital. If we are not able to raise additional capital, our financial condition, results of operations and capital would be materially and adversely affected

Credit losses are inherent in the business of making loans. We make various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of our consolidated loan portfolio and maintain an allowance for estimated credit losses based on a number of factors, including the size of the portfolio, asset classifications, economic trends, industry experience and trends, industry and geographic concentrations, estimated collateral values, management’s assessment of the credit risk inherent in the portfolio, historical loan loss experience and loan underwriting policies. In addition, the Company evaluates all loans identified as problem loans and augments the allowance based upon our estimation of the potential loss associated with those problem loans. Additions to the allowance for credit losses recorded through our provision for credit losses decrease net income. If such assumptions and judgments are incorrect, our actual credit losses may exceed our allowance for credit losses.

At December 31, 2011, our allowance for credit losses was $99.2 million. Deterioration in the real estate market and/or general economic conditions could affect the ability of our loan customers to service their debt, which could result in additional loan provisions and subsequent increases in our allowance for credit losses in the future. Any increases in the provision or allowance for credit losses will result in a decrease in our net income and, potentially, capital, and may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Moreover, because future events are uncertain and because we may not successfully identify all deteriorating loans in a timely manner, there may be loans that deteriorate in an accelerated time frame. If actual credit losses materially exceed our allowance for credit losses, we may be required to raise additional capital, which may not be available to us on acceptable terms or at all. Our inability to raise additional capital on acceptable terms when needed could materially and adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and capital.

In addition, we may be required to increase our allowance for credit losses based on changes in economic and real estate market conditions, new information regarding existing loans, input from regulators in connection with their review of our allowance, as a result of changes in regulatory guidance regulations or accounting standards, identification of additional problem loans and other factors, both within and outside of our management’s control. Increases to our allowance for credit losses would negatively affect our financial condition and earnings.

Because of the geographic concentration of our assets, our business is highly susceptible to local economic conditions

Our business is primarily concentrated in selected markets in Arizona, California and Nevada. As a result of this geographic concentration, our financial condition and results of operations depend largely upon economic conditions in these market areas. Deterioration in economic conditions in the markets we serve could result in one or more of the following: an increase in loan delinquencies; an increase in problem assets and foreclosures; a decrease in the demand for our products and services; and a decrease in the value of collateral for loans, especially real estate, in turn reducing customers’ borrowing power, the value of assets associated with problem loans and collateral coverage.

 

15


Table of Contents

If actual credit losses exceed our provision for credit losses, we may also be required to record a valuation allowance against our deferred tax assets

Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that some or all deferred tax assets will not be realized. This determination is based upon an evaluation of all available positive or negative evidence. As a result of losses incurred in 2009, and 2010, the Company is in a three-year cumulative pretax loss position at December 31, 2011. A cumulative loss position is considered significant negative evidence in assessing the realizability of a deferred tax asset. The Company has assessed its ability to utilize deferred tax assets and we have concluded that there is sufficient positive evidence to overcome this negative evidence. This positive evidence includes Company forecasts, exclusive of tax planning strategies, that show realization of deferred tax assets by the end of 2013 based on current projections. In addition, management has identified tax planning strategies that would also be available to utilize deferred tax assets. The Company has concluded that there is sufficient positive evidence to overcome negative evidence, and that it is not more likely than not that deferred tax assets will not be realized. However, if future results underperform management’s forecasts, the Company may be required to record a valuation allowance against some or all of its deferred tax assets which would have an adverse impact on our capital.

We could be required to revalue our deferred tax assets if stock transactions result in limitations on the deductibility of our net operating losses or loan losses

Our deferred tax assets relate primarily to net operating losses and loan loss allowances and the net operating loss carryforwards. The availability of net operating losses and loan losses to offset future taxable income would be limited if we were to undergo an “ownership change” pursuant to Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended. On September 14, 2010, our Board of Directors approved an amendment to WAL’s Amendment and Restated By-laws (the “By-laws Amendment”) and an amendment to WAL’s Second Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation, as amended (the “Articles Amendment”), to prohibit certain acquisitions of the Company’s common stock. The By-Laws Amendment and Articles Amendment are intended to protect the Company’s ability to use certain tax assets, such as net operating loss carryforwards, capital loss carryforwards and certain built-in losses, by preventing stock transactions that would result in an ownership change (any such restrictions would most likely affect 5% stockholders or those persons who would seek to acquire 5% of our stock). The Articles Amendment was approved by WAL’s stockholders on November 30, 2010.

Notwithstanding the restrictions implemented through the By-Laws Amendment and Articles Amendment, there can be no assurance that such restrictions will prevent all acquisitions that could result in an “ownership change” or will be upheld if challenged, or that the restrictions and any remedies or cures for violations would be respected by taxing or other authorities. Further, because such restrictions restrict a stockholder’s ability to acquire, directly or indirectly, additional shares of common stock in excess of the specified limitations, and may limit a stockholder’s ability to dispose of common stock by reducing the universe of potential acquirors for such common stock, and because a stockholder’s ownership of common stock may become subject to the Articles Amendment upon actions taken by persons related to, or affiliated with, such stockholder, the restrictions could adversely affect the marketability and market price for our stock.

The downgrade of the U.S. government’s sovereign credit rating, any related rating agency action in the future, the ongoing debt crisis in Europe and the downgrade of the sovereign credit ratings for several European nations could negatively impact our business, financial condition and results of operations

On November 21, 2011, a Congressional committee that was formed to achieve $1.2 trillion in deficit reduction measures announced that it had failed to achieve its stated purpose by the deadline imposed by Congress’ August agreement to raise the U.S. government’s debt ceiling. Standard & Poor’s Rating Services, which had downgraded the U.S. government’s AAA sovereign credit rating to AA+ with a negative outlook in August 2011, affirmed its AA+ rating following the announcement. Moody’s Investors Services, which changed its U.S. government rating outlook to negative on August 2, 2011, also reaffirmed its rating following the Congressional committee’s announcement. On November 22, 2011, Fitch Ratings stated that the failure of the committee to reach an agreement would likely cause it to change its outlook on U.S. government debt to negative. Further, on November 28, 2011, Fitch stated that a downgrade of the U.S. sovereign credit rating would occur without a credible plan in place by 2013 to reduce the U.S. government deficit. The impact of any additional downgrades to the U.S. government’s sovereign credit rating by any of these rating agencies, as well as the perceived creditworthiness of U.S. government-related obligations, is inherently unpredictable and could adversely affect the U.S. and global financial markets and economic conditions and have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operation.

In addition, while we don’t have direct exposure certain European nations continue to experience varying degrees of financial stress. Despite various assistance packages, worries about European financial institutions and sovereign finances persist. On January 13, 2012, Standard & Poor’s downgraded the credit ratings of France, Italy and seven other European nations in part as a result of the failure of leaders to address systemic stresses in the Eurozone. Market

 

16


Table of Contents

concerns over the direct and indirect exposure of European banks and insurers to these European Union nations and each other have resulted in a widening of credit spreads and increased costs of funding for some European financial institutions. Risks related to the European economic crisis have had, and are likely to continue to have, a negative impact on global economic activity and the financial markets. As these conditions persist, our financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

The Company’s financial instruments expose it to certain market risks and may increase the volatility of reported earnings

The Company holds certain financial instruments measured at fair value. For those financial instruments measured at fair value, the Company is required to recognize the changes in the fair value of such instruments in earnings. Therefore, any increases or decreases in the fair value of these financial instruments have a corresponding impact on reported earnings. Fair value can be affected by a variety of factors, many of which are beyond our control, including our credit position, interest rate volatility, volatility in capital markets and other economic factors. Accordingly, our earnings are subject to mark-to-market risk and the application of fair value accounting may cause our earnings to be more volatile than would be suggested by our underlying performance.

If the Company lost a significant portion of its low-cost deposits, it could negatively impact our liquidity and profitability

The Company’s profitability depends in part on successfully attracting and retaining a stable base of low-cost deposits. While we generally do not believe these core deposits are sensitive to interest rate fluctuations, the competition for these deposits in our markets is strong and customers are increasingly seeking investments that are safe, including the purchase of U.S. Treasury securities and other government-guaranteed obligations, as well as the establishment of accounts at the largest, most-well capitalized banks. If the Company were to lose a significant portion of its low-cost deposits, it would negatively impact its liquidity and profitability.

From time to time, the Company has been dependent on borrowings from the FHLB and the FRB, and there can be no assurance these programs will be available as needed

As of December 31, 2011, the Company has borrowings from the FHLB of San Francisco of $280.0 million and no borrowings from the FRB. The Company in the recent past has been reliant on such borrowings to satisfy its liquidity needs. The Company’s borrowing capacity is generally dependent on the value of the Company’s collateral pledged to these entities. These lenders could reduce the borrowing capacity of the Company or eliminate certain types of collateral and could otherwise modify or even terminate its loan programs. Any change or termination would have an adverse affect on the Company’s liquidity and profitability.

A decline in the Company’s stock price or expected future cash flows, or a material adverse change in our results of operations or prospects, could result in further impairment of our goodwill

Since January 1, 2008, we have written off $188.5 million in goodwill. A further significant and sustained decline in our stock price and market capitalization, a significant decline in our expected future cash flows, a significant adverse change in the business climate or slower growth rates could result in additional impairment of our goodwill. If we were to conclude that a future write-down of our goodwill is necessary, then we would record the appropriate charge, which could be materially adverse to our operating results and financial position. For further discussion, see Note 7, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets” in the notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Any reduction in the Company’s credit rating could increase the cost of funding from the capital markets

Moody’s Investors Service regularly evaluates its ratings of us and our long-term debt based on a number of factors, including our financial strength as well as factors not entirely within our control, including conditions affecting the financial services industry generally. In light of the difficulties in the financial services industry and the real estate and financial markets, there can be no assurance that we will not be subject to credit downgrades. Credit ratings measure a company’s ability to repay its obligations and directly affect the cost and availability to that company of unsecured financing. Downgrades could adversely affect the cost and other terms upon which we are able to obtain funding and increase our cost of capital.

The Company’s expansion strategy may not prove to be successful and our market value and profitability may suffer

The Company continually evaluates expansion through acquisitions of banks, the organization of new banks and the expansion of our existing banks through establishment of new branches. Any future acquisitions will be accompanied by the risks commonly encountered in acquisitions. These risks include, among other things: 1) difficulty of integrating the operations and personnel; 2) potential disruption of our ongoing business; and 3) inability of our management to maximize our financial and strategic position by the successful implementation of uniform product offerings and the incorporation of uniform technology into our product offerings and control systems.

 

17


Table of Contents

The recent crisis also revealed and caused risks that are unique to acquisitions of financial institutions and banks, and that are difficult to assess, including the risk that the acquired institution has troubled, illiquid, or bad assets or an unstable base of deposits or assets under management. The Company expects that competition for suitable acquisition candidates may be significant. We may compete with other banks or financial service companies with similar acquisition strategies, many of which are larger and have greater financial and other resources. The Company cannot assure you that we will be able to successfully identify and acquire suitable acquisition targets on acceptable terms and conditions.

In addition to the acquisition of existing financial institutions, the Company may consider the organization of new banks in new market areas. We do not have any current plans to organize a new bank. Any acquisition or organization of a new bank carries with it numerous risks, including the following:

 

   

the inability to obtain all the regulatory approvals;

 

   

significant costs and anticipated operating losses during the application and organizational phases, and the first years of operation of the new bank;

 

   

the inability to secure the services of qualified senior management;

 

   

the local market may not accept the services of a new bank owned and managed by a bank holding company headquartered outside of the market area of the new bank;

 

   

the inability to obtain attractive locations within a new market at a reasonable cost and

 

   

the additional strain on management resources and internal systems and controls.

The Company cannot provide any assurance that it will be successful in overcoming these risks or any other problems encountered in connection with acquisitions and the organization of new banks. Further, the Bank of Nevada is currently subject to a memorandum of understanding, which, among other things, imposes requirements that could limit the Bank’s ability to grow its business. See “Legal Proceedings.” Regulatory enforcement actions, like a memorandum of understanding, also may adversely affect our ability to engage in certain expansionary activities. The Company’s inability to provide resources necessary for its subsidiary banks to meet the requirements of any regulatory action or otherwise to overcome these risks could have an adverse effect on the achievement of our business strategy and maintenance of our market value.

The Company may not be able to implement and improve its controls and processes, or its reporting systems and procedures, which could cause it to experience compliance and operational problems or incur additional expenditures beyond current projections, any one of which could adversely affect our financial results

The Company’s future success will depend on the ability of officers and other key employees to continue to implement and improve operational, credit, financial, management and other internal risk controls and processes, and improve reporting systems and procedures, while at the same time maintaining and growing existing businesses and client relationships. We may not successfully implement such improvements in an efficient or timely manner and may discover deficiencies in existing systems and controls. Such activities would divert management from maintaining and growing our existing businesses and client relationships and could require us to incur additional expenditures to expand our administrative and operational infrastructure. If we are unable to improve our controls and processes, or our reporting systems and procedures, we may experience compliance and operational problems or incur additional expenditures beyond current projections, any one of which could adversely affect our financial results.

The Company’s future success will depend on our ability to compete effectively in a highly competitive market

The Company faces substantial competition in all phases of our operations from a variety of different competitors. Our competitors, including commercial banks, community banks, savings and loan associations, mutual savings banks, credit unions, consumer finance companies, insurance companies, securities dealers, brokers, mortgage bankers, investment advisors, money market mutual funds and other financial institutions, compete with lending and deposit-gathering services offered by us. Increased competition in our markets may result in reduced loans and deposits.

There is very strong competition for financial services in the market areas in which we conduct our businesses from many local commercial banks as well as numerous national and commercial banks and regionally based commercial banks. Many of these competing institutions have much greater financial and marketing resources than we have. Due to their size, many competitors can achieve larger economies of scale and may offer a broader range of products and services than us. If we are unable to offer competitive products and services, our business may be negatively affected.

Some of the financial services organizations with which we compete are not subject to the same degree of regulation as is imposed on bank holding companies and federally insured depository institutions. As a result, these non-bank competitors have certain advantages over us in accessing funding and in providing various services. The banking business in our primary market areas is very competitive, and the level of competition facing us may increase further, which may limit our asset growth and financial results.

 

18


Table of Contents

The success of the Company is dependent upon its ability to recruit and retain qualified employees especially seasoned relationship bankers

The Company’s business plan includes and is dependent upon hiring and retaining highly qualified and motivated executives and employees at every level. In particular, our relative success to date has been partly the result of our management’s ability to identify and retain highly qualified relationship bankers that have long-standing relationships in their communities. These professionals bring with them valuable customer relationships and have been an integral part of our ability to attract deposits and to expand our marketshare. From time to time, the Company recruits or utilizes the services of employees who are subject to limitations on their ability to use confidential information of a prior employer, to freely compete with that employer, or to solicit customers of that employer. If the Company is unable to hire or retain qualified employees it may not be able to successfully execute its business strategy. If the Company or its employee is found to have violated any nonsolicitation or other restrictions applicable to it or its employees, the Company or its employee could become subject to litigation or other proceedings.

The Company would be harmed if it lost the services of any of its senior management team or senior relationship bankers

We believe that our success to date has been substantially dependent on our senior management team, which includes Robert Sarver, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, Kenneth Vecchione, President and Chief Operating Officer, Dale Gibbons, Chief Financial Officer, Robert R. McAuslan, Chief Credit Officer, Bruce Hendricks, Chief Executive Officer of Bank of Nevada, James Lundy, Chief Executive Officer of Western Alliance Bank, Gerald Cady, Chief Executive Officer of Torrey Pines Bank, and certain of our senior relationship bankers. We also believe that our prospects for success in the future are dependent on retaining our senior management team and senior relationship bankers. In addition to their skills and experience as bankers, these persons provide us with extensive community ties upon which our competitive strategy is based. Our ability to retain these persons may be hindered by the fact that we have not entered into employment agreements with any of them. The loss of the services of any of these persons, particularly Mr. Sarver, could have an adverse effect on our business if we cannot replace them with equally qualified persons who are also familiar with our market areas.

Mr. Sarver’s involvement in outside business interests requires substantial time and attention and may adversely affect the Company’s ability to achieve its strategic plan

Mr. Sarver joined the Company in December 2002 and is an integral part of our business. He has substantial business interests that are unrelated to us, including his position as managing partner of the Phoenix Suns National Basketball Association franchise. Mr. Sarver’s other business interests demand significant time commitments, the intensity of which may vary throughout the year. Mr. Sarver’s other commitments may reduce the amount of time he has available to devote to our business. We believe that Mr. Sarver spends the substantial majority of his business time on matters related to our company. However, a significant reduction in the amount of time Mr. Sarver devotes to our business may adversely affect our ability to achieve our strategic plan.

Terrorist attacks and threats of war or actual war may impact all aspects of our operations, revenues, costs and stock price in unpredictable ways

Terrorist attacks in the United States, as well as future events occurring in response or in connection to them including, without limitation, future terrorist attacks against United States targets, rumors or threats of war, actual conflicts involving the United States or its allies or military or trade disruptions, may impact our operations. Any of these events could cause consumer confidence and savings to decrease or result in increased volatility in the United States and worldwide financial markets and economy. Any of these occurrences could have an adverse impact on the Company’s operating results, revenues and costs and may result in the volatility of the market price for our securities, including our common stock, and impair their future price.

The Company has received an IRS notice of proposed deficiency related to the Company’s claim of certain deductions on its 2008 tax return, in connection with the partial worthlessness of collateralized debt obligations, which deductions resulted in an approximately $37-million tax refund for the 2006 and 2007 taxable periods. The Company has since received a favorable oral decision from the IRS Appellate Conferee, which decision must be approved by the Joint Committee on Taxation before the matter is closed

The Internal Revenue Service’s Examination Division issued a notice of proposed deficiency on January 10, 2011, proposing a taxable income adjustment of $136.7 million related to deductions taken on the Company’s 2008 tax return in connection with the partial worthlessness of collateralized debt obligations, or CDOs. The use of these deductions on the Company’s 2008 tax return resulted in a net operating loss carryback claim for a tax refund of approximately $40.0 million of federal taxes for the 2006 and 2007 taxable periods. The Company filed a protest of the proposed deficiency, which caused the matter to be referred to the Appeals Division of the IRS. The Appellate Conferee has conceded that our $136.7 million deduction was correct and has proposed no further adjustments. However, the case is not yet closed. Due

 

19


Table of Contents

to the size of the refund, the Appellate Conferee was required to submit his formal written recommendation to the Joint Committee on Taxation and will close the case after receiving approval from that committee. The Company has not accrued a reserve for this potential exposure.

The business may be adversely affected by internet fraud

The Company is inherently exposed to many types of operational risk, including those caused by the use of computer, internet and telecommunications systems. These risks may manifest themselves in the form of fraud by employees, by customers, other outside entities targeting us and/or our customers that use our internet banking, electronic banking or some other form of our telecommunications systems. Given the growing level of use of electronic, internet-based, and networked systems to conduct business directly or indirectly with our clients, certain fraud losses may not be avoidable regardless of the preventative and detection systems in place.

We may experience interruptions or breaches in our information system security

We rely heavily on communications and information systems to conduct our business. Any failure, interruption or breach in security of these systems could result in failures or disruptions in our customer relationship management, general ledger, deposit, loan and other systems. While we have policies and procedures designed to prevent or limit the effect of the failure, interruption or security breach of these information systems, there can be no assurance that any such failures, interruptions or security breaches will not occur or, if they do occur, that they will be adequately addressed. The occurrence of any failures, interruptions or security breaches of these information systems could damage our reputation, result in a loss of customer business, subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny, or expose us to civil litigation and possible financial liability, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

A failure in or breach of our operational or security systems or infrastructure, or those of our third party vendors and other service providers, including as a result of cyber attacks, could disrupt our businesses, result in the disclosure or misuse of confidential or proprietary information, damage our reputation, increase our costs and cause losses

As a financial institution, we are susceptible to fraudulent activity that may be committed against us or our clients, which may result in financial losses to us or our clients, privacy breaches against our clients, or damage to our reputation. Such fraudulent activity may take many forms, including check fraud, electronic fraud, wire fraud, phishing, and other dishonest acts. In recent periods, there has been a rise in electronic fraudulent activity within the financial services industry, especially in the commercial banking sector, due to cyber criminals targeting commercial bank accounts. Consistent with industry trends, we have also experienced an increase in attempted electronic fraudulent activity in recent periods.

In addition, our operations rely on the secure processing, storage and transmission of confidential and other information on our computer systems and networks. Although we take numerous protective measures to maintain the confidentiality, integrity and availability of our and our clients’ information across all geographic and product lines, and endeavor to modify these protective measures as circumstances warrant, the nature of the threats continues to evolve. As a result, our computer systems, software and networks and those of our customers may be vulnerable to unauthorized access, loss or destruction of data (including confidential client information), account takeovers, unavailability of service, computer viruses or other malicious code, cyber attacks and other events that could have an adverse security impact and result in significant losses by us and/or our customers. Despite the defensive measures we take to manage our internal technological and operational infrastructure, these threats may originate externally from third parties, such as foreign governments, organized crime and other hackers, and outsource or infrastructure-support providers and application developers, or the threats may originate from within our organization. Given the increasingly high volume of our transactions, certain errors may be repeated or compounded before they can be discovered and rectified.

We also face the risk of operational disruption, failure, termination or capacity constraints of any of the third parties that facilitate our business activities, including exchanges, clearing agents, clearing houses or other financial intermediaries. Such parties could also be the source of an attack on, or breach of, our operational systems, data or infrastructure. In addition, as interconnectivity with our clients grows, we increasingly face the risk of operational failure with respect to our clients’ systems.

Although to date we have not experienced any material losses relating to cyber attacks or other information security breaches, there can be no assurance that we will not suffer such losses in the future. Our risk and exposure to these matters remains heightened because of, among other things, the evolving nature of these threats, the outsourcing of some of our business operations, and the continued uncertain global economic environment. As cyber threats continue to evolve, we may be required to expend significant additional resources to continue to modify or enhance our protective measures or to investigate and remediate any information security vulnerabilities.

We maintain an insurance policy which we believe provides sufficient coverage at a manageable expense for an institution of our size and scope with similar technological systems. However, we cannot assure that this policy will afford coverage for all possible losses or would be sufficient to cover all financial losses, damages, penalties, including lost revenues, should we experience any one or more of our or a third party’s systems failing or experiencing attack.

 

20


Table of Contents

Risks Related to the Banking Industry

We operate in a highly regulated environment and the laws and regulations that govern our operations, corporate governance, executive compensation and accounting principles, or changes in them, or our failure to comply with them, may adversely affect us

The Company is subject to extensive regulation, supervision, and legislation that governs almost all aspects of our operations. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Supervision and Regulation” included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Intended to protect customers, depositors and the FDIC’s Deposit Insurance Fund, these laws and regulations, among other matters, prescribe minimum capital requirements, impose limitations on the business activities in which we can engage, limit the dividends or distributions that our banking institutions can pay to our holding company, restrict the ability of institutions to guarantee our parent company’s debt, impose certain specific accounting requirements on us that may be more restrictive and may result in greater or earlier charges to earnings or reductions in our capital than generally accepted accounting principles, among other things. Compliance with laws and regulations can be difficult and costly, and changes to laws and regulations often impose additional compliance costs. Further, an alleged failure by us to comply with these laws and regulations, even if we acted in good faith or the alleged failure reflects a difference in interpretation, could subject the Company to additional restrictions on its business activities, fines and other penalties, any of which could adversely affect our results of operations, capital base and the price of our securities.

On July 21, 2010, President Obama signed the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, or the Dodd-Frank Act, into law. The Dodd-Frank Act has had, and will continue to have, a broad impact on the financial services industry, including significant regulatory and compliance changes. Many of the requirements called for in the Dodd-Frank Act are in the process of being implemented by regulations issued by the SEC and Federal banking agencies, such as the FDIC and Federal Reserve, and will continue to be implemented over the course of several years. Given the uncertainty associated with the manner in which the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act will be implemented by the various regulatory agencies and through regulations, the full extent of the impact such requirements will have on our operations is unclear. The changes resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act may impact the profitability of our business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. In particular, the potential impact of the Dodd-Frank Act on our operations and activities, both currently and prospectively, include, among others:

 

   

a reduction in our ability to generate or originate revenue-producing assets as a result of compliance with heightened capital standards;

 

   

increased cost of operations due to greater regulatory oversight, supervision and examination of banks and bank holding companies, and higher deposit insurance premiums;

 

   

the limitation on our ability to raise capital through the use of trust preferred securities as these securities may no longer be included in Tier 1 capital going forward; and

 

   

the limitations on our ability to offer certain consumer products and services due to anticipated stricter consumer protection laws and regulations.

Examples of these provisions include, but are not limited to:

 

   

Creation of the Financial Stability Oversight Council that may recommend to the Federal Reserve increasingly strict rules for capital, leverage, liquidity, risk management and other requirements as companies grow in size and complexity;

 

   

Application of the same leverage and risk-based capital requirements that apply to insured depository institutions to most bank holding companies, such as the Company;

 

   

Changes to the assessment base used by the FDIC to assess insurance premiums from insured depository institutions and increases to the minimum reserve ratio for the Deposit Insurance Fund, or DIF, from 1.15% to not less than 1.35%, with provisions to require institutions with total consolidated assets of $10 billion or more to bear a greater portion of the costs associated with increasing the DIF’s reserve ratio;

 

   

Repeal of the federal prohibitions on the payment of interest on demand deposits, thereby permitting depository institutions to pay interest on business transaction and other accounts;

 

   

Establishment of a consumer financial protection bureau with broad authority to implement new consumer protection regulations and, for bank holding companies with $10 billion or more in assets, to examine and enforce compliance with federal consumer laws;

 

21


Table of Contents
   

Implementation of risk retention rules for loans (excluding qualified residential mortgages) that are sold by a bank; and

 

   

Amendment of the Electronic Fund Transfer Act to, among other things, give the Federal Reserve the authority to issue rules have limiting debit-card interchange fees.

In addition, under section 343 of the Dodd-Frank Act, deposits held in noninterest-bearing transaction accounts at our bank subsidiaries are fully insured by the FDIC regardless of the balance in the account through December 31, 2012. This unlimited coverage is available to all depositors and is separate from, and in addition to, the insurance coverage provided for a depositor’s other accounts held at our banks. Unless extended, the scheduled expiration on January 1, 2013 of the unlimited deposited insurance for noninterest-bearing transaction accounts may result in a loss of deposits at our banks, which could have an adverse effect on our business and financial condition.

Further, we may be required to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any changes necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements under the Dodd-Frank Act. Failure to comply with the new requirements may negatively impact our results of operations and financial condition. While we cannot predict what effect any presently contemplated or future changes in the laws or regulations or their interpretations would have on us, these changes could be materially adverse to our investors.

State and federal banking agencies periodically conduct examinations of our business, including for compliance with laws and regulations, and our failure to comply with any supervisory actions to which we are or become subject as a result of such examinations may adversely affect us

State and federal banking agencies periodically conduct examinations of our business, including for compliance with laws and regulations. If, as a result of an examination, the FDIC or Federal Reserve were to determine that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of any of the banks’ operations had become unsatisfactory, or that any of the banks or their management was in violation of any law or regulation, the FDIC or Federal Reserve may take a number of different remedial or enforcement actions as it deems appropriate. These actions include the power to enjoin “unsafe or unsound” practices, to require affirmative actions to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in the bank’s capital, to restrict the bank’s growth, to assess civil monetary penalties against the bank’s officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if the FDIC concludes that such conditions cannot be corrected or there is an imminent risk of loss to depositors, to terminate the bank’s deposit insurance. Under Nevada, Arizona and California law, the respective state banking supervisory authority has many of the same enforcement powers with respect to its state-chartered banks.

Bank of Nevada has been placed under informal supervisory oversight by banking regulators in the form of a memorandum of understanding. The oversight requires enhanced supervision by the Board of Directors of the bank, and the adoption or revision of written plans and/or policies addressing such matters as asset quality, credit underwriting and administration, the allowance for loan and lease losses, loan and investment portfolio risks, asset-liability management and loan concentrations, as well as the formulation and adoption of comprehensive strategic plans. The bank is also prohibited from paying dividends or making other distributions to the Company without prior regulatory approval and is required to maintain higher levels of Tier 1 capital than otherwise would be required to be considered well-capitalized under federal capital guidelines. In addition, the Bank of Nevada is required to provide regulators with prior notice of certain management and director changes and, in certain cases, to obtain their non-objection before engaging in a transaction that would materially change its balance sheet composition.

If we were unable to comply with regulatory directives in the future, or if we were unable to comply with the terms of any future supervisory requirements to which we may become subject, then we could become subject to additional supervisory actions and orders, including cease and desist orders, prompt corrective action and/or other regulatory enforcement actions. If our regulators were to take such additional supervisory actions, then we could, among other things, become subject to greater restrictions on our ability to develop any new business, as well as restrictions on our existing business, and we could be required to raise additional capital, dispose of certain assets and liabilities within a prescribed period of time, or both. Failure to implement the measures in the time frames provided, or at all, could result in additional orders or penalties from federal and state regulators, which could result in one or more of the remedial actions described above. In the event that one or more of our banks was ultimately unable to comply with the terms of a regulatory enforcement action, such a bank could ultimately fail and be placed into receivership by the chartering agency. Under applicable federal law and FDIC regulations, the failure of one of the subsidiary banks could impose liability for any loss to the FDIC or the DIF on the remaining subsidiary banks, further straining the financial resources available to the surviving charters. The terms of any such supervisory action and the consequences associated with any failure to comply therewith could have a material negative effect on our business, operating flexibility and financial condition.

Changes in interest rates could adversely affect our profitability, business and prospects

Most of the Company’s assets and liabilities are monetary in nature, which subjects us to significant risks from changes in interest rates and can impact our net income and the valuation of our assets and liabilities. Increases or decreases in prevailing interest rates could have an adverse effect on our business, asset quality and prospects. The Company’s operating income and net income depend to a great extent on our net interest margin. Net interest margin is the difference between the interest yields we receive on loans, securities and other earning assets and the interest rates we pay on interest bearing deposits, borrowings and other liabilities. These rates are highly sensitive to many factors beyond our control, including competition, general economic conditions and monetary and fiscal policies of various governmental

 

22


Table of Contents

and regulatory authorities, including the Federal Reserve. If the rate of interest we pay on our interest bearing deposits, borrowings and other liabilities increases more than the rate of interest we receive on loans, securities and other earning assets increases, our net interest income, and therefore our earnings, would be adversely affected. The Company’s earnings also could be adversely affected if the rates on our loans and other investments fall more quickly than those on our deposits and other liabilities.

In addition, loan volumes are affected by market interest rates on loans. Rising interest rates generally are associated with a lower volume of loan originations while lower interest rates are usually associated with higher loan originations. Conversely, in rising interest rate environments, loan repayment rates will decline and in falling interest rate environments, loan repayment rates will increase. The Company cannot guarantee that it will be able to minimize interest rate risk. In addition, an increase in the general level of interest rates may adversely affect the ability of certain borrowers to pay the interest on and principal of their obligations.

Interest rates also affect how much money the Company can lend. When interest rates rise, the cost of borrowing increases. Accordingly, changes in market interest rates could materially and adversely affect our net interest spread, asset quality, loan origination volume, business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

The Company is exposed to risk of environmental liabilities with respect to properties to which we obtain title

Approximately 71% of the Company’s loan portfolio at December 31, 2011 was secured by real estate. In the course of our business, the Company may foreclose and take title to real estate, and could be subject to environmental liabilities with respect to these properties. We may be held liable to a governmental entity or to third parties for property damage, personal injury, investigation and clean-up costs incurred by these parties in connection with environmental contamination, or may be required to investigate or clean up hazardous or toxic substances, or chemical releases at a property. The costs associated with investigation or remediation activities could be substantial. In addition, if we are the owner or former owner of a contaminated site, we may be subject to common law claims by third parties based on damages and costs resulting from environmental contamination emanating from the property. These costs and claims could adversely affect our business and prospects.

Risks Related to our Common Stock

The price of our common stock may fluctuate significantly, and this may make it difficult for you to resell shares of common stock owned by you at times or at prices you find attractive

The price of our common stock on New York Stock Exchange constantly changes. We expect that the market price of our common stock will continue to fluctuate and there can be no assurances about the market prices for our common stock.

Our stock price may fluctuate as a result of a variety of factors, many of which are beyond our control. These factors include:

 

   

sales of our equity securities;

 

   

our financial condition, performance, creditworthiness and prospects;

 

   

quarterly variations in our operating results or the quality of our assets;

 

   

operating results that vary from the expectations of management, securities analysts and investors;

 

   

changes in expectations as to our future financial performance;

 

   

announcements of strategic developments, acquisitions and other material events by us or our competitors;

 

   

the operating and securities price performance of other companies that investors believe are comparable to us;

 

   

the credit, mortgage and housing markets, the markets for securities relating to mortgages or housing, and developments with respect to financial institutions generally;

 

   

changes in global financial markets and global economies and general market conditions, such as interest or foreign exchange rates, stock, commodity or real estate valuations or volatility and other geopolitical, regulatory or judicial events; and

 

   

our past and future dividend practice.

There may be future sales or other dilution of our equity, which may adversely affect the market price of our common stock

We are not restricted from issuing additional common stock, including any securities that are convertible into or exchangeable for, or that represent the right to receive, common stock. The issuance of any additional shares of common stock or preferred stock or securities convertible into, exchangeable for or that represent the right to receive common stock or the exercise of such securities could be substantially dilutive to shareholders of our common stock. Holders of our shares of common stock have no preemptive rights that entitle holders to purchase their pro rata share of any offering of shares of any class or series. Because our decision to issue securities in any future offering will depend on market conditions and other factors beyond our control, we cannot predict or estimate the amount, timing or nature of our future offerings. Thus, our stockholders bear the risk of our future offerings reducing the market price of our common stock and diluting their stock holdings in us.

 

23


Table of Contents

Offerings of debt, which would be senior to our common stock upon liquidation, and/or preferred equity securities which may be senior to our common stock for purposes of dividend distributions or upon liquidation, may adversely affect the market price of our common stock

We may from time to time issue debt securities, borrow money through other means, or issue preferred stock. On August 25, 2010, the Company completed a public offering of $75 million in principal Senior Notes due in 2015. In 2011, we issued preferred stock to the federal government under the SBLF program, and from time to time we have borrowed money from the Federal Reserve, the FHLB, other financial institutions and other lenders. All of these securities or borrowings have priority over the common stock on a liquidation, which could affect the market price of our stock. The SBLF preferred stock also may restrict our ability to pay dividends on our common stock under certain circumstances. See Exhibits 3.8 and 3.9 attached hereto and incorporated herein by this reference.

Our Board of Directors is authorized to issue one or more classes or series of preferred stock from time to time without any action on the part of the stockholders. Our Board of Directors also has the power, without stockholder approval, to set the terms of any such classes or series of preferred stock that may be issued, including voting rights, dividend rights, and preferences over our common stock with respect to dividends or upon our dissolution, winding-up and liquidation and other terms. If we issue preferred stock in the future that has a preference over our common stock with respect to the payment of dividends or upon our liquidation, dissolution, or winding up, or if we issue preferred stock with voting rights that dilute the voting power of our common stock, the rights of holders of our common stock or the market price of our common stock could be adversely affected.

Anti-takeover provisions could negatively impact our stockholders

Provisions of Nevada law and provisions of our amended and restated articles of incorporation and amended and restated by-laws could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire control of us or have the effect of discouraging a third party from attempting to acquire control of us. Additionally, our amended and restated articles of incorporation authorize our Board of Directors to issue additional series of preferred stock and such preferred stock could be issued as a defensive measure in response to a takeover proposal. These provisions could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire us even if an acquisition might be in the best interest of our stockholders.

 

ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

None

 

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES

At December 31, 2011, the Company and Western Alliance Bank are headquartered at One E. Washington Street in Phoenix, Arizona. In addition, the Company occupies a leased 7,000 square foot service center in San Diego, California and owns a 36,000 square foot operations facility in Las Vegas, Nevada. The Company also has 6 executive and administrative facilities, 3 of which are owned, located in Las Vegas, Nevada, San Diego, California, Oakland, California, Phoenix, Arizona, Wilmington, Delaware and Reno, Nevada.

At December 31, 2011, the Company operated 39 domestic branch locations, of which 18 are owned and 21 are on leased premises. See Item 1 “Business” for location cities on page 4. For information regarding rental payments, see Note 5, “Premises and Equipment” of the Consolidated Financial Statements. In addition, the Company had one non-banking subsidiary with a leased office in Denver, Colorado.

The Company continually evaluates the suitability and adequacy of its offices. Management believes that the existing facilities are adequate for present and anticipated future use.

 

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

There are no material pending legal proceedings to which the Company is a party or to which any of our properties are subject. There are no material proceedings known to us to be contemplated by any governmental authority. See “Supervision and Regulation” for additional information. From time to time, we are involved in a variety of litigation matters in the ordinary course of our business and anticipate that we will become involved in new litigation matters in the future.

 

24


Table of Contents

As previously disclosed in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, one of the Company’s banking subsidiaries, Bank of Nevada, has been placed under informal supervisory oversight by banking regulators in the form of a memorandum of understanding. The oversight requires enhanced supervision by the Board of Directors of the bank, and the adoption or revision of written plans and/or policies addressing such matters as asset quality, credit underwriting and administration, the allowance for loan and lease losses, loan and investment portfolio risks, asset-liability management and loan concentrations, as well as the formulation and adoption of comprehensive strategic plans. The bank is also prohibited from paying dividends or making other distributions to the Company without prior regulatory approval and is required to maintain higher levels of Tier 1 capital than otherwise would be required to be considered well-capitalized under federal capital guidelines. In addition, the bank is required to provide regulators with prior notice of certain management and director changes and, in certain cases, to obtain their non-objection before engaging in a transaction that would materially change its balance sheet composition. The Company believes Bank of Nevada is in full compliance with the requirements of the memorandum of understanding.

 

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

Not applicable.

 

25


Table of Contents

PART II

 

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

Market Information

The Company’s common stock began trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “WAL” on June 30, 2005. The Company has filed, without qualifications, its 2011 Domestic Company section 303A CEO certification regarding its compliance with the NYSE’s corporate governance listing standards. The following table presents the high and low sales prices of the Company’s common stock for each quarterly period for the last two years as reported by The NASDAQ Global Select Market:

 

     2011 Quarters      2010 Quarters  
     Fourth      Third      Second      First      Fourth      Third      Second      First  

Range of stock prices:

                       

High

   $ 6.87       $ 7.60       $ 8.33       $ 8.45       $ 7.46       $ 8.10       $ 9.64       $ 6.04   

Low

     4.99         4.44         6.47         6.77         5.69         5.98         5.59         3.75   

Holders

At December 31, 2011, there were approximately 1,347 stockholders of record. This number excludes an estimate for the number of stockholders whose shares are held in the name of brokerage firms or other financial institutions. The Company is not provided the exact number of or identities of these stockholders. There are no other classes of common equity outstanding.

Dividends

Western Alliance Bancorporation (“Western Alliance”) is a legal entity separate and distinct from the banks and our other non-bank subsidiaries. As a holding company with limited significant assets other than the capital stock of our subsidiaries, Western Alliance’s ability to pay dividends depends primarily upon the receipt of dividends or other capital distributions from our subsidiaries. Our subsidiaries’ ability to pay dividends to Western Alliance is subject to, among other things, their individual earnings, financial condition and need for funds, as well as federal and state governmental policies and regulations applicable to Western Alliance and each of those subsidiaries, which limit the amount that may be paid as dividends without prior approval. See the additional discussion in the “Supervision and Regulation” section of this report for information regarding restrictions on the ability to pay cash dividends. Our Bank of Nevada subsidiary is also presently subject to a Memorandum of Understanding that requires prior regulatory approval of any dividend paid to Western Alliance Bancorporation. In addition, the terms and conditions of other securities we issue may restrict our ability to pay dividends to holders of our common stock. For example if any required payments on outstanding trust preferred securities or our SBLF preferred stock are not made, Western Alliance would be prohibited from paying cash dividends on our common stock. Western Alliance has never paid a cash dividend on its common stock and does not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future.

Sale of Unregistered Securities

The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from Item 3.02 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on September 27, 2011.

Share Repurchases

There were no shares repurchased during 2011 or 2010.

Performance Graph

The following graph summarizes a five year comparison of the cumulative total returns for the Company’s common stock, the Standard & Poor’s 500 stock index and the KBW Regional Banking Index, each of which assumes an initial value of $100.00 on December 31, 2005 and reinvestment of dividends.

 

26


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

The information under the caption “Equity Compensation Plans” in our definitive proxy statement to be filed with the SEC is incorporated by reference into this Item 5.

 

ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

The following selected financial data have been derived from the Company’s consolidated financial condition and results of operations, as of and for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007, and should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this report:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  
     (in thousands, except per share data)  

Results of Operations:

          

Interest income

   $ 296,591      $ 281,813      $ 276,023      $ 295,591      $ 305,822   

Interest expense

     38,923        49,260        73,734        100,683        125,933   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

     257,668        232,553        202,289        194,908        179,889   

Provision for credit losses

     46,188        93,211        149,099        68,189        20,259   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

     211,480        139,342        53,190        126,719        159,630   

Non-interest income

     34,457        46,836        4,435        (117,258     22,533   

Non-interest expense

     195,598        196,758        242,977        288,967        131,011   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before taxes

     50,339        (10,580     (185,352     (279,506     51,152   

Income tax provision (benefit)

     16,849        (6,410     (38,453     (49,496     16,674   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     33,490        (4,170     (146,899     (230,010     34,478   

Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax benefit

     (1,996     (3,025     (4,507     (6,450     (1,603
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 31,494      $ (7,195   $ (151,406   $ (236,460   $ 32,875   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

27


Table of Contents

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  
     (in thousands, except per share data)  

Per Share Data:

          

Income (loss) per share—basic

   $ 0.19      $ (0.23   $ (2.74   $ (7.27   $ 1.14   

Income (loss) per share—diluted

   $ 0.19      $ (0.23   $ (2.74   $ (7.27   $ 1.06   

Income (loss) per share from continuing operations—basic

   $ 0.41      $ (0.06   $ (2.50   $ (7.04   $ 1.19   

Income (loss) per share from continuing operations—diluted

   $ 0.41      $ (0.06   $ (2.50   $ (7.04   $ 1.11   

Book value per common share

   $ 6.02      $ 5.77      $ 6.18      $ 9.59      $ 16.63   

Shares outstanding at period end

     82,362        81,669        72,504        38,601        30,157   

Weighted average shares outstanding—basic

     80,909        75,083        58,836        32,652        28,918   

Weighted average shares outstanding—diluted

     81,183        75,083        58,836        32,652        31,019   

Selected Balance Sheet Data:

          

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 154,995      $ 216,746      $ 396,830      $ 139,954      $ 115,629   

Investments and other

   $ 1,490,501      $ 1,273,098      $ 864,779      $ 565,377      $ 736,200   

Gross loans, including net deferred loan fees

   $ 4,780,069      $ 4,240,542      $ 4,079,638      $ 4,095,711      $ 3,633,009   

Allowance for loan losses

   $ 99,170      $ 110,699      $ 108,623      $ 74,827      $ 49,305   

Assets

   $ 6,844,541      $ 6,193,883      $ 5,753,279      $ 5,242,761      $ 5,016,096   

Deposits

   $ 5,658,512      $ 5,338,441      $ 4,722,102      $ 3,652,266      $ 3,546,922   

Other borrowings

   $ 355,000      $ 75,000      $ —        $ —        $ —     

Junior subordinated and subordinated debt

   $ 36,985      $ 43,034      $ 102,438      $ 103,038      $ 122,240   

Stockholders’ equity

   $ 636,683      $ 602,174      $ 575,725      $ 495,497      $ 501,518   

Selected Other Balance Sheet Data:

          

Average assets

   $ 6,486,396      $ 6,030,609      $ 5,575,025      $ 5,198,237      $ 4,667,243   

Average earning assets

   $ 5,964,056      $ 5,526,521      $ 5,125,574      $ 4,600,466      $ 4,123,956   

Average stockholders’ equity

   $ 631,361      $ 601,412      $ 586,171      $ 512,872      $ 493,365   

Selected Financial and Liquidity Ratios:

          

Return on average assets

     0.49     (0.12 )%      (2.72 )%      (4.55 )%      0.70

Return on average stockholders’ equity

     4.99     (1.20 )%      (25.83 )%      (46.11 )%      6.66

Net interest margin (2)

     4.37     4.23     3.97     4.28     4.40

Loan to deposit ratio

     84.48     79.43     86.39     112.14     102.43

Capital Ratios:

          

Leverage ratio

     9.8     9.5     9.5     8.9     7.4

Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio

     11.3     12.0     11.8     9.8     7.9

Total risk-based capital ratio

     12.6     13.2     14.4     12.3     10.3

Average equity to average assets

     9.7     10.0     10.5     9.9     10.6

Selected Asset Quality Ratios:

          

Nonaccrual loans to gross loans

     1.89     2.76     3.77     1.44     0.49

Nonaccrual loans and repossessed assets to total assets

     2.62     3.63     4.12     1.40     0.42

Loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing to total loans

     0.05     0.03     0.14     0.30     0.02

Allowance for credit losses to total loans

     2.07     2.61     2.66     1.83     1.36

Allowance for credit losses to nonaccrual loans

     109.71     94.62     70.67     128.34     275.86

Net charge-offs to average loans

     1.32     2.22     2.86     1.10     0.23

 

28


Table of Contents
ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with “Item 8 – Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.” This discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that involve risk, uncertainties and assumptions. Certain risks, uncertainties and other factors, including but not limited to those set forth under “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements,” may cause actual results to differ materially from those projected in the forward-looking statements.

Financial Overview and Highlights

Western Alliance Bancorporation is a multi-bank holding company headquartered in Phoenix, Arizona that provides full service banking, lending and investment advisory services through its subsidiaries.

Financial Result Highlights of 2011

Net income available to common stockholders for the Company of $15.3 million, or $0.19 per diluted share for 2011, compared to net loss of $17.1 million or ($0.23) loss per diluted share for 2010.

The significant factors impacting earnings of the Company during 2011 were:

 

   

All bank subsidiaries were profitable for the first time since 2007. Bank of Nevada reported net income of $7.5 million compared to a net loss of $26.4 million in 2010. Western Alliance Bank reported net income of $19.8 million for 2011 compared to $12.8 million for 2010. The Torrey Pines Bank Segment (which excludes discontinued operation), reported net income of $19.5 million for 2011 compared to $10.3 million for 2010.

 

   

During 2011, the Company improved its net interest margin to 4.37% from 4.23% and its net interest spread to 4.12% from 3.92%. The increase is attributed to the reduction in the cost of interest bearing liabilities, primarily deposits, at a faster rate than the reduction on earning asset yields to 0.90% from 1.20%. The Company has continued to report consecutive quarters of increases in net interest income.

 

   

The Company experienced loan growth of $539.5 million to $4.78 billion at December 31, 2011 from $4.24 billion at December 31, 2010.

 

   

During 2011, the Company increased deposits by $320.1 million to $5.66 billion at December 31, 2011 from $5.34 billion at December 31, 2010.

 

   

Other assets acquired through foreclosure declined by $18.6 million to $89.1 million at December 31, 2011 from $107.7 million at December 31, 2010.

 

   

Provision expense for 2011 declined $47.0 million to $46.2 million compared to $93.2 million for 2010 as net charge-offs also declined by $33.4 million to $57.7 million in 2011 compared to $91.1 million in 2010.

 

   

Key asset quality ratios improved for 2011 compared to 2010. Nonaccrual loans and repossessed assets to total assets improved to 2.62% from 3.63% in 2010 and nonaccrual loans to gross loans improved to 1.89% at the end of 2011 compared to 2.76% at the end of 2010.

 

   

On September 27, 2011, the Company received $141.0 million from participation in the U.S. Department of Treasury’s Small Business Lending Fund (SBLF).

 

   

The Company redeemed its CPP Preferred Stock of $140 million on September 27, 2011 and recorded a one-time equity charge of $6.9 million.

 

   

On November 23, 2011, the Company completed the repurchase of a warrant held by the U.S. Department of the Treasury.

The impact to the Company from these items, and others of both a positive and negative nature, will be discussed in more detail as they pertain to the Company’s overall comparative performance for the year ended December 31, 2011 throughout the analysis sections of this report.

 

29


Table of Contents

A summary of our results of operations and financial condition and select metrics is included in the following table:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands, except per share amounts)  

Net income (loss) available to common stockholders

   $ 15,288      $ (17,077   $ (161,148

Basic earnings (loss) per share

     0.19        (0.23     (2.74

Diluted earnings (loss) per share

     0.19        (0.23     (2.74

Total assets

   $ 6,844,541      $ 6,193,883      $ 5,753,279   

Gross loans

   $ 4,780,069      $ 4,240,542      $ 4,079,639   

Total deposits

   $ 5,658,512      $ 5,338,441      $ 4,722,102   

Net interest margin

     4.37     4.23     3.97

Return on average assets

     0.49     (0.12 )%      (2.72 )% 

Return on average stockholders' equity

     4.99     (1.20 )%      (25.84 )% 

As a bank holding company, management focuses on key ratios in evaluating the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. In the current economic environment, key ratios regarding asset credit quality and efficiency are more informative as to the financial condition of the Company than those utilized in a more normal economic period such as return on equity and return on assets.

Asset Quality

For all banks and bank holding companies, asset quality plays a significant role in the overall financial condition of the institution and results of operations. The Company measures asset quality in terms of nonaccrual loans as a percentage of gross loans, and net charge-offs as a percentage of average loans. Net charge-offs are calculated as the difference between charged-off loans and recovery payments received on previously charged-off loans. The following table summarizes asset quality metrics:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
           (in thousands)        

Non-accrual loans

   $ 90,392      $ 116,999      $ 153,702   

Non-performing assets

     294,568        342,808        289,066   

Non-accrual loans to gross loans

     1.89     2.76     3.77

Net charge-offs to average loans

     1.32     2.22     2.86

Asset and Deposit Growth

The ability to originate new loans and attract new deposits is fundamental to the Company’s asset growth. The Company’s assets and liabilities are comprised primarily of loans and deposits. Total assets increased during 2011 to $6.84 billion from $6.19 billion at December 31, 2010. Total gross loans excluding net deferred fees and unearned income increased by $540.6 million, or 12.7%, as of December 31, 2011 compared to December 31, 2010. Total deposits increased $320.1 million, or 6.0%, to $5.66 billion as of December 31, 2011 from $5.34 billion as of December 31, 2010.

 

30


Table of Contents

RESULTS OF OPERATONS

The following table sets forth a summary financial overview for the comparable years:

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
    Increase  
     2011     2010     (Decrease)  
     (in thousands, except per share amounts)  

Consolidated Statement of Operations Data:

      

Interest income

   $ 296,591      $ 281,813      $ 14,778   

Interest expense

     38,923        49,260        (10,337
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

     257,668        232,553        25,115   

Provision for credit losses

     46,188        93,211        (47,023
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

     211,480        139,342        72,138   

Other non-interest income

     34,457        46,836        (12,379

Non-interest expense

     195,598        196,758        (1,160
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

     50,339        (10,580     60,919   

Income tax provision (benefit)

     16,849        (6,410     23,259   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     33,490        (4,170     37,660   

Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax benefit

     (1,996     (3,025     1,029   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 31,494      $ (7,195   $ 38,689   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) available to common stockholders

   $ 15,288      $ (17,077   $ 32,365   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) per share—basic

   $ 0.19      $ (0.23   $ 0.42   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) per share—diluted

   $ 0.19      $ (0.23   $ 0.42   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The Company’s primary source of income is interest income. Interest income for the year ended December 31, 2011 was $296.6 million, an increase of 5.2% when comparing interest income for the year ended December 31, 2010. This increase was primarily from interest income from loans and investment securities. Interest income from loans increased by $5.8 million for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 compared to the twelve months ended December 31, 2010. Interest income from investment securities increased by $9.7 million for the twelve month period ended December 31, 2011 compared to December 31, 2010. Federal funds sold and other interest income declined by $0.5 million to $0.7 million from $1.3 million for the comparable twelve month periods. Despite the increased interest income, average yield on interest earning assets dropped 10 basis points for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010, primarily the result of decreased yields on loans of 25 basis points.

Interest expense for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010 decreased by 21.0% to $38.9 million from $49.3 million. This decline was primarily due to decreased average cost of deposits, which declined 38 basis points to 0.69% for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to the same period in 2010. Interest paid on borrowings and other debt increased by $3.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010, primarily due to the higher cost of the senior debt obligations issued in the third quarter of 2010.

Net interest income was $257.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010, an increase of $25.1 million, or 10.8%. The increase in net interest income reflects a $437.5 million increase in average earning assets, offset by a $219.6 million increase in average interest bearing liabilities. The increased net interest margin of 14 basis points was due to a decrease in our average cost of funds primarily as a result of downward repricing of deposits and decreased rates on short-term borrowings.

 

31


Table of Contents

Net Interest Margin

The net interest margin is reported on a tax equivalent basis (“TEB”). A tax equivalent adjustment is added to reflect interest earned on certain municipal securities and loans that are exempt from Federal income tax. The following table sets forth the average balances and interest income on a fully tax equivalent basis and interest expense for the years indicated:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     (dollars in thousands)  
     Average
Balance
    Interest      Average
Yield/Cost
    Average
Balance
    Interest      Average
Yield/Cost
 

Interest-Earning Assets

              

Securities:

              

Taxable

   $ 1,178,765      $ 29,836         2.53   $ 869,027      $ 23,272         2.68

Tax-exempt (1)

     128,336        4,583         5.92     46,171        1,481         5.73
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total securities

     1,307,101        34,419         2.86     915,198        24,753         2.83

Federal funds sold and other

     897        1         0.11     17,328        141         0.81

Loans (1) (2) (3)

     4,373,454        261,443         5.98     4,105,022        255,626         6.23

Short term investments

     246,963        629         0.25     448,815        1,130         0.25

Restricted stock

     35,641        99         0.28     40,158        163         0.41
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total earnings assets

     5,964,056        296,591         5.02     5,526,521        281,813         5.12

Nonearning Assets

              

Cash and due from banks

     119,499             116,588        

Allowance for credit losses

     (105,927          (114,074     

Bank-owned life insurance

     131,645             99,435        

Other assets

     377,123             402,139        
  

 

 

        

 

 

      

Total assets

   $ 6,486,396           $ 6,030,609        
  

 

 

        

 

 

      

Interest-Bearing Liabilities

              

Sources of Funds

              

Interest-bearing deposits:

              

Interest checking

   $ 478,345      $ 1,759         0.37   $ 581,063      $ 2,898         0.50

Savings and money market

     2,105,316        12,858         0.61     1,861,668        16,724         0.90

Time deposits

     1,460,690        13,360         0.91     1,437,234        21,707         1.51
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing deposits

     4,044,351        27,977         0.69     3,879,965        41,329         1.07

Short-term borrowings

     161,618        714         0.44     131,878        1,506         1.14

Long-term debt

     73,143        7,904         10.81     26,558        2,777         10.46

Junior subordinated and subordinated debt

     41,256        2,328         5.64     62,342        3,648         5.85
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing liabilities

     4,320,368        38,923         0.90     4,100,743        49,260         1.20

Noninterest-Bearing Liabilities

              

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

     1,509,363             1,296,634        

Other liabilities

     25,304             31,820        

Stockholders’ equity

     631,361             601,412        
  

 

 

        

 

 

      

Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

   $ 6,486,396           $ 6,030,609        
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

   

 

 

    

Net interest income and margin (4)

     $ 257,668         4.37     $ 232,553         4.23
    

 

 

        

 

 

    

Net interest spread (5)

          4.12          3.92

 

(1) Yields on loans and securities have been adjusted to a tax equivalent basis. Interest income has not been adjusted to a tax equivalent basis. The tax-equivalent adjustments for 2011 and 2010 were $3,014 and $1,164, respectively.
(2) Net loan fees of $4.3 million and $4.2 million are included in the yield computation for 2011 and 2010, respectively.
(3) Includes nonaccrual loans.
(4) Net interest margin is computed by dividing net interest income by total average earning assets.
(5) Net interest spread represents average yield earned on interest-earning assets less the average rate paid on interest bearing liabilities.

 

32


Table of Contents

The table below sets forth the relative impact on net interest income of changes in the volume of earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities and changes in rates earned and paid by us on such assets and liabilities. For purposes of this table, nonaccrual loans have been included in the average loan balances.

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011 versus 2010  
     Increase (Decrease)
Due to Changes in (1)(2)
 
     Volume     Rate     Total  
     (in thousands)  

Interest on investment securities:

      

Taxable

   $ 7,840      $ (1,276   $ 6,564   

Tax-exempt

     2,934        168        3,102   

Federal funds sold and other

     (18     (122     (140

Loans

     16,047        (10,230     5,817   

Short term investments

     (514     13        (501

Restricted stock

     (13     (51     (64
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

     26,276        (11,498     14,778   

Interest expense:

      

Interest checking

     (378     (761     (1,139

Savings and money market

     1,488        (5,354     (3,866

Time deposits

     215        (8,562     (8,347

Short-term borrowings

     131        (923     (792

Long-term debt

     5,034        93        5,127   

Junior subordinated debt

     (1,190     (130     (1,320
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest expense

     5,300        (15,637     (10,337
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase

   $ 20,976      $ 4,139      $ 25,115   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Changes due to both volume and rate have been allocated to volume changes.
(2) Changes due to mark-to-market gains/losses under ASC 825 have been allocated to volume changes.

Comparison of net interest margin for 2010 to 2009

The following table sets forth a summary financial overview for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009:

 

     Year Ended        
     December 31,     Increase  
     2010     2009     (Decrease)  
     (in thousands, except per share amounts)  

Consolidated Statement of Operations Data:

      

Interest income

   $ 281,813      $ 276,023      $ 5,790   

Interest expense

     49,260        73,734        (24,474
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

     232,553        202,289        30,264   

Provision for credit losses

     93,211        149,099        (55,888
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

     139,342        53,190        86,152   

Other non-interest income

     46,836        4,435        42,401   

Non-interest expense

     196,758        242,977        (46,219
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

     (10,580     (185,352     174,772   

Income tax benefit

     (6,410     (38,453     32,043   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from continuing operations

     (4,170     (146,899     142,729   

Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax benefit

     (3,025     (4,507     1,482   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

   $ (7,195   $ (151,406   $ 144,211   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss available to common stockholders

   $ (17,077   $ (161,148   $ 144,071   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss per share—basic

   $ (0.23   $ (2.74   $ 2.51   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss per share—diluted

   $ (0.23   $ (2.74   $ 2.51   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

33


Table of Contents

The Company’s primary source of income is interest income. Interest income for the year ended December 31, 2010 was $281.8 million, an increase of 2.1% when comparing interest income for 2010 to 2009. This increase was primarily from interest income from loans. Average yield on loans increased 9 basis points to 6.23% for the year ended December 31, 2010 compared to 2009.

Interest expense for the year ended 2010 compared to 2009 decreased by 33.2% to $49.3 million from $73.7 million. This decline was primarily due to decreased average interest paid on deposits, which declined 83 basis points to 1.07% for the year ended December 31, 2010 compared to the same period in 2009.

Net interest income was $232.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, compared to 2009, an increase of $30.3 million, or 15.0%. The increase in net interest income reflects a $400.9 million increase in average earning assets, offset by a $209.2 million increase in average interest bearing liabilities. The increased margin of 26 basis points was due to a decrease in our average cost of funds primarily as a result of downward repricing of deposits.

 

34


Table of Contents

The net interest margin is reported on a tax equivalent basis (“TEB”). A tax equivalent adjustment is added to reflect interest earned on certain municipal securities and loans that are exempt from Federal income tax. The following table sets forth the average balances and interest income on a fully tax equivalent basis and interest expense for the years indicated:

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
     2010     2009  
     (dollars in thousands)  
      Average
Balance
    Interest      Average
Yield/Cost
    Average
Balance
    Interest      Average
Yield/Cost
 

Interest-Earning Assets

              

Securities:

              

Taxable

   $ 869,027      $ 23,272         2.68   $ 634,916      $ 24,124         3.80

Tax-exempt (1)

     46,171        1,481         5.73     55,515        1,691         5.23
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total securities

     915,198        24,753         2.83     690,431        25,815         3.91

Federal funds sold and other

     17,328        141         0.81     33,479        1,103         3.29

Loans (1) (2) (3)

     4,105,022        255,626         6.23     4,037,659        248,098         6.14

Short term investments

     448,815        1,130         0.25     322,883        874         0.27

Restricted stock

     40,158        163         0.41     41,122        133         0.32
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total earnings assets

     5,526,521        281,813         5.12     5,125,574        276,023         5.41

Nonearning Assets

              

Cash and due from banks

     116,588             174,112        

Allowance for credit losses

     (114,074          (88,243     

Bank-owned life insurance

     99,435             91,321        

Other assets

     402,139             272,261        
  

 

 

        

 

 

      

Total assets

   $ 6,030,609           $ 5,575,025        
  

 

 

        

 

 

      

Interest-Bearing Liabilities

              

Sources of Funds

              

Interest-bearing deposits:

              

Interest checking

   $ 581,063      $ 2,898         0.50   $ 303,388      $ 3,216         1.06

Savings and money market

     1,861,668        16,724         0.90     1,666,728        26,903         1.61

Time deposits

     1,437,234        21,707         1.51     1,280,381        31,786         2.48
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing deposits

     3,879,965        41,329         1.07     3,250,497        61,905         1.90

Short-term borrowings

     131,878        1,506         1.14     512,265        5,286         1.03

Long-term debt

     26,558        2,777         10.46     25,727        1,577         6.13

Junior subordinated and subordinated debt

     62,342        3,648         5.85     103,034        4,966         4.82
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing liabilities

     4,100,743        49,260         1.20     3,891,523        73,734         1.89

Noninterest-Bearing Liabilities

              

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

     1,296,634             1,070,011        

Other liabilities

     31,820             27,320        

Stockholders’ equity

     601,412             586,171        
  

 

 

        

 

 

      

Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

   $ 6,030,609           $ 5,575,025        
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

   

 

 

    

Net interest income and margin (4)

     $ 232,553         4.23     $ 202,289         3.97
    

 

 

        

 

 

    

Net interest spread (5)

          3.92          3.52

 

(1) Yields on loans and securities have been adjusted to a tax equivalent basis. Interest income has not been adjusted to a tax equivalent basis. The tax-equivalent adjustments for 2010 and 2009 were $1,164 and $1,210, respectively.
(2) Net loan fees of $4.2 million and $4.0 million are included in the yield computation for 2010 and 2009, respectively.
(3) Includes nonaccrual loans.
(4) Net interest margin is computed by dividing net interest income by total average earning assets.
(5) Net interest spread represents average yield earned on interest-earning assets less the average rate paid on interest bearing liabilities.

 

35


Table of Contents

The table below sets forth the relative impact on net interest income of changes in the volume of earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities and changes in rates earned and paid by us on such assets and liabilities. For purposes of this table, nonaccrual loans have been included in the average loan balances.

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
     2010 versus 2009  
     Increase (Decrease)  
     Due to Changes in (1)(2)  
     Volume     Rate     Total  
     (in thousands)  

Interest on investment securities:

      

Taxable

   $ 6,269      $ (7,121   $ (852

Tax-exempt

     (300     90        (210

Federal funds sold and other

     (131     (831     (962

Loans

     4,195        3,333        7,528   

Short term investments

     317        (61     256   

Restricted stock

     (4     34        30   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

     10,346        (4,556     5,790   

Interest expense:

      

Interest checking

     1,385        (1,703     (318

Savings and money market

     1,751        (11,930     (10,179

Time deposits

     2,369        (12,448     (10,079

Short-term borrowings

     (4,344     564        (3,780

Long-term debt

     87        1,113        1,200   

Junior subordinated debt

     (2,381     1,063        (1,318
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest expense

     (1,133     (23,341     (24,474
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease)

   $ 11,479      $ 18,785      $ 30,264   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Changes due to both volume and rate have been allocated to volume changes.
(2) Changes due to mark-to-market gains/losses under ASC 825 have been allocated to volume changes.

Provision for Credit Losses

The provision for credit losses in each period is reflected as a charge against earnings in that period. The provision is equal to the amount required to maintain the allowance for credit losses at a level that is adequate to absorb probable credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio. The provision for credit losses decreased by $47.0 million, or 50.4%, to $46.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, compared with $93.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. The provision decreased primarily due to decreased net charge-offs and improvement in asset quality. Provision for credit losses related to commercial real estate, commercial and industrial, and construction and land development loans decreased by $27.6 million, $12.0 million and $8.7 million, respectively, for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010. Provision for credit losses related to residential real estate and consumer loans increased by $1.1 million and $0.1 million, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010.

The provision for credit losses was $93.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, a decrease of $55.9 million compared with $149.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2009. The provision decreased in 2010 compared to 2009 primarily due to increased asset quality.

Non-interest Income

The Company earned non-interest income primarily through fees related to services provided to loan and deposit customers, bank owned life insurance, investment advisory services, investment securities gains and impairment charges, mark to market gains and other.

 

36


Table of Contents

The following tables present a summary of non-interest income for the periods presented:

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
      2011     2010     Increase
(Decrease)
 
     (in thousands)  

Service charges

   $ 9,102      $ 8,969      $ 133   

Trust and investment advisory services

     2,537        4,003        (1,466

Operating lease income

     1,878        3,793        (1,915

Other fee revenue

     3,453        3,324        129   

Income from bank owned life insurance

     5,372        3,299        2,073   

Gain on extinguishment of debt

     —          3,000        (3,000

Mark to market (loss) gain, net

     5,621        (369     5,990   

Gain on sales of investment securities, net

     4,798        19,757        (14,959

Net securities impairment charges

     (226     (1,186     960   

Derivative losses, net

     (238     (269     31   

Other

     2,160        2,515        (355
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-interest income

   $ 34,457      $ 46,836      $ (12,379
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-interest income for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010 decreased by $12.4 million, or 26.4%, primarily as a result of the $15.0 million decrease in net gains on sale of investment securities. During the twelve months ended December 31, 2011, the Company sold $504.1 million of investment securities for a net gain on security sales of $4.8 million compared to $496.9 million of investment securities sales as of December 31, 2010 for net gains on sales of $19.8 million. Mark to market gains increased for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010 due to $6.0 million of unrealized gains recorded on the junior subordinated debt as the result of credit spreads widening. Service charges, other fee revenue and derivative losses remained almost flat for the comparable twelve month periods ended December 31, 2011 and 2010. Income from bank owned life insurance increased by 62.8% due to increased investment in this asset in the fourth quarter of 2010. Partially offsetting these increases was a decrease in trust and advisory fees for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010 due to the disposition of the Company’s trust unit, Premier Trust, in the third quarter of 2010 which contributed $1.7 million in trust fees in 2010. In addition, operating lease income declined by $1.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010 due to the decline in the balance of operating equipment leases. The Company no longer focuses on this product. Other non-interest income declined by $0.4 million for the year ended 2011 compared to 2010 mostly due to a gain from the sale of Premier Trust in the third quarter of 2010. In addition, the Company recognized a one-time gain on extinguishment of the remaining subordinated debt in the second quarter of 2010 of $3.0 million.

 

37


Table of Contents

Comparison of non-interest income for 2010 to 2009

The following table presents non-interest income for the periods presented:

      Year Ended December 31,  
      2010     2009     Increase
(Decrease)
 
     (in thousands)  

Net securities impairment charges

   $ (1,186   $ (43,784   $ 42,598   

Gain on sales of investment securities, net

     19,757        16,100        3,657   

Service charges

     8,969        8,172        797   

Trust and investment advisory services

     4,003        9,287        (5,284

Operating lease income

     3,793        4,066        (273

Other fee revenue

     3,324        2,754        570   

Income from bank owned life insurance

     3,299        2,193        1,106   

Gain on extinguishment of debt

     3,000        —          3,000   

Mark to market (loss) gain, net

     (369     3,631        (4,000

Derivative losses, net

     (269     (263     (6

Other

     2,515        2,279        236   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-interest income

   $ 46,836      $ 4,435      $ 42,401   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-interest income increased for the year ended December 31, 2010 compared to 2009 mostly due to the $42.6 million decrease in security impairment charges. In 2010, the Company recorded $1.2 million of other then temporary impairment charges (“OTTI”) related to its collateralized mortgage debt securities. In 2009, the Company recorded $43.8 million OTTI on its investment securities. These impairment charges included $36.4 million related to impairment losses in the Company’s adjustable rate preferred stock (“ARPS”), $3.4 million related to impairment losses to the Company’s collateralized debt obligations (“CDO”) portfolio and $4.0 million related to the Company’s collateralized mortgage obligation (“CMO”) portfolio. Net gains from investment securities sales increased by $3.7 million for the comparable twelve month periods 2010 to 2009. The increase in gains on sales of securities for 2010 compared to 2009 was mostly due to previously impaired securities which had improvements in price and were sold to reduce the percentage of classified securities in the Company’s portfolio. The Company also recognized a $3.0 million gain on the repayment of its subordinated debt during 2010. Partially offsetting this increased income was a decrease of $5.3 million in trust and advisory service fees as a result of the divestitures of MRA at the end of 2009 and Premier Trust in September of 2010.

Non-interest Expense

The following table presents a summary of non-interest expenses for the periods presented:

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
      2011      2010      Increase
(Decrease)
 
     (in thousands)  

Non-interest expense:

        

Salaries and employee benefits

   $ 93,140       $ 86,586       $ 6,554   

Occupancy

     19,972         19,580         392   

Net loss on sales/valuations of repossessed assets and bank premises, net

     24,592         28,826         (4,234

Insurance

     11,045         15,475         (4,430

Loan and repossessed asset expense

     8,126         8,076         50   

Legal, professional and director fees

     7,678         7,591         87   

Marketing

     4,676         4,061         615   

Data processing

     3,566         3,374         192   

Intangible amortization

     3,559         3,604         (45

Customer service

     3,336         4,256         (920

Operating lease depreciation

     1,201         2,506         (1,305

Other

     14,707         12,823         1,884   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-interest expense

   $ 195,598       $ 196,758       $ (1,160
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-interest expense decreased $1.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to the same period in 2010. The decrease in non-interest expense was mostly related to a decrease in insurance expense and a net decrease in repossessed assets valuations and sales. Insurance expense declined due to the reduced FDIC insurance premiums

 

38


Table of Contents

for the comparable periods of $4.4 million, or 33.2% from $13.4 million for 2010 to $8.9 million for 2011. For the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010, other real estate owned (“OREO”) valuation write-downs decreased by $4.8 million, net loss on sales of OREO increased by $0.6 million and net loss on sale of assets and other repossessed assets remained flat at $0.7 million primarily due to a decline in the number of new OREO properties and in the number of OREO and assets sold. Operating lease depreciation continued to decline as the Company no longer focuses on operating equipment leases. Customer service expense declined by $0.9 million primarily due to decreased customer data processing expense which was $2.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 compared to $2.3 million in 2011. Total salaries and benefits increased by $6.6 million for the year ended 2011 compared to 2010 due to increased variable performance based compensation from changes to incentive plans based on strategic initiatives which were achieved in 2011. Marketing expenses increased $0.6 million mostly due to increased charitable contributions of $0.4 million and business development costs of $0.3 million for the comparable year 2011 to 2010. Other expense increased by $1.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010 mostly due to increased off-balance sheet reserve provision of $0.9 million, travel expense of $0.6 million and accounting and audit fees of $0.4 million. Occupancy expense increased by $0.4 million for 2011 compared to 2010 as a result of increased equipment and building maintenance costs of $0.9 million and increased building rent of $0.4 million partially off-set by decreased depreciation expense of $0.9 million.

Comparison of non-interest expense for 2010 to 2009

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
      2010      2009      Increase
(Decrease)
 
     (in thousands)  

Non-interest expense:

        

Salaries and employee benefits

   $ 86,586       $ 91,504       $ (4,918

Occupancy

     19,580         20,802         (1,222

Net loss on sales/valuations of repossessed assets and bank premises, net

     28,826         21,274         7,552   

Insurance

     15,475         12,525         2,950   

Loan and respossessed asset expense

     8,076         6,363         1,713   

Legal, professional and director fees

     7,591         8,973         (1,382

Customer service

     4,256         4,290         (34

Marketing

     4,061         4,915         (854

Data processing

     3,374         4,274         (900

Intangible amortization

     3,604         3,781         (177

Operating lease depreciation

     2,506         3,229         (723

Goodwill impairment charges

     —           49,671         (49,671

Other

     12,823         11,376         1,447   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-interest expense

   $ 196,758       $ 242,977       $ (46,219
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-interest expense declined $46.2 million, or 19.0% for the year ended 2010 compared to 2009. This decrease is primarily the result of the $49.7 million decrease in goodwill impairment charges as there was no goodwill impairment recognized in 2010. In 2009, the Company recorded $45.0 million in goodwill impairment at its BON subsidiary, $4.1 million at its Shine subsidiary and $0.6 million at its former MRA subsidiary. Net of increased costs related to asset quality issues and insurance of $12.2 million due to an increase in other real estate owned and problem loan workout activity during 2010, the Company’s other non-interest expense categories decreased by $8.8 million. The Company was diligent with cost saving strategies in 2010 and also reduced headcount from 930 full time equivalent employees to 908 contributing to the $4.9 million decline in salary and employee benefit costs.

 

39


Table of Contents

Income Taxes

The reconciliation between the statutory federal income tax rate and the Company’s effective tax rate are summarized as follows:

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands)  

Income tax at statutory rate

   $ 17,619      $ (3,703   $ (64,873

Increase (decrease) resulting from:

      

State income taxes, net of federal benefits

     1,411        (739     (1,641

Dividends received deductions

     (900     (476     (442

Bank-owned life insurance

     (1,431     (1,155     (767

Tax-exempt income

     (867     (280     (338

Nondeductible expenses

     276        340        445   

Nondeductible goodwill impairment

     —          —          17,385   

Deferred tax asset valuation allowance

     —          (2,033     6,200   

Restricted stock write off

     617        1,259        2,057   

Other, net

     124        377        3,521   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 16,849      $ (6,410   $ (38,453
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The effective tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2011 was 32.8% compared to 54.4% for the year ended December 31, 2010. This decrease in the effective tax rate on the tax benefit from the prior year was primarily due to the favorable tax impact of securities yielding dividends received deductions, tax exempt income, bank owned life insurance and because all bank subsidiaries were profitable.

Business Segment Results

Bank of Nevada reported net income of $7.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to a net loss of $26.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. The increase in income for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to 2010 was primarily due to decreased provision for credit losses of $47.0 million. Total deposits at Bank of Nevada decreased by $11.0 million to $2.38 billion at December 31, 2011 compared to $2.39 billion at December 31, 2010. Total loans decreased $55.0 million to $1.86 billion at December 31, 2011 compared to 2010.

Western Alliance Bank, which consists of Alliance Bank of Arizona operating in Arizona and First Independent Bank operating in Northern Nevada, reported a net income of $19.8 million and $12.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. The increase in net income for the year ended December 31, 2011 from the year ended December 31, 2010 was mostly due to increased interest income of $9.7 million, decreased interest expense of $3.7 million and decreased non-interest expense of $1.8 million, partially offset by increased provision for credit losses of $3.7 million, decreased non-interest income of $2.0 million and increased income tax expense of $2.7 million. During 2011, total loans at Western Alliance Bank grew $339.5 million to $1.64 billion from $1.31 billion at December 31, 2010. In addition, total deposits grew by $206.4 million to $1.88 billion at December 31, 2011.

Torrey Pines Bank segment, which excludes discontinued operations, reported net income of $19.5 million and $10.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. The increase in net income for the year ended December 31, 2011 from the year ended December 31, 2010 was the result of increased net interest income of $13.4 million, decreased provision for credit losses of $3.7 million, increased non-interest income of $0.6 million partially offset by increased non-interest expense of $2.7 million and income tax expense of $5.9 million. Total loans at Torrey Pines Bank increased by $255.1 million to $1.32 billion at December 31, 2011 from $1.06 billion at December 31, 2010. Total deposits increased by $135.2 million during 2011 to $1.42 billion at December 31, 2011.

The other segment, which includes the holding company, Shine, Western Alliance Equipment Finance, the discontinued operations related to the affinity credit card platform, and Premier Trust (through September 1, 2010), reported a net loss of $15.3 million and $3.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. The increase in the net loss for the comparable years is primarily due to decreased gains from investment security sales of $11.6 million.

BALANCE SHEET ANALYSIS

Total assets increased $650.7 million, or 10.5%, to $6.84 billion at December 31, 2011 compared to $6.19 billion at December 31, 2010. The majority of the increase was in loans of $539.5 million, or 12.7%, to $4.78 billion. Investment securities increased by $247.8 million as the Company invested excess liquidity and changed the mix of the portfolio.

 

40


Table of Contents

Total liabilities increased $616.1 million, or 11.0% to $6.21 billion at December 31, 2011 from $5.59 billion at December 31, 2010. Total deposits increased by $320.1 million or 6.0% to $5.66 billion at December 31, 2011 from $5.34 billion at December 31, 2010. Non-interest bearing demand deposits increased by $115.0 million, or 8.0%, to $1.56 billion at December 31, 2011 from $1.44 billion at December 31, 2010.

Total stockholders’ equity increased by $34.5 million to $636.7 million at December 31, 2011 from $602.2 million at December 31, 2010.

The following table shows the amounts of loans outstanding by type of loan at the end of each of the periods indicated.

 

      December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

   $ 2,553,354      $ 2,261,638      $ 2,024,624      $ 1,763,392      $ 1,514,533   

Construction and land development

     381,676        451,470        623,198        820,874        806,110   

Commercial and industrial

     1,336,582        934,627        802,193        860,280        784,378   

Residential real estate

     443,020        527,302        568,319        589,196        492,551   

Consumer

     72,504        71,545        80,300        71,148        43,517   

Net deferred loan fees

     (7,067     (6,040     (18,995     (9,179     (8,080
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross loans, net of deferred fees

     4,780,069        4,240,542        4,079,639        4,095,711        3,633,009   

Less: allowance for credit losses

     (99,170     (110,699     (108,623     (74,827     (49,305
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total loans, net

   $ 4,680,899      $ 4,129,843      $ 3,971,016      $ 4,020,884      $ 3,583,704   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table sets forth the amount of loans outstanding by type of loan as of December 31, 2011 that were contractually due in one year or less, more than one year and less than five years, and more than five years based on remaining scheduled repayments of principal. Lines of credit or other loans having no stated final maturity and no stated schedule of repayments are reported as due in one year or less. The tables also present an analysis of the rate structure for loans within the same maturity time periods. Actual cash flows from these loans may differ materially from contractual maturities due to prepayment, refinancing or other factors.

 

      December 31, 2011  
      Due in one
year or less
     Due after one
year to five
years
     Due after
five years
     Total  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate — owner occupied

           

Floating rate

   $ 18,068       $ 143,089       $ 564,693       $ 725,850   

Fixed rate

     42,230         214,986         269,116         526,332   

Commercial real estate — non-owner occupied

           

Floating rate

     61,858         305,189         328,144         695,191   

Fixed rate

     80,452         409,763         108,699         598,914   

Commercial and industrial

           

Floating rate

     503,146         231,306         47,295         781,747   

Fixed rate

     67,003         207,981         63,376         338,360   

Leases

           

Floating rate

     —           1,749         4,274         6,023   

Fixed rate

     20,172         123,751         66,529         210,452   

Construction and land development

           

Floating rate

     135,676         91,883         13,896         241,455   

Fixed rate

     53,144         73,868         13,209         140,221   

Residential real estate

           

Floating rate

     19,657         32,101         323,822         375,580   

Fixed rate

     6,248         16,034         45,158         67,440   

Consumer

           

Floating rate

     60,328         459         175         60,962   

Fixed rate

     4,770         6,442         330         11,542   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,072,752       $ 1,858,601       $ 1,848,716       $ 4,780,069   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

41


Table of Contents

As of December 31, 2011, approximately $2.1 billion or 73.5%, of total variable rate loans were subject to rate floors with a weighted average interest rate of 5.92%. At December 31, 2011, total loans consisted of 60.4% with floating rates and 39.6% with fixed rates.

Concentrations of Lending Activities

The Company’s lending activities are primarily driven by the customers served in the market areas where the Company has branch offices in the states of Nevada, California and Arizona. The Company monitors concentrations within five broad categories: geography, industry, product, call code, and collateral. The Company grants commercial, construction, real estate and consumer loans to customers through branch offices located in the Company’s primary markets. The Company’s business is concentrated in these areas and the loan portfolio includes significant credit exposure to the commercial real estate market of these areas. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, commercial real estate related loans accounted for approximately 61% and 64% of total loans, respectively, and approximately 2% of commercial real estate loans, for each year, are secured by undeveloped land. Substantially all of these loans are secured by first liens with an initial loan to value ratio of generally not more than 75%. Approximately 49% and 54% of these commercial real estate loans were owner occupied at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. In addition, approximately 4% and 3% of total loans were unsecured as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.

Interest Reserves. Interest reserves are generally established at the time of the loan origination as an expense item in the budget for a construction and land development loan. The Company’s practice is to monitor the construction, sales and/or leasing progress to determine the feasibility of ongoing construction and development projects. If, at any time during the life of the loan, the project is determined not to be viable, the Company discontinues the use of the interest reserve and may take appropriate action to protect its collateral position via renegotiation and/or legal action as deemed appropriate. At December 31, 2011, the Company had 18 loans with an outstanding balance of $28.0 million with available interest reserves of $0.5 million. In instances where projects have been determined unviable, the interest reserves have been frozen. This is a decrease from 26 loans at December 31, 2010 with an outstanding principal balance of $46.7 million and available interest reserve amounts of $1.2 million.

Impaired loans

A loan is identified as impaired when it is probable that interest and principal will not be collected according to the contractual terms of the original loan agreement. These loans generally have balances greater than $250,000 and are rated substandard or worse. An exception to this would be any known impaired loans regardless of balance. Most impaired loans are classified as nonaccrual. However, there are some loans that are termed impaired due to doubt regarding collectability according to contractual terms, but are both fully secured by collateral and are current in their interest and principal payments. These impaired loans are not classified as nonaccrual. Impaired loans are measured for reserve requirements in accordance with ASC Topic 310, Receivables, based on the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate or, as a practical expedient, at the loan’s observable market price or the fair value of the collateral less applicable disposition costs if the loan is collateral dependent. The amount of an impairment reserve, if any, and any subsequent changes are charged against the allowance for credit losses.

Total nonaccrual loans and loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing decreased by $25.5 million, or 21.5%, at December 31, 2011 to $93.0 million from $118.5 million at December 31, 2010. During 2011, total impaired loans decreased 12.1%, from $238.3 million at December 31, 2010 to $209.5 million at December 31, 2011.

 

      December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Total nonaccrual loans

   $ 90,392      $ 116,999      $ 153,702      $ 58,302      $ 17,873   

Loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing

     2,589        1,458        5,538        11,515        779   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonaccural and 90 past due still accruing

     92,981        118,457        159,240        69,817        18,652   

Restructured loans

     112,483        116,696        46,480        15,605        3,782   

Other impaired loans

     4,027        3,182        27,752        92,981        12,680   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans

   $ 209,491      $ 238,335      $ 233,472      $ 178,403      $ 35,114   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other assets acquired through foreclosure

   $ 89,104      $ 107,655      $ 83,347      $ 14,545      $ 3,412   

Nonaccrual loans to gross loans

     1.89     2.76     3.77     1.42     0.49

Loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing to total loans

     0.05        0.03        0.14        0.28        0.02   

Interest income received on nonaccrual loans, cash basis

   $ 444      $ 2,501      $ 624      $ 488      $ 30   

Interest income that would have been recorded under the original terms of nonaccrual loans

   $ 6,331      $ 6,016      $ 8,713      $ 1,827      $ 765   

 

42


Table of Contents

The composite of nonaccrual loans were as follows:

 

      At December 31, 2011     At December 31, 2010  
      Nonaccrual
Balance
     %     Percent of
Total Loans
    Nonaccrual
Balance
     %     Percent of
Total Loans
 
     (dollars in thousands)  

Construction and land

   $ 28,813         31.88     0.60   $ 36,523         31.22     0.86

Residential real estate

     15,747         17.42     0.33     32,638         27.90     0.76

Commercial real estate

     38,019         42.05     0.80     40,257         34.40     0.95

Commercial and industrial

     7,410         8.20     0.16     7,349         6.28     0.17

Consumer

     403         0.45     0.01     232         0.20     0.01
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total nonaccrual loans

   $ 90,392         100.00     1.90   $ 116,999         100.00     2.76
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, nonaccrual loans totaled $90.4 million and $117.0 million, respectively. Nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2011 consisted of multiple customer relationships with no single customer relationship having a principal balance greater than $10.0 million. Nonaccrual loans by bank at December 31, 2011 were $69.0 million at Bank of Nevada, $16.2 million at Western Alliance Bank and $5.2 million at Torrey Pines Bank. Nonaccrual loans as a percentage of total gross loans were 1.89% and 2.76% at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Nonaccrual loans as a percentage of each bank’s total gross loans were 3.71% at Bank of Nevada, 0.98% at Western Alliance Bank and 0.39% at Torrey Pines Bank. Total lost interest on nonaccrual loans for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 was $6.3 million and $6.0 million, respectively.

Troubled Debt Restructured Loans

A troubled debt restructured loan is a loan on which the Bank, for reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, grants a concession to the borrower that the Bank would not otherwise consider. The loan terms that have been modified or restructured due to a borrower’s financial situation include, but are not limited to, a reduction in the stated interest rate, an extension of the maturity or renewal of the loan at an interest rate below current market, a reduction in the face amount of the debt, a reduction in the accrued interest, extensions, deferrals, renewals and rewrites. A troubled debt restructured loan is also considered impaired. Generally, a loan that is modified at an effective market rate of interest may no longer be disclosed as a troubled debt restructuring in years subsequent to the restructuring if it is not impaired based on the terms specified by the restructuring agreement.

As of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, the aggregate amount of loans classified as impaired was $209.5 million and $238.3 million, respectively. The total specific allowance for loan losses related to these loans was $10.4 million and $13.4 million for December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. As of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, we had $112.5 million and $116.7 million, respectively, in loans classified as accruing restructured loans. The net decrease in impaired loans is primarily attributable to the declined impaired commercial real estate and residential real estate loans, which were $123.9 million and $42.4 million, respectively, at December 31, 2010 compared to $90.7 million and $28.8 million, respectively, at December 31, 2011, a decrease of $33.2 million and $13.6 million, respectively. Impaired construction and land, commercial and industrial and consumer loans increased from $58.4 million, $12.8 million and $0.7 million, respectively, at December 31, 2010, to $61.9 million, $25.7 million and $2.3 million, respectively, at December 31, 2011.

The following tables present a breakdown of total impaired loans and the related specific reserves for the periods indicated:

 

      At December 31, 2011  
      Impaired
Balance
     Percent     Percent of
Total Loans
    Reserve
Balance
     Percent     Percent of
Total Allowance
 
     (dollars in thousands)  

Construction and land development

   $ 61,911         29.55     1.30   $ 3,501         33.74     3.53

Residential real estate

     28,850         13.77     0.60     2,186         21.07     2.20

Commercial real estate

     90,712         43.31     1.90     2,827         27.25     2.85

Commercial and industrial

     25,730         12.28     0.54     1,863         17.95     1.88

Consumer

     2,288         1.09     0.05     —           0.00     0.00
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans

   $ 209,491         100.00     4.39   $ 10,377         100.00     10.46
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

43


Table of Contents
      At December 31, 2010  
      Impaired
Balance
     Percent     Percent of
Total Loans
    Reserve
Balance
     Percent     Percent of
Total Allowance
 
     (dollars in thousands)  

Construction and land development

   $ 58,415         24.51     1.38   $ 2,846         21.18     2.57

Residential real estate

     42,423         17.80     1.00     2,716         20.21     2.45

Commercial real estate

     123,939         52.00     2.92     4,582         34.08     4.14

Commercial and industrial

     12,803         5.37     0.30     3,170         23.59     2.86

Consumer

     755         0.32     0.02     126         0.94     0.11
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans

   $ 238,335         100.00     5.62   $ 13,440         100.00     12.14
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

The amount of interest income recognized on impaired loans for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was approximately $8.0 million, $7.6 million and $10.5 million, respectively.

Allowance for Credit Losses

The following table summarizes the activity in our allowance for credit losses for the period indicated.

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Allowance for credit losses:

          

Balance at beginning of period

   $ 110,699      $ 108,623      $ 74,827      $ 49,305      $ 33,551   

Provisions charged to operating expenses :

          

Construction and land development

     2,692        11,405        35,697        25,714        7,884   

Commercial real estate

     21,959        49,582        20,935        3,850        4,446   

Residential real estate

     16,256        15,116        36,199        15,151        1,504   

Commercial and industrial

     1,109        13,117        49,060        19,829        9,221   

Consumer

     4,172        3,991        7,208        3,645        623   

Other

     —          —          —          —          (3,419
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Provision

     46,188        93,211        149,099        68,189        20,259   

Acquisitions

     —          —          —          —          3,419   

Recoveries of loans previously charged-off:

          

Construction and land development

     2,154        3,197        1,708        32        —     

Commercial real estate

     2,157        1,003        230        3        —     

Residential real estate

     1,060        2,039        545        43        —     

Commercial and industrial

     3,401        3,000        1,529        533        213   

Consumer

     174        164        173        37        49   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total recoveries

     8,946        9,403        4,185        648        262   

Loans charged-off:

          

Construction and land development

     11,238        23,623        35,807        16,715        2,361   

Commercial real estate

     22,128        33,821        16,756        2,912        —     

Residential real estate

     19,071        20,663        24,082        6,643        49   

Commercial and industrial

     9,757        17,218        38,573        15,937        5,304   

Consumer

     4,469        5,213        4,270        1,108        472   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total charged-off

     66,663        100,538        119,488        43,315        8,186   

Net charge-offs

     57,717        91,135        115,303        42,667        7,924   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at end of period

   $ 99,170      $ 110,699      $ 108,623      $ 74,827      $ 49,305   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net charge-offs to average loans outstanding

     1.32     2.22     2.86     1.10     0.23

Allowance for credit losses to gross loans

     2.07     2.61     2.66     1.83     1.36

 

44


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes the allocation of the allowance for credit losses by loan type. However, allocation of a portion of the allowance to one category of loans does not preclude its availability to absorb losses in other categories:

 

      December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  
     (dollars in thousands)  
      Amount      % of
Loans in
Each
Category
to Gross
Loans
    Amount      % of
Loans in
Each
Category
to Gross
Loans
    Amount      % of
Loans in
Each
Category
to Gross
Loans
    Amount      % of
Loans in
Each
Category
to Gross
Loans
    Amount      % of
Loans in
Each
Category
to Gross
Loans
 

Construction and land development

   $ 14,195         8.0   $ 20,587         10.6   $ 29,608         15.2   $ 28,010         20.0   $ 18,979         22.1

Real estate:

                         

Commercial

     35,031         53.3        33,043         53.3        16,279         49.4        11,870         42.9        10,929         41.6   

Residential

     19,134         9.3        20,889         12.4        24,397         13.9        11,735         14.4        3,184         13.5   

Commercial and industrial

     25,535         27.9        30,782         22.0        31,883         19.6        19,867         21.0        15,442         21.5   

Consumer

     5,275         1.5        5,398         1.7        6,456         2.0        3,345         1.7        771         1.3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 99,170         100.0   $ 110,699         100.0   $ 108,623         100.0   $ 74,827         100.0   $ 49,305         100.0
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The allowance for credit losses as a percentage of total loans decreased to 2.07% at December 31, 2011 from 2.61% at December 31, 2010 and decreased from 2.66% at December 31, 2009. The Company’s credit loss reserve at December 31, 2011 decreased to $99.2 million from $110.7 million at December 31, 2010 mostly due to improvement in credit quality and change in the portfolio mix.

Potential Problem Loans

The Company classifies loans consistent with federal banking regulations using a nine category grading system. These loan grades are described in further detail in Item 1, “Business” of this Form 10-K. The following table presents information regarding potential problem loans, consisting of loans graded watch, substandard, doubtful, and loss, but still performing:

 

      At December 31, 2011  
      Number
of Loans
     Loan
Balance
     Percent     Percent of
Total Loans
 
     (dollars in thousands)  

Construction and land development

     11       $ 6,212         4.04     0.13

Commercial real estate

     83         104,455         67.87     2.19

Residential real estate

     42         12,751         8.28     0.27

Commercial and industrial

     111         28,751         18.68     0.60

Consumer

     9         1,746         1.13     0.04
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     256       $ 153,915         100.00     3.23
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total potential problem loans are primarily secured by real estate.

Investment securities

Investment securities are classified at the time of acquisition as either held-to-maturity, available-for-sale, or trading based upon various factors, including asset/liability management strategies, liquidity and profitability objectives, and regulatory requirements. Held-to-maturity securities are carried at amortized cost, adjusted for amortization of premiums or accretion of discounts. Available-for-sale securities are securities that may be sold prior to maturity based upon asset/liability management decisions. Investment securities identified as available-for-sale are carried at fair value. Unrealized gains or losses on available-for-sale securities are recorded as accumulated other comprehensive income in stockholders’ equity. Amortization of premiums or accretion of discounts on mortgage-backed securities is periodically adjusted for estimated prepayments. Investment securities measured at fair value are reported at fair value, with unrealized gains and losses included in current period earnings.

 

45


Table of Contents

The investment securities portfolio of the Company is utilized as collateral for borrowings, required collateral for public deposits and customer repurchase agreements, and to manage liquidity, capital and interest rate risk.

The following table summarizes the carrying value of the investment securities portfolio:

 

      At December 31,  
     2011      2010      2009  
     (in thousands)  

U.S. Government sponsored agency securities

   $ 156,211       $ 280,103       $ 2,479   

Municipal obligations

     187,509         1,677         5,380   

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     54,676         67,243         18,296   

Mutual funds

     28,864         —           —     

Corporate bonds

     107,360         49,907         71,190   

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     871,099         781,179         655,073   

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     25,784         8,111         18,175   

CRA investments

     25,015         23,743         17,189   

Trust preferred securities

     21,159         23,126         22,050   

Private label commercial mortgage-backed securities

     5,431         —           —     

Collateralized debt obligations

     50         276         918   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investment securities

   $ 1,483,158       $ 1,235,365       $ 810,750   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Weighted average yield is calculated by dividing income within each maturity range by the outstanding amount of the related investment and has not been tax affected on tax-exempt obligations. Securities available for sale are carried at amortized cost in the table below for purposes of calculating the weighted average yield received on such securities. The maturity distribution and weighted average yield of our investment security portfolios at December 31, 2011 are summarized in the table below:

 

      December 31, 2011  
      Due Under 1 Year
Amount/Yield
    Due 1-5 Years
Amount/Yield
    Due 5-10 Years
Amount/Yield
    Due Over 10 Years
Amount/Yield
    Total
Amount/Yield
 
     (dollars in thousands)  

Available-for-sale

                         

Municipal obligations

   $ —           0.00   $ —           0.00   $ 56         5.90   $ 5,530         3.93   $ 5,586         3.95

U.S. Government-sponsered agency securities

     —           0.00        10,013         2.38        109,253         2.08        36,945         2.68        156,211         2.24   

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     1,020         6.70        5,190         4.12        14,215         8.73        34,251         5.74        54,676         6.38   

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     —           0.00        —           0.00        —           0.00        864,584         2.14        864,584         2.14   

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     —           0.00        —           0.00        11,897         2.57        13,887         4.09        25,784         3.39   

Private label commercial mortgage-backed securities

     —           0.00        5,431         3.16        —           0.00        —           0.00        5,431         3.16   

Trust preferred securities

     —           0.00        —           0.00        —           0.00        21,159         1.35        21,159         1.35   

Mutual funds

     28,864         4.52        —           0.00        —           0.00        —           0.00        28,864         4.52   

Corporate bonds

     —           0.00        —           0.00        —           0.00        4,575         5.00        4,575         5.00   

CRA investments

     23,515         3.59        —           0.00        —           0.00        —           0.00        23,515         3.59   
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total

   $ 53,399         4.15   $ 20,634         3.02   $ 135,421         2.82   $ 980,931         2.32   $ 1,190,385         2.47
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Held-to-maturity

                         

Municipal obligations

   $ —           0.00   $ 734         4.70   $ 24,618         2.86   $ 156,571         3.33   $ 181,923         3.27

Corporate bonds

     —           0.00        7,655         3.47        90,130         5.22        5,000         5.00        102,785         5.08   

Collateralized debt obligations

     —           0.00        —           0.00        —           0.00        50         0.00        50         0.00   

CRA investments

     1,500         0.00        —           0.00        —           0.00        —           0.00        1,500         0.00   
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total

   $ 1,500         0.00   $ 8,389         3.58      $ 114,748         4.71   $ 161,621         3.38   $ 286,258         3.90
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Measured at fair value

                         

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

   $ —           0.00   $ 7         1.45   $ 1,017         5.37   $ 5,491         4.00   $ 6,515         4.21
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

The Company does not own any subprime MBS in its investment portfolio. The majority of its MBS are GSE issued. The remaining MBS not GSE issued consist of $13.3 million rated AAA, $4.1 million rated AA, $6.4 million rated A, and $1.9 million are non-investment grade.

Gross unrealized losses at December 31, 2011 are primarily caused by interest rate fluctuations, credit spread widening and reduced liquidity in applicable markets. The Company has reviewed securities on which there is an unrealized loss in accordance with its accounting policy for other then temporary impaired (“OTTI”) described in Note 3, Investment Securities, and recorded impairment charges totaling $0.2 million and $1.2 million for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. For both 2011 and 2010, the impairment charges related to unrealized losses in the Company’s CDO portfolio.

 

46


Table of Contents

The Company does not consider any other securities to be other-than-temporarily impaired as of December 31, 2011 and 2010. However, the Company cannot guarantee that additional OTTI will not occur in future periods. At December 31, 2011, the Company had the intent and ability to retain its investments for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value.

Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

The Company had no goodwill impairment in 2011 or 2010. Total goodwill impairment for the year ended December 31, 2009 was $49.7 million. The Company utilizes three general approaches to the valuation testing: the asset-based approach, the market approach and the income approach. Specifically, the Company used the capitalized earnings, capitalized tangible book value, core deposit premium plus tangible book value, and discounted cash flow calculations in the valuation analysis based on available market and Company information. In addition, the Company included a market capitalization analysis in the calculation of goodwill impairment.

The Company tests for impairment of goodwill as of October 1 of each year, and again at a quarter-end if any triggering events occur during a quarter that may affect goodwill. For this testing, the Company typically works together with a third-party valuation firm to perform a “Step 1” test for potential goodwill impairment of the Company’s bank subsidiaries. At October 1, 2011, it was determined that the both Bank of Nevada and Shine passed Step 1 of the testing.

The Company determined at the conclusion of its Step 1 analysis that the fair value of the goodwill in the Bank of Nevada reporting unit exceeded its carrying value of $23.2 million and that no impairment of goodwill existed at the testing date.

During the first quarter of 2009, the Company determined that it was necessary to perform an interim test for goodwill impairment on the Bank of Nevada reporting unit. As a result of this goodwill impairment test, the Company determined that the Bank of Nevada reporting unit was impaired by $45.0 million. During the third quarter of 2009, the Company performed an interim test of goodwill on its former subsidiary Miller/Russell and Associates, Inc. As a result of this goodwill impairment test, the Company determined that the Miller/Russell and Associates, Inc. reporting unit was impaired by $0.6 million. At the end of 2009, the Company recorded a $4.1 million impairment charge for Shine.

The goodwill impairment charges had no effect on the Company’s cash balances or liquidity. In addition, because goodwill is not included in the calculation of regulatory capital, the Company’s regulatory ratios were not affected by these non-cash expenses. No assurance can be given that goodwill will not be further impaired in future periods.

Other Intangibles

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010  

Core Deposit Intangibles:

    

Balance, beginning of year

   $ 11,550      $ 14,988   

Amortization

     (3,438     (3,438
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

   $ 8,112      $ 11,550   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010  

Other Intangibles:

    

Balance, beginning of year

   $ 1,816      $ 2,208   

Amortization

     (121     (166

Sale of premier trust

     —          (226
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

   $ 1,695      $ 1,816   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

47


Table of Contents

Deposits

The average balances and weighted average rates paid on deposits for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 are presented below.

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
      2011 Average
Balance/Rate
    2010 Average
Balance/Rate
    2009 Average
Balance/Rate
 
     (dollars in thousands)  

Interest checking (NOW)

   $ 478,345         0.37   $ 581,063         0.50   $ 303,388         1.06

Savings and money market

     2,105,316         0.61        1,861,668         0.90        1,666,728         1.61   

Time

     1,460,690         0.91        1,437,234         1.51        1,280,381         2.48   
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total interest-bearing deposits

     4,044,351         0.69        3,879,965         1.07        3,250,497         1.90   

Noninterest bearing demand deposits

     1,509,363         —          1,296,634         —          1,070,011         —     
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total deposits

   $ 5,553,714         0.50   $ 5,176,599         0.80   $ 4,320,508         1.43
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total deposits increased to $5.66 billion at December 31, 2011, from $5.34 billion at December 31, 2010, an increase of $320.1 million or 6.0%. This increase was primarily from money market accounts, non-interest bearing demand deposits, savings and broker interest bearing deposits which increased by $161.3 million, $115.0 million, $45.5 million and $34.6 million, respectively. Interest bearing demand deposits decreased by $41.8 million from December 31, 2011 to December 31, 2010. Deposits have historically been the primary source of funding the Company’s asset growth. In addition, all of the banking subsidiaries are members of Certificate of Deposit Registry Service (“CDARS”). CDARS provides a mechanism for obtaining FDIC insurance for large deposits. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company also had $34.6 million and $20.0 million, respectively, of other brokered deposits outstanding.

Certificates of Deposit of $100,000 or More

The table below discloses the remaining maturity for certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more:

 

      December 31,  
     2011      2010  
     (in thousands)  

3 months or less

   $ 544,964       $ 435,400   

3 to 6 months

     340,502         299,710   

6 to 12 months

     313,312         470,847   

Over 12 months

     89,903         70,412   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,288,681       $ 1,276,369   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other Assets Acquired Through Foreclosure

The following table represents the changes in other assets acquired through foreclosure:

 

      Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands)  

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 107,655      $ 83,347      $ 14,545   

Additions

     48,585        93,656        104,610   

Dispositions

     (47,366     (40,674     (17,858

Valuation adjustments in the period, net

     (19,770     (28,674     (17,950
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

   $ 89,104      $ 107,655      $ 83,347   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other assets acquired through foreclosure consist primarily of properties acquired as a result of, or in-lieu-of, foreclosure. Properties or other assets (primarily repossessed assets formerly leased) are classified as other real estate owned and other repossessed property and are reported at the lower of carrying value or fair value, less estimated costs to sell the

 

48


Table of Contents

property. Costs relating to the development or improvement of the assets are capitalized and costs relating to holding the assets are charged to expense. The Company had $89.1 million, $107.7 million and $83.3 million, respectively, of such assets at December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009. At December 31, 2011, the Company held approximately 83 other real estate owned properties compared to 98 at December 31, 2010. When significant adjustments were based on unobservable inputs, such as when a current appraised value is not available or management determines the fair value of the collateral is further impaired below appraised value and there is no observable market price, the resulting fair value measurement has been categorized as a Level 3 measurement.

Capital Resources

The Company and the Banks are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements could trigger certain mandatory or discretionary actions that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Company’s business and financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Company and the Banks must meet specific capital guidelines that involve qualitative measures of their assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and the Banks to maintain minimum amounts and ratios of total and Tier I capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier I leverage (as defined) to average assets (as defined). As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company and the Banks met all capital adequacy requirements to which they are subject.

As of December 31, 2011, the Company and each of its subsidiaries met the minimum capital ratio requirements necessary to be classified as well-capitalized, as defined by the banking agencies. To be categorized as well-capitalized, the Banks must maintain minimum total risk-based, Tier I risk-based and Tier I leverage ratios as set forth in the table below. In addition, the Memorandum of Understanding to which Bank of Nevada is subject may require it to maintain a higher Tier 1 leverage ratio than otherwise required to be considered well-capitalized. At December 31, 2011, the capital levels at Bank of Nevada exceeded this elevated requirement.

The actual capital amounts and ratios for the Banks and Company are presented in the following tables as of the periods indicated:

 

      Total
Capital
     Tier 1
Capital
     Risk-
Weighted
Assets
     Tangible
Average
Assets
     Total
Capital

Ratio
    Tier 1
Capital
Ratio
    Tier 1
Leverage
Ratio
 
     (dollars in thousands)  

December 31, 2011

                  

WAL (Consolidated)

   $ 723,327       $ 651,104       $ 5,749,818       $ 6,636,083         12.6     11.3     9.8

Bank of Nevada

     294,747         266,430         2,232,208         2,818,077         13.2     11.9     9.5

Western Alliance Bank

     231,360         188,328         1,944,738         2,128,033         11.9     9.7     8.9

Torrey Pines Bank

     183,772         151,058         1,541,878         1,641,500         11.9     9.8     9.2

Well-capitalized ratios

                 10.0     6.0     5.0

Minimum capital ratios

                 8.0     4.0     4.0

December 31, 2010

                  

WAL (Consolidated)

     654,011         591,633         4,941,057         6,198,903         13.2     12.0     9.5

Bank of Nevada

     278,697         250,907         2,177,357         2,705,631         12.8     11.5     9.3

Western Alliance Bank

     204,650         162,964         1,492,491         1,955,696         13.7     10.9     8.3

Torrey Pines Bank

     170,342         135,126         1,215,825         1,453,686         14.0     11.1     9.3

Well-capitalized ratios

                 10.0     6.0     5.0

Minimum capital ratios

                 8.0     4.0     4.0

Additionally, State of Nevada banking regulations restrict distribution of the net assets of Bank of Nevada because such regulations require the sum of the bank’s stockholders’ equity and reserve for loan losses to be at least 6% of the average of the bank’s total daily deposit liabilities for the preceding 60 days. As a result of these regulations, approximately $147.6 million and $145.2 million of Bank of Nevada’s stockholders’ equity was restricted at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

49


Table of Contents

JUNIOR SUBORDINATED AND SUBORDINATED DEBT

The Company has formed or acquired through mergers six statutory business trusts, which exist for the exclusive purpose of issuing Cumulative Trust Preferred Securities. All of the funds raised from the issuance of these securities were passed to the Company and are reflected in the accompanying balance sheet as junior subordinated debt in the amount of $37.0 million. The junior subordinated debt has contractual balances and maturity dates as follows:

 

            December 31,  
Name of Trust    Maturity      2011     2010  
            (in thousands)  

BankWest Nevada Capital Trust II

     2033       $ 15,464      $ 15,464   

Intermountain First Statutory Trust I

     2034         7,217        7,217   

WAL Trust No. 1

     2036         10,310        10,310   

First Independent Capital Trust I

     2034         20,619        20,619   

WAL Statutory Trust No. 2

     2037         5,155        5,155   

WAL Statutory Trust No. 3

     2037         7,732        7,732   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
      $ 66,497      $ 66,497   

Unrealized gains on trust preferred securities measured at fair value, net

        (29,512     (23,463
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
      $ 36,985      $ 43,034   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

The weighted average contractual rate of the junior subordinated debt was 3.61% and 4.34% as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

In the event of certain changes or amendments to regulatory requirements or Federal tax rules, the debt is redeemable in whole. The obligations under these instruments are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the Company and rank subordinate and junior in right of payment to all other liabilities of the Company. The trust preferred securities qualify as Tier 1 Capital for the Company, subject to certain limitations, with the excess being included in total capital for regulatory purposes.

Contractual Obligations and Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

The Company enters into contracts for services in the ordinary course of business that may require payment for services to be provided in the future and may contain penalty clauses for early termination of the contracts. To meet the financing needs of customers, the Company has financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk, including commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit. The Company has also committed to irrevocably and unconditionally guarantee the following payments or distributions with respect to the holders of preferred securities to the extent that BankWest Nevada Trust I, BankWest Nevada Trust II, Intermountain First Statutory Trust I, and WAL Trust No. 1 have not made such payments or distributions: (1) accrued and unpaid distributions, (2) the redemption price, and (3) upon a dissolution or termination of the trust, the lesser of the liquidation amount and all accrued and unpaid distributions and the amount of assets of the trust remaining available for distribution. The Company does not believe that these off-balance sheet arrangements have or are reasonably likely to have a material effect on its financial condition, changes in financial condition, revenues or expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures, or capital resources. However, there can be no assurance that such arrangements will not have a future effect.

 

50


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth our significant contractual obligations as of December 31, 2011.

 

      Payments Due by Period  
     (in thousands)  
      Total      Less Than
1 Year
     1-3
Years
     3-5
Years
     After
5 Years
 
     (in thousands)  

Time deposit maturities

   $ 1,450,933       $ 1,348,034       $ 101,322       $ 1,577       $ —     

Long-term borrowed funds

     75,000         —           —           75,000         —     

Junior subordinated deferrable interest debentures

     36,985         —           —           —           36,985   

Purchase obligations

     14,841         5,614         5,427         3,800         —     

Operating lease obligations

     25,407         4,923         7,644         5,494         7,346   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,603,166       $ 1,358,571       $ 114,393       $ 85,871       $ 44,331   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Off-balance sheet commitments associated with outstanding letters of credit, commitments to extend credit, and credit card guarantees as of December 31, 2011 are summarized below. Since commitments associated with letters of credit and commitments to extend credit may expire unused, the amounts shown do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements.

 

      Total      Amount of Commitment Expiration Per Period  

Other Commitments

   Amounts
Committed
     Less Than
1 Year
     1-3
Years
     3-5
Years
     After 5
Years
 
     (in thousands)  

Commitments to extend credit

   $ 863,120       $ 488,714       $ 171,473       $ 108,280       $ 94,653   

Credit card commitments and guarantees

     319,892         319,892         —           —           —     

Standby letters of credit

     34,768         —           34,608         160         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,217,780       $ 808,606       $ 206,081       $ 108,440       $ 94,653   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table sets forth certain information regarding FHLB and FRB advances and customer repurchase agreements.

 

      December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (dollars in thousands)  

FHLB and FRB Advances

      

Maximum month-end balance

   $ 280,000      $ 20,000      $ 635,500   

Balance at end of year

     280,000        —          —     

Average balance

     13,206        5,367        228,951   

Customer Repurchase Accounts:

      

Maximum month-end balance

     176,966        211,046        307,367   

Balance at end of year

     123,626        109,409        223,269   

Average balance

     148,412        126,511        279,477   

Total Short-Term Borrowed Funds

   $ 403,626      $ 109,409      $ 223,269   

Weighted average interest rate at end of year

     0.16     0.23     1.02

Weighted average interest rate during year

     0.20     0.81     0.99

Short-Term Borrowed Funds. The Company from time to time utilizes short-term borrowed funds to support short-term liquidity needs generally created by increased loan demand. The majority of these short-term borrowed funds consist of advances from the FHLB and FRB and customer repurchase agreements. The Company’s borrowing capacity at FHLB and FRB is determined based on collateral pledged, generally consisting of securities and loans. In addition, the Company has borrowing capacity from other sources pledged by securities, including securities sold under agreements to repurchase, which are reflected at the amount of cash received in connection with the transaction, and may require additional collateral based on the fair value of the underlying securities. At December 31, 2011, total short-term borrowed funds consisted of customer repurchases of $123.6 million and $280.0 million of FHLB advances. No advances were outstanding from the FRB at December 31, 2011. At December 31, 2010, total short-term borrowed funds consisted of $109.4 million of customer repurchases. The increase of $249.2 million in short-term borrowings for 2011 compared to 2010 was due to the Company’s increased lending in the fourth quarter.

 

51


Table of Contents

Critical Accounting Policies

The Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contain a discussion of our significant accounting policies, including information regarding recently issued accounting pronouncements, our adoption of such policies and the related impact of their adoption. We believe that certain of these policies, along with various estimates that we are required to make in recording our financial transactions, are important to have a complete understanding of our financial position. In addition, these estimates require us to make complex and subjective judgments, many of which include matters with a high degree of uncertainty. The following is a summary of these critical accounting policies and significant estimates.

Allowance for credit losses

Credit risk is inherent in the business of extending loans and leases to borrowers. Like other financial institutions, the Company must maintain an adequate allowance for credit losses. The allowance for credit losses is established through a provision for credit losses charged to expense. Loans are charged against the allowance for credit losses when Management believes that the contractual principal or interest will not be collected. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. The allowance is an amount believed adequate to absorb probable losses on existing loans that may become uncollectable, based on evaluation of the collectability of loans and prior credit loss experience, together with other factors. The Company formally re-evaluates and establishes the appropriate level of the allowance for credit losses on a quarterly basis.

The Company’s allowance for credit loss methodology incorporates several quantitative and qualitative risk factors used to establish the appropriate allowance for credit losses at each reporting date. Quantitative factors include our historical loss experience, delinquency and charge-off trends, collateral values, changes in the level of nonperforming loans and other factors. Qualitative factors include the economic condition of our operating markets and the state of certain industries. Specific changes in the risk factors are based on perceived risk of similar groups of loans classified by collateral type, purpose and terms. An internal one-year and three-year loss history are also incorporated into the allowance calculation model. Due to the credit concentration of our loan portfolio in real estate secured loans, the value of collateral is heavily dependent on real estate values in Nevada, Arizona and California, which have declined significantly in recent periods. While management uses the best information available to make its evaluation, future adjustments to the allowance may be necessary if there are significant changes in economic or other conditions. In addition, the FDIC and state bank regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their examination processes, periodically review our subsidiary banks’ allowances for credit losses, and may require the Company to make additions to our allowance based on their judgment about information available to them at the time of their examinations. Management regularly reviews the assumptions and formulae used in determining the allowance and makes adjustments if required to reflect the current risk profile of the portfolio.

The allowance consists of specific and general components. The specific allowance relates to impaired loans. In general, impaired loans include those where interest recognition has been suspended, loans that are more than 90 days delinquent but because of adequate collateral coverage, income continues to be recognized, and other criticized and classified loans not paying substantially according to the original contract terms. For such loans, an allowance is established when the discounted cash flows, collateral value or observable market price of the impaired loan are lower than the carrying value of that loan, pursuant to FASB ASC 310, Receivables (“ASC 310”). Loans not collateral dependent are evaluated based on the expected future cash flows discounted at the original contractual interest rate. The amount to which the present value falls short of the current loan obligation will be set up as a reserve for that account or charged-off.

The Company uses an appraised value method to determine the need for a reserve on impaired, collateral dependent loans and further discounts the appraisal for disposition costs. Due to the rapidly changing economic and market conditions of the regions within which we operate, the Company obtains independent collateral valuation analysis on a regular basis for each loan, typically every nine months.

The general allowance covers all non-impaired loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for the various qualitative and quantitative factors listed above. The change in the allowance from one reporting period to the next may not directly correlate to the rate of change of the nonperforming loans for the following reasons:

1. A loan moving from impaired performing to impaired nonperforming does not mandate an increased reserve. The individual account is evaluated for a specific reserve requirement when the loan moves to impaired status, not when it moves to nonperforming status, and is reevaluated at each subsequent reporting period. Because our nonperforming loans are predominately collateral dependent, reserves are primarily based on collateral value, which is not affected by borrower performance but rather by market conditions.

2. Not all impaired accounts require a specific reserve. The payment performance of the borrower may require an impaired classification, but the collateral evaluation may support adequate collateral coverage. For a number of impaired accounts in which borrower performance has ceased, the collateral coverage is now sufficient because a partial charge off of the account has been taken. In those instances, neither a general reserve nor a specific reserve is assessed.

 

52


Table of Contents

Investment securities

Investment securities may be classified as held-to-maturity (“HTM”), available-for-sale (“AFS”) or trading. The appropriate classification is initially decided at the time of purchase. Securities classified as held-to-maturity are those debt securities the Company has both the intent and ability to hold to maturity regardless of changes in market conditions, liquidity needs or general economic conditions. These securities are carried at amortized cost. The sale of a security within three months of its maturity date or after at least 85 percent of the principal outstanding has been collected is considered a maturity for purposes of classification and disclosure.

Securities classified as AFS or trading are reported as an asset on the Consolidated Balance Sheets at their estimated fair value. As the fair value of AFS securities changes, the changes are reported net of income tax as an element of other comprehensive income (“OCI”), except for impaired securities. When AFS securities are sold, the unrealized gain or loss is reclassified from OCI to non-interest income. The changes in the fair values of trading securities are reported in non-interest income. Securities classified as AFS are both equity and debt securities the Company intends to hold for an indefinite period of time, but not necessarily to maturity. Any decision to sell a security classified as AFS would be based on various factors, including significant movements in interest rates, changes in the maturity mix of the Company’s assets and liabilities, liquidity needs, decline in credit quality, and regulatory capital considerations.

Interest income is recognized based on the coupon rate and increased by accretion of discounts earned or decreased by the amortization of premiums paid over the contractual life of the security using the interest method. For mortgage-backed securities, estimates of prepayments are considered in the constant yield calculations.

In estimating whether there are any other than temporary impairment losses, management considers 1) the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than amortized cost, 2) the financial condition and near term prospects of the issuer, 3) the impact of changes in market interest rates, and 4) the intent and ability of the Company to retain its investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value.

Declines in the fair value of individual debt securities available for sale that are deemed to be other than temporary are reflected in earnings when identified. The fair value of the debt security then becomes the new cost basis. For individual debt securities where the Company does not intend to sell the security and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, the other than temporary decline in fair value of the debt security related to 1) credit loss is recognized in earnings, and 2) market or other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income or loss. Credit loss is recorded if the present value of cash flows is less than amortized cost. For individual debt securities where the Company intends to sell the security or more likely than not will not recover all of its amortized cost, the other than temporary impairment is recognized in earnings equal to the entire difference between the securities cost basis and its fair value at the balance sheet date. For individual debt securities for which a credit loss has been recognized in earnings, interest accruals and amortization and accretion of premiums and discounts are suspended when the credit loss is recognized. Interest received after accruals have been suspended is recognized on a cash basis.

Derivative financial instruments

All derivatives are recognized on the balance sheet at their fair value, with changes in fair value reported in current-period earnings. These instruments consist primarily of interest rate swaps.

Certain derivative transactions that meet specified criteria qualify for hedge accounting. The Company occasionally purchases a financial instrument or originates a loan that contains an embedded derivative instrument. Upon purchasing the instrument or originating the loan, the Company assesses whether the economic characteristics of the embedded derivative are clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the remaining component of the financial instrument (i.e., the host contract) and whether a separate instrument with the same terms as the embedded instrument would meet the definition of a derivative instrument. When it is determined that (1) the embedded derivative possesses economic characteristics that are not clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the host contract, and (2) a separate instrument with the same terms would qualify as a derivative instrument, the embedded derivative is separated from the host contract and carried at fair value. However, in cases where (1) the host contract is measured at fair value, with changes in fair value reported in current earnings, or (2) the Company is unable to reliably identify and measure an embedded derivative for separation from its host contract, the entire contract is carried on the balance sheet at fair value and is not designated as a hedging instrument.

Goodwill

The Company recorded as goodwill the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired in accordance with applicable guidance. As per this guidance, a two-step process is outlined for impairment testing of goodwill. Impairment testing is generally performed annually, as well as when an event triggering impairment may have occurred. The first step tests for impairment, while the second step, if necessary, measures the impairment. The resulting impairment amount if any is charged to current period earnings as non-interest expense.

 

53


Table of Contents

Other intangible assets

The Company’s intangible assets consist of core deposit intangible assets, investment advisory and trust customer relationship intangibles, and are amortized over periods ranging from 6 to 12 years. The Company evaluates the remaining useful lives of its core deposit intangible assets each reporting period, as required by FASB ASC 350, Intangibles—Goodwill and Other, to determine whether events and circumstances warrant a revision to the remaining period of amortization. If the estimate of an intangible asset’s remaining useful life has changed, the remaining carrying amount of the intangible asset is amortized prospectively over that revised remaining useful life. As a result of current economic conditions, the Company revised its estimates of the useful lives of its core deposit intangibles during the year ended December 31, 2008. The Company made no further changes to these revised lives in 2011 or 2010.

Stock compensation plans

The Company has the 2005 Stock Incentive Plan as amended (the “Incentive Plan”), which is described more fully in Note 13, “Stockholders’ Equity.” Compensation expense for stock options and non-vested restricted stock awards is based on the fair value of the award on the measurement date, which, for the Company, is the date of the grant and is recognized ratably over the service period of the award. Prior to the Company’s initial public offering (“IPO”), the Company used the minimum value method to calculate the fair value of stock options. Subsequent to the Company’s IPO, the Company utilizes the Black-Scholes option-pricing model to calculate the fair value of stock options. The fair value of non-vested restricted stock awards is the market price of the Company’s stock on the date of grant.

During the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, the Company granted stock options to the non-executive directors of its subsidiaries. These directors do not meet the definition of an employee under FASB ASC 718 Compensation. Accordingly, the Company applies FASB ASC 505 Equity to determine the measurement date for options granted to these directors. Therefore, the expense related to these options is re-measured each reporting date until the options are vested.

Income taxes

Western Alliance Bancorporation and its subsidiaries, other than BW Real Estate, Inc., file a consolidated federal tax return. Due to tax regulations, several items of income and expense are recognized in different periods for tax return purposes than for financial reporting purposes. These items represent “temporary differences.” Deferred taxes are provided on an asset and liability method whereby deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary differences and tax credit carry-forwards and deferred tax liabilities are recognized for taxable temporary differences. Temporary differences are the differences between the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and their tax bases. Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in the opinion of Management, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted for the effect of changes in tax laws and rates on the date of enactment.

Although realization is not assured, the Company believes that the realization of the recognized net deferred tax asset of $61.7 million at December 31, 2011 is more likely than not based on expectations as to future taxable income and based on available tax planning strategies as defined in FASB ASC 740, Income Taxes (‘ASC 740”) that could be implemented if necessary to prevent a carryforward from expiring.

The most significant source of these timing differences are the credit loss reserve and net operating loss carryforwards, which account for substantially all of the net deferred tax asset.

As a result of the losses incurred in 2009 and 2010, the Company is in a three-year cumulative pretax loss position at December 31, 2011. A cumulative loss position is considered significant negative evidence in assessing the realizability of a deferred tax asset. The Company has concluded that there is sufficient positive evidence to overcome this negative evidence. This positive evidence includes Company forecasts, exclusive of tax planning strategies, that show full utilization of the net operating losses by the end of 2013 based on current projections. In addition, the Company has evaluated tax planning strategies, including potential sales of businesses and assets in which it could realize the excess of appreciated value over the tax basis of its assets. The amount of deferred tax assets considered realizable, however, could be significantly reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are significantly lower than forecasted due to deterioration in market conditions.

Based on the above discussion, the Company believes that it is more likely than not that it will fully utilize deferred federal and state tax assets pertaining to the existing net operating loss carryforwards and any NOL that would be created by the reversal of the future net deductions that have not yet been taken on a tax return. See Note 8, “Income Taxes” to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion on income taxes

Liquidity

Liquidity is the ongoing ability to accommodate liability maturities and deposit withdrawals, fund asset growth and business operations, and meet contractual obligations through unconstrained access to funding at reasonable market rates. Liquidity management involves forecasting funding requirements and maintaining sufficient capacity to meet the needs and accommodate fluctuations in asset and liability levels due to changes in our business operations or unanticipated events.

 

54


Table of Contents

The ability to have readily available funds sufficient to repay fully maturing liabilities is of primary importance to depositors, creditors and regulators. Our liquidity, represented by cash and amounts due from banks, federal funds sold and non-pledged marketable securities, is a result of our operating, investing and financing activities and related cash flows. In order to ensure funds are available when necessary, on at least a quarterly basis, we project the amount of funds that will be required, and we strive to maintain relationships with a diversified customer base. Liquidity requirements can also be met through short-term borrowings or the disposition of short-term assets. The Company has unsecured borrowing lines at correspondent banks totaling $55.0 million. In addition, loans and securities are pledged to the FHLB providing $1.20 billion in borrowing capacity with outstanding borrowings and letters of credit of $280.0 million and $72.0 million, respectively, leaving $843.4 million in available credit as of December 31, 2011. Loans and securities pledged to the FRB discount window provided $696.6 million in borrowing capacity. As of December 31, 2011, there were no outstanding borrowings from the FRB, thus our available credit totaled $696.6 million.

The Company has a formal liquidity policy, and in the opinion of management, our liquid assets are considered adequate to meet cash flow needs for loan funding and deposit cash withdrawals for the next 90-120 days. At December 31, 2011, there was $891.2 million in liquid assets comprised of $162.3 million in cash and cash equivalents and $728.9 million in unpledged marketable securities. At December 31, 2010, the Company maintained $1.03 billion in liquid assets comprised of $254.5 million of cash and cash equivalents (including federal funds sold of $0.9 million) and $780.0 million of unpledged marketable securities.

The holding company maintains additional liquidity that would be sufficient to fund its operations and certain nonbank affiliate operations for an extended period should funding from normal sources be disrupted. Since deposits are taken by the bank operating subsidiaries and not by the parent company, parent company liquidity is not dependant on the bank operating subsidiaries’ deposit balances. In our analysis of parent company liquidity, we assume that the parent company is unable to generate funds from additional debt or equity issuance, receives no dividend income from subsidiaries, and does not pay dividends to shareholders, while continuing to meet nondiscretionary uses needed to maintain operations and repayment of contractual principal and interest payments owed by the parent company and affiliated companies. Under this scenario, the amount of time the parent company and its nonbank subsidiaries can operate and meet all obligations before the current liquid assets are exhausted is considered as part of the parent company liquidity analysis. Management believes the parent company maintains adequate liquidity capacity to operate without additional funding from new sources for over 12 months. The Banks maintain sufficient funding capacity to address large increases in funding requirements, such as deposit outflows. This capacity is comprised of liquidity derived from a reduction in asset levels and various secured funding sources.

On a long-term basis, the Company’s liquidity will be met by changing the relative distribution of our asset portfolios, for example by reducing investment or loan volumes, or selling or encumbering assets. Further, the Company can increase liquidity by soliciting higher levels of deposit accounts through promotional activities and/or borrowing from correspondent banks, the FHLB of San Francisco and the FRB. At December 31, 2011, our long-term liquidity needs primarily relate to funds required to support loan originations and commitments and deposit withdrawals which can be met by cash flows from investment payments and maturities, and investment sales if necessary.

The Company’s liquidity is comprised of three primary classifications: (i) cash flows provided by operating activities; (ii) cash flows used in investing activities; and (iii) cash flows provided by financing activities. Net cash provided by or used in operating activities consists primarily of net income, adjusted for changes in certain other asset and liability accounts and certain non-cash income and expense items, such as the loan loss provision, investment and other amortization and depreciation. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, net cash provided by operating activities was $142.5 million, $0.3 million and $74.8 million, respectively.

Our primary investing activities are the origination of real estate, commercial and consumer loans and purchase and sale of securities. Our net cash provided by and used in investing activities has been primarily influenced by our loan and securities activities. The net increase in loans for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, was $644.8 million, $339.3 million and $112.1 million, respectively.

Net cash provided by financing activities has been impacted significantly by increased deposit levels. During the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, deposits increased $320.1 million, $616.3 million and $938.1 million, respectively.

Fluctuations in core deposit levels may increase our need for liquidity as certificates of deposit mature or are withdrawn before maturity and as non-maturity deposits, such as checking and savings account balances, are withdrawn. Additionally, we are exposed to the risk that customers with large deposit balances will withdraw all or a portion of such deposits, due in part to the FDIC limitations on the amount of insurance coverage provided to depositors. To mitigate the uninsured deposit risk, we have joined the Certificate of Deposit Account Registry Service (CDARS), a program that allows customers to invest up to $50.0 million in certificates of deposit through one participating financial institution, with the entire amount being covered by FDIC insurance. As of December 31, 2011, we had $376.0 million of CDARS deposits.

 

 

55


Table of Contents

As of December 31, 2011, we had $35.8 million of wholesale brokered deposits outstanding. Brokered deposits are generally considered to be deposits that have been received from a third party that is acting on behalf of that party’s customer. Often, a broker will direct a customer’s deposits to the banking institution offering the highest interest rate available. Federal banking law and regulation places restrictions on depository institutions regarding brokered deposits because of the general concern that these deposits are at a greater risk of being withdrawn and placed on deposit at another institution offering a higher interest rate, thus posing liquidity risk for institutions that gather brokered deposits in significant amounts. The Company does not anticipate using brokered deposits as a significant liquidity source in the near future.

Federal and state banking regulations place certain restrictions on dividends paid by the Banks to Western Alliance. The total amount of dividends which may be paid at any date is generally limited to the retained earnings of each Bank. Dividends paid by the Banks to the Company would be prohibited if the effect thereof would cause the respective Bank’s capital to be reduced below applicable minimum capital requirements. In addition, the memorandum of understanding at Bank of Nevada presently requires prior regulatory approval of the payments of dividends to Western Alliance.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

Market risk is the risk of loss in a financial instrument arising from adverse changes in market prices and rates, foreign currency exchange rates, commodity prices and equity prices. Our market risk arises primarily from interest rate risk inherent in our lending, investing and deposit taking activities. To that end, management actively monitors and manages our interest rate risk exposure. We generally manage our interest rate sensitivity by evaluating re-pricing opportunities on our earning assets to those on our funding liabilities.

Management uses various asset/liability strategies to manage the re-pricing characteristics of our assets and liabilities, all of which are designed to ensure that exposure to interest rate fluctuations is limited to within our guidelines of acceptable levels of risk-taking. Hedging strategies, including the terms and pricing of loans and deposits and management of the deployment of our securities, are used to reduce mismatches in interest rate re-pricing opportunities of portfolio assets and their funding sources.

Interest rate risk is addressed by each Bank’s respective Asset and Liability Management Committee, or ALCO (or its equivalent), which includes members of executive management, senior finance and operations. ALCO monitors interest rate risk by analyzing the potential impact on the net economic value of equity and net interest income from potential changes in interest rates, and considers the impact of alternative strategies or changes in balance sheet structure. We manage our balance sheet in part to maintain the potential impact on economic value of equity and net interest income within acceptable ranges despite changes in interest rates.

Our exposure to interest rate risk is reviewed on at least a quarterly basis by the ALCO. Interest rate risk exposure is measured using interest rate sensitivity analysis to determine our change in economic value of equity in the event of hypothetical changes in interest rates. If potential changes to net economic value of equity and net interest income resulting from hypothetical interest rate changes are not within the limits established by each Bank’s Board of Directors, the respective Board of Directors may direct management to adjust the asset and liability mix to bring interest rate risk within board-approved limits.

Net Interest Income Simulation. In order to measure interest rate risk at December 31, 2011, we used a simulation model to project changes in net interest income that result from forecasted changes in interest rates. This analysis calculates the difference between net interest income forecasted using an immediate increase and decrease in interest rates and a net interest income forecast using a flat market interest rate environment derived from spot yield curves typically used to price our assets and liabilities. The income simulation model includes various assumptions regarding the re-pricing relationships for each of our products. Many of our assets are floating rate loans, which are assumed to re-price immediately, and proportional to the change in market rates, depending on their contracted index. Some loans and investments include the opportunity of prepayment (embedded options), and accordingly the simulation model uses estimated market speeds to derive prepayments and reinvests proceeds at modeled yields. Our non-term deposit products re-price more slowly, usually changing less than the change in market rates and at our discretion.

This analysis indicates the impact of changes in net interest income for the given set of rate changes and assumptions. It assumes the balance sheet remains static and that its structure does not change over the course of the year. It does not account for all factors that could impact our results, including changes by management to mitigate interest rate changes or secondary factors such as changes to our credit risk profile as interest rates change.

Furthermore, loan prepayment rate estimates and spread relationships change regularly. Interest rate changes create changes in actual loan prepayment speeds that will differ from the market estimates incorporated in this analysis. Changes that vary significantly from the modeled assumptions may have significant effects on our actual net interest income.

 

56


Table of Contents

This simulation model assesses the changes in net interest income that would occur in response to an instantaneous and sustained increase or decrease (shock) in market interest rates. At December 31, 2011, our net interest margin exposure for the next twelve months related to these hypothetical changes in market interest rates was within our current guidelines.

Sensitivity of Net Interest Income

 

      Interest Rate Scenario (change in basis points from Base)  
(in 000’s)    Down 100     Base      UP 100     UP 200     Up 300     Up 400  

Interest Income

   $ 289,110      $ 297,528       $ 310,190      $ 328,472      $ 349,778      $ 370,606   

Interest Expense

   $ 32,304      $ 32,366       $ 49,647      $ 67,884      $ 86,625      $ 104,822   

Net Interest Income

   $ 256,806      $ 265,162       $ 260,543      $ 260,588      $ 263,153      $ 265,784   

% Change

     -3.2        -1.7     -1.7     -0.8     0.2

Economic Value of Equity. We measure the impact of market interest rate changes on the net present value of estimated cash flows from our assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet items, defined as economic value of equity, using a simulation model. This simulation model assesses the changes in the market value of interest rate sensitive financial instruments that would occur in response to an instantaneous and sustained increase or decrease (shock) in market interest rates.

At December 31, 2011, our economic value of equity exposure related to these hypothetical changes in market interest rates was within the current guidelines established by us. The following table shows our projected change in economic value of equity for this set of rate shocks at December 31, 2011.

Economic Value of Equity

 

      Interest Rate Scenario (change in basis points from Base)  
     Down 100     Base     UP 100     UP 200     Up 300     Up 400  

Present Value (000’s)

            

Assets

   $ 7,066,745      $ 7,009,647      $ 6,876,426      $ 6,734,122      $ 6,593,772      $ 6,457,387   

Liabilities

   $ 6,213,671      $ 6,145,421      $ 6,032,661      $ 5,911,335      $ 5,790,353      $ 5,682,208   

Adjustments

            

Goodwill & Intangibles

   $ (36,867   $ (36,867   $ (36,867   $ (36,867   $ (36,867   $ (36,867

AFS Fair Market Value

   $ 6,746      $ 6,746      $ 6,746      $ 6,746      $ 6,746      $ 6,746   

Net Present Value

   $ 822,953      $ 834,105      $ 813,644      $ 792,666      $ 773,298      $ 745,058   

% Change

     -1.3       -2.5     -5.0     -7.3     -10.7

The computation of prospective effects of hypothetical interest rate changes are based on numerous assumptions, including relative levels of market interest rates, asset prepayments and deposit decay, and should not be relied upon as indicative of actual results. Further, the computations do not contemplate any actions we may undertake in response to changes in interest rates. Actual amounts may differ from the projections set forth above should market conditions vary from the underlying assumptions.

Derivative Contracts. In the normal course of business, the Company uses derivative instruments to meet the needs of its customers and manage exposure to fluctuations in interest rates. The following table summarizes the aggregate notional amounts, market values and terms of the Company’s derivative positions with derivative market makers as of December 31, 2011.

 

57


Table of Contents

Outstanding Derivatives Positions

 

         Weighted Average

Notional

   Net Value   Term (in yrs)

32,880,403

   (163,316)   3.8

The following table summarizes the aggregate notional amounts, market values and terms of the Company’s derivative positions with derivative market makers as of December 31, 2010:

Outstanding Derivatives Positions

 

         Weighted Average

Notional

   Net Value   Term (in yrs)

12,860,170

   (1,395,856)   3.9

Recent accounting pronouncements

In December 2010, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued guidance within the Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2010-20 “Disclosures about the Credit Quality of Financing Receivables and the Allowance for Credit Losses.” ASU 2010-20 requires entities to provide disclosures designed to facilitate financial statement users’ evaluation of (i) the nature of credit risk inherent in the entity’s portfolio of financing receivables, (ii) how that risk is analyzed and assessed in arriving at the allowance for credit losses, and (iii) the changes and reasons for those changes in the allowance for credit losses. Disclosures must be disaggregated by portfolio segment, the level at which an entity develops and documents a systematic method for determining its allowance for credit losses, and class of financing receivable, which is generally a disaggregation of portfolio segment. The required disclosures include, among other things, a roll forward of the allowance for credit losses as well as information about modified, impaired, nonaccrual and past due loans and credit quality indicators. ASU 2010-20 became effective for the Company’s financial statements as of December 31, 2010, as it relates to disclosures required as of the end of a reporting period. Disclosures that relate to activity during a reporting period are required for the Company’s financial statements that include periods beginning on or after January 1, 2011. The adoption of this guidance did not have any impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In April 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-02 “A Creditor’s Determination of Whether a Restructuring is a Troubled Debt Restructuring.” ASU 2011-02 clarifies when a loan modification or restructuring is considered a troubled debt restructuring. This guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after June 15, 2011, and will be applied retrospectively to the beginning of the annual period of adoption. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In April 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-03 “Reconsideration of Effective Control for Repurchase Agreements.” The amendments in ASU 2011-03 remove from the assessment of effective control (1) the criterion requiring the transferor to have the ability to repurchase or redeem the financial assets on substantially the agreed terms, even in the event of default by the transferee, and (2) the collateral maintenance implementation guidance related to that criterion. This guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after December 15, 2011, and will be applied prospectively to transactions or modifications of existing transactions that occur on or after the effective date. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In May 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-04 “Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs.” The amendments in ASU 2011-04 generally represent clarifications of Topic 820, Fair Value Measurement but also include some instances where a particular principle or requirement for measuring fair value or disclosing information about fair value measurements has changed. This update results in common principles and requirements for measuring fair value and for disclosing information about fair value measurements in accordance with U.S. GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”). This guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after December 15, 2011, and will be applied prospectively. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of the adoption of this guidance but does not anticipate a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

 

58


Table of Contents

In June 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-05 “Presentation of Comprehensive Income.” The amendments in ASU 2011-05 to Topic 220, Comprehensive Income, allow an entity the option to present the total comprehensive income, the components of net income, and the components of other comprehensive income either in a single continuous statement of comprehensive income or in two separate but consecutive statements. In both choices, an entity is required to present each component of net income along with total net income, each component of other comprehensive income along with a total for other comprehensive income, and a total amount for comprehensive income. This update eliminates the option to present the components of other comprehensive income as part of the statement of changes in stockholders’ equity. The amendments do not change the items that must be reported in other comprehensive income or when an item of other comprehensive income must be reclassified to net income. This guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after December 15, 2011, and will be applied retrospectively. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operatons, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In September 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-08 “Testing Goodwill for Impairment.” The amendments in this update to Topic 350, Intangibles-Goodwill and Other, will allow an entity to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is necessary to perform the two-step quantitative goodwill impairment test. An entity would not be required to calculate the fair value of a reporting unit unless the entity determines, based on a qualitative assessment, that it is more likely than not that its fair value is less than its carrying amount. The amendments include a number of events and circumstances for an entity to consider in conducting the qualitative assessment. This guidance is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. Companies may elect to early adopt. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In December 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-10 “De-recognition of in Substance Real Estate – a Scope Clarification.” The amendments to Topic 360, Property, Plant, and Equipment, resolve the diversity in practice when a parent ceases to have a controlling financial interest in a subsidiary that is in substance real estate as a result of default on the subsidiary’s nonrecourse debt. This guidance is effective for annual and interim periods beginning after June 15, 2012. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In December 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-11 “Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities.” The update to Topic 210, Balance Sheet, requires enhanced disclosures to enable users of the financial statements to evaluate the effect or potential effect of netting arrangements on an entity’s financial position. This guidance is effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after January 1, 2013. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

Bank holding companies and banks operate in an extensively regulated environment under state and federal law. These laws and regulations are intended primarily for the protection of depositors and the Deposit Insurance Fund (the “DIF”) and not for the benefit of shareholders or creditors. The following discussion is only intended to summarize some of the significant statutes and regulations that affect the banking industry, and therefore is not a comprehensive survey of the field. These summaries are not intended to be complete and are qualified in their entirety by reference to the particular statute or regulation described. Moreover, recent legislation, such as the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, or Dodd-Frank Act, and regulations have been adopted relating to the regulation, supervision, examination and operation of financial institutions. These laws and regulations have been in effect for only a limited time, and we cannot predict the long-term impact their implementation will have on the capital, credit and real estate markets as well as our operations and activities.

Regulatory oversight of financial institutions, including banks and bank holding companies, has increased in recent periods. Regulators conduct a variety of evaluations, including compliance audits and safety and soundness reviews. As a result of these reviews, regulators may require that we change our practices or policies, write down assets or increase reserves (and therefore reduce our capital base), and take or omit to take other actions deemed prudent by the regulator. Given the implementation of these new laws and regulations, the Company cannot predict the outcome of future regulatory evaluations or whether it will become subject to conditions, policies or directives resulting from regulatory evaluations.

TARP Programs and Compliance

On February 17, 2009, President Obama signed into law the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (the “stimulus bill” or “ARRA”). The final version of the stimulus bill amended the executive compensation provisions of Section 111 of EESA to set forth new restrictions on executive compensation paid by financial institutions participating in TARP.

 

59


Table of Contents

The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act

As a result of the financial crisis, the U.S. Congress passed, and on July 21, 2010 President Obama signed into law, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, or the Dodd-Frank Act. The Dodd-Frank Act has had, and will continue to have, a broad impact on the financial services industry. Many of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act codify or direct the appropriate Federal regulatory agency, including the SEC, Federal Reserve or FDIC, to promulgate regulations to implement, the requirements discussed above for TARP participants. The Federal regulatory agencies have issued a number of requests for public comment, proposed rules and final regulations to implement the requirements of the Dodd-Frank Act. The following items provide a brief description of the impact of the Dodd-Frank Act on the operations and activities, both currently and prospectively, of the Company and its subsidiaries.

Deposit Insurance. The Dodd-Frank Act and implementing final rules from the FDIC make permanent the $250,000 deposit insurance limit for insured deposits. The assessment base against which an insured depository institution’s deposit insurance premiums paid to the FDIC’s Deposit Insurance Fund (or the DIF) has been revised to use the institution’s average consolidated total assets less its average equity rather than its deposit base. These provisions could increase the FDIC deposit insurance premiums paid by our insured depository institution subsidiaries. The Dodd-Frank Act also amended the Federal Deposit Insurance Act to provide full deposit insurance coverage for non-interest-bearing transaction accounts beginning on December 31, 2010. As a result, the FDIC discontinued its Transaction Account Guarantee Program, created under the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program. Unlike the FDIC’s programs, no opt outs from participation in the Dodd-Frank Act’s insurance protection were allowed and institutions were not required to pay a separate assessment for participation.

Increased Capital Standards and Enhanced Supervision. The federal banking agencies are required to establish minimum leverage and risk-based capital requirements for banks and bank holding companies. These new standards will be no lower than existing regulatory capital and leverage standards applicable to insured depository institutions and may, in fact, be higher when established by the agencies. Compliance with heightened capital standards may reduce our ability to generate or originate revenue-producing assets and thereby restrict revenue generation from banking and non-banking operations. The Dodd-Frank Act also increases regulatory oversight, supervision and examination of banks, bank holding companies and their respective subsidiaries by the appropriate regulatory agency. Compliance with new regulatory requirements and expanded examination processes could increase our cost of operations.

Trust Preferred Securities. Under the increased capital standards established by the Dodd-Frank Act, bank holding companies are prohibited from including in their regulatory Tier 1 capital hybrid debt and equity securities issued on or after May 19, 2010. Among the hybrid debt and equity securities included in this prohibition are trust preferred securities, which the Company has used in the past as a tool for raising additional Tier 1 capital and otherwise improving its regulatory capital ratios. Although the Company may continue to include our existing trust preferred securities as Tier 1 capital, the prohibition on the use of these securities as Tier 1 capital going forward may limit the Company’s ability to raise capital in the future.

The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau. The Dodd-Frank Act creates a new, independent Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (or the Bureau) within the Federal Reserve that is tasked with establishing and implementing rules and regulations under certain federal consumer protection laws. These consumer protection laws govern the manner in which we offer many of our financial products and services. On July 21, 2011, the rulemaking and certain enforcement authority for enumerated federal consumer financial protection laws was transferred to the Bureau. As a result of this transfer, the Bureau now has significant interpretive and enforcement authority with respect to many of the federal laws and regulations under which we operate. In accordance with this authority, the Bureau has officially transferred many of the regulations formally maintained by the Federal Reserve and the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development, to a new chapter of Title 12 of the Code of Federal Regulations maintained by the Bureau, many of which deal with consumer credit, account disclosures and residential mortgage lending. Although the Bureau did not make significant or substantive changes to the rules as part of this transfer, it now has authority to promulgate guidance and interpretations of these rules and regulations in a manner that could differ from prior interpretations from other federal regulatory bodies.

State Enforcement of Consumer Financial Protection Laws. The Dodd-Frank Act permits states to adopt consumer protection laws and regulations that are stricter than those regulations promulgated by the Bureau. State attorneys general are permitted to enforce consumer protection rules adopted by the Bureau against certain state-chartered institutions. Although our subsidiaries do not currently offer many of these consumer products or services, compliance with any such new regulations would increase our cost of operations and, as a result, could limit our ability to expand into these products and services.

Transactions with Affiliates and Insiders. The Dodd-Frank Act enhances the requirements for certain transactions with affiliates under Section 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, including an expansion of the definition of “covered transactions” and an increase in the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered transactions must

 

60


Table of Contents

be maintained. Additionally, limitations on transactions with insiders are expanded through the (i) strengthening on loan restrictions to insiders; and (ii) expansion of the types of transactions subject to the various limits, including derivative transactions, repurchase agreements, reverse repurchase agreements and securities lending or borrowing transactions. Restrictions are also placed on certain asset sales to and from an insider to an institution, including requirements that such sales be on market terms and, in certain circumstances, approved by the institution’s board of directors.

Corporate Governance. The Dodd-Frank Act addresses many corporate governance and executive compensation matters that will affect most U.S. publicly traded companies, including us. The Dodd-Frank Act (1) grants shareholders of U.S. publicly traded companies an advisory vote on executive compensation; (2) enhances independence requirements for compensation committee members; (3) requires companies listed on national securities exchanges to adopt incentive-based compensation claw-back policies for executive officers; and (4) provides the SEC with authority to adopt proxy access rules that would allow shareholders of publicly traded-companies to nominate candidates for election as a director and have those nominees included in a company’s proxy materials. The SEC recently adopted final rules implementing rules for the shareholder advisory vote on executive compensation and golden parachute payments.

Additional regulations called for in the Dodd-Frank Act, including regulations dealing with the risk retention requirements for, and disclosures required from, residential mortgage originators will be implemented over time. Although the Dodd-Frank Act contains some specific timelines for the Federal regulatory agencies to follow, it remains unclear whether the agencies will be able to meet these deadlines and when rules will be proposed and finalized. We continue to monitor the rulemaking process and, while our current assessment is that the Dodd-Frank Act and the implementing regulations will not have a material effect on the Company, given the uncertainty associated with the manner in which the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act will be implemented, the full extent of the impact such requirements will have on our operations is unclear. The changes resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act may impact the profitability of our business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. These changes may also require us to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any changes necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements. Failure to comply with the new requirements would negatively impact our results of operations and financial condition. While we cannot predict what effect any presently contemplated or future changes in the laws or regulations or their interpretations would have on us, these changes could be materially adverse to our investors.

Bank Holding Company Regulation

General. Western Alliance Bancorporation is a bank holding company, registered with the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve (the “Federal Reserve”) under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (the “BHC Act”). As such, the Federal Reserve is Western Alliance’s primary federal regulator, and Western Alliance is subject to extensive regulation, supervision and examination by the Federal Reserve. Western Alliance must file reports with the Federal Reserve and provide it with such additional information as it may require.

Under Federal Reserve policy, a bank holding company is required to serve as a source of financial and managerial strength for its subsidiary banks and may not conduct its operations in an unsafe or unsound manner. Accordingly, the Company must stand ready to use its available resources to provide adequate capital to its subsidiary banks during a period of financial stress or adversity and should maintain the financial flexibility and capital-raising capacity to obtain additional resources for assisting its subsidiary banks. Such support may be required at times when, absent the Federal Reserve’s policy, a bank holding company may not be inclined to provide it. The expectation to serve as a source of financial strength is in addition to certain guarantees required under the prompt correction action provisions discussed below. A bank holding company’s failure to meet these obligations will generally be considered by the Federal Reserve to be an unsafe and unsound banking practice or a violation of Federal Reserve regulations, or both.

Among its powers, the Federal Reserve may require a bank holding company to terminate an activity or terminate control of, divest or liquidate subsidiaries or affiliates that the Federal Reserve determines constitute a significant risk to the financial safety or soundness of the bank holding company or any of its bank subsidiaries. Subject to certain exceptions, bank holding companies also are required to give written notice to and receive approval from the Federal Reserve before purchasing or redeeming their common stock or other equity securities. The Federal Reserve also may regulate provisions of a bank holding company’s debt, including by imposing interest rate ceilings and reserve requirements. In addition, the Federal Reserve requires all bank holding companies to maintain capital at or above certain prescribed levels. As a result of the Dodd-Frank Act, the Company also cannot engage in proprietary trading or establish or invest in private equity or hedge funds, subject to a few narrow exemptions. The so-called Volcker Rule will become effective on July 21, 2012. The federal agencies tasked with jointly issuing implementing regulations, including the SEC, OCC and Federal Reserve, issued a notice of proposed rulemaking in October 2011, with public comment due by February 13, 2012.

Holding Company Bank Ownership. The BHC Act requires every bank holding company to obtain the approval of the Federal Reserve before it may acquire, directly or indirectly, ownership or control of any voting shares of another bank or bank holding company if, after such acquisition, it would own or control more than 5% of any class of the outstanding

 

61


Table of Contents

voting shares of such other bank or bank holding company, acquire all or substantially all the assets of another bank or bank holding company or merge or consolidate with another bank holding company. The BHC Act further provides that the Federal Reserve may not approve any transaction that would result in a monopoly or would be in furtherance of any combination or conspiracy to monopolize or attempt to monopolize the business of banking in any section of the United States, or the effect of which may be substantially to lessen competition or to tend to create a monopoly in any section of the country, or that in any other manner would be in restraint of trade, unless the anticompetitive effects of the proposed transaction are clearly outweighed by the public interest in meeting the convenience and needs of the community to be served. The Federal Reserve is also required to consider the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the bank holding companies and banks concerned and the convenience and needs of the community to be served. Consideration of financial resources generally focuses on capital adequacy, and consideration of convenience and needs issues includes the parties’ performance under the Community Reinvestment Act (“CRA”). In addition, the Federal Reserve must take into account the institutions’ effectiveness in combating money laundering.

Holding Company Non-bank Ownership. With certain exceptions, the BHC Act prohibits a bank holding company from acquiring or retaining, directly or indirectly, ownership or control of more than 5% of the outstanding voting shares of any company that is not a bank or bank holding company, or from engaging, directly or indirectly, in activities other than those of banking, managing or controlling banks, or providing services for its subsidiaries. The principal exceptions to these prohibitions involve certain non-bank activities that have been identified, by statute or by Federal Reserve regulation or order as activities so closely related to the business of banking or of managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto. Business activities that have been determined to be so related to banking include securities brokerage services, investment advisory services, fiduciary services and certain management advisory and data processing services, among others. A bank holding company that qualifies as a “financial holding company” also may engage in a broader range of activities that are financial in nature (and complementary to such activities). Additional limitations on expansion were implemented by the Dodd-Frank Act’s amendments to the BHC Act, which prohibit mergers or acquisitions if the resulting institution would own or control more than 10% of the aggregate consolidated liabilities of all U. S. financial companies.

Bank holding companies that qualify and elect to become financial holding companies may engage in non-bank activities that have been identified by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 (“GLB Act”) or by Federal Reserve and Treasury regulation as financial in nature or incidental to a financial activity. The Federal Reserve may also determine that a financial holding company may engage in certain activities that are complementary to a financial activity. Activities that are defined as financial in nature include securities underwriting, dealing and market making, sponsoring mutual funds and investment companies, engaging in insurance underwriting and agency activities, and making merchant banking investments in non-financial companies. In order to become or remain a financial holding company, a bank holding company must be well-capitalized, well-managed, and, except in limited circumstances, have at least satisfactory CRA ratings. A financial holding company must also file a certification with the Federal Reserve that all its depository institution subsidiaries are well-capitalized and well managed. If, after becoming a financial holding company and undertaking activities not permissible for a bank holding company, the company fails to continue to meet any of the prerequisites for financial holding company status, the company must enter into an agreement with the Federal Reserve to comply with all applicable capital and management requirements. If the company does not return to compliance within 180 days, the Federal Reserve may order the company to divest its subsidiary banks or the company may discontinue or divest investments in companies engaged in, activities permissible only for a bank holding company that has elected to be treated as a financial holding company. On March 30, 2009, the Company withdrew its election to be a financial holding company, and is now required to limit its activities to those permissible for a bank holding company.

Change in Control. In the event that the BHC Act is not applicable to a person or entity, the Change in Bank Control Act of 1978 (“CIBC Act”) requires, that such person or entity give notice to the Federal Reserve and the Federal Reserve not disapprove such notice before such person or entity may acquire “control” of a bank or bank holding company. A limited number of exemptions apply to such transactions. Subject to more recent guidance issued by the Federal Reserve, control is conclusively presumed to exist if a person or entity acquires 25% or more of the outstanding shares of any class of voting stock of the bank holding company or insured depository institution. Control is rebuttably presumed to exist if a person or entity acquires 10% or more but less than 25% of such voting stock and either the issuer has a class of registered securities under Section 12 of the Exchange Act, or no other person or entity will own, control or hold the power to vote a greater percentage of such voting stock immediately after the transaction.

The Federal Reserve has stated that generally it will be able to conclude that an investor does not have “control” of a bank or bank holding company if it does not own in excess of 15% of the voting power and 33% of the total equity of the relevant bank or bank holding company. Under prior Federal Reserve guidance, a board seat was generally not permitted for non-controlling investment of 10% or greater of the equity or voting power. Under recent guidance, however, the Federal Reserve may permit a non-controlling investor to have up to two board seats if the investor’s aggregate board representation is proportionate to its total interest in the bank or bank holding company but does not exceed 25% of the voting members of the board and another shareholder of the bank or bank holding company controls the bank or bank holding company under the BHC Act. The Federal Reserve has also set forth the terms of nonvoting equity securities it will deem to be voting securities and gives examples of other indicia of control beyond just equity ownership limits.

 

62


Table of Contents

State Law Restrictions. As a Nevada corporation, Western Alliance is subject to certain limitations and restrictions under applicable Nevada corporate law. For example, Nevada law imposes restrictions relating to indemnification of directors, maintenance of books, records and minutes and observance of certain corporate formalities. Western Alliance is also a bank holding company within the meaning of state law in the states where its subsidiary banks are located. As such, it is subject to examination by and may be required to file reports with the Nevada Financial Institutions Division (“Nevada FID”) under sections 666.095 and 666.105 of the Nevada Revised Statutes. Western Alliance must obtain the approval of the Nevada Commissioner of Financial Institutions (“Nevada Commissioner”) before it may acquire another bank. Any transfer of control of a Nevada bank holding company must be approved in advance by the Nevada Commissioner.

Under section 6-142 of the Arizona Revised Statutes, no person may acquire control of a company that controls an Arizona bank without the prior approval of the Arizona Superintendent of Financial Institutions (“Arizona Superintendent”). A person who has the power to vote 15% or more of the voting stock of a controlling company is presumed to control the company.

Western Alliance also is subject to examination and reporting requirements of the California Department of Financial Institutions (“California DFI”) under sections 3703 and 3704 of the California Financial Code. Any transfer of control of a corporation that controls a California bank requires the prior approval of the California Commissioner of Financial Institutions (“California Commissioner”).

Bank Regulation

General. On December 31, 2010, the Company merged its former Alta Alliance Bank subsidiary into its Torrey Pines Bank subsidiary, and its former First Independent Bank of Nevada subsidiary into its Alliance Bank of Arizona subsidiary. As part of the latter merger, Alliance Bank of Arizona was renamed Western Alliance Bank doing business as Alliance Bank of Arizona (in Arizona) and First Independent Bank (in Nevada). Following this charter consolidation, Western Alliance controls three subsidiary banks: Bank of Nevada located in Las Vegas, Nevada, Western Alliance Bank located in Phoenix, Arizona, and Torrey Pines Bank located in San Diego, California. All three banks are state-chartered, nonmember banks and are subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the FDIC, which is their primary federal banking agency. In addition, Bank of Nevada is chartered in Nevada and subject to supervision by the Nevada FID, Western Alliance Bank is chartered in Arizona and is subject to supervision by the Arizona Department of Financial Institutions (“Arizona DFI”), and Torrey Pines Bank is chartered in California and is subject to supervision by the California DFI.

Federal and state banking laws and the implementing regulations promulgated by the federal and state banking regulatory agencies cover most aspects of the banks’ operations, including capital requirements, reserve requirements against deposits and for possible loan losses and other contingencies, dividends and other distributions to shareholders, customers’ interests in deposit accounts, payment of interest on certain deposits, permissible activities and investments, securities that a bank may issue and borrowings that a bank may incur, rate of growth, number and location of branch offices and acquisition and merger activity with other financial institutions.

Deposit Insurance Assessments. Deposits in the banks are insured by the FDIC to applicable limits through the Deposit Insurance Fund (“DIF”). All of Western Alliance’s subsidiary banks are required to pay deposit insurance premiums, which are generally assessed semiannually and paid quarterly. The FDIC utilizes a risk-based assessment system that imposes insurance premiums based upon a risk matrix that takes into account a bank’s capital level and supervisory rating (“CAMELS rating”). The risk matrix utilizes four risk categories (plus a category for large and highly complex institutions) which are distinguished by capital levels and supervisory ratings. Banks with higher levels of capital and a low degree of supervisory concern are assessed lower premiums than banks with lower levels of capital or a higher degree of supervisory concern. On February 7, 2011, the FDIC approved a final rule to implement deposit insurance assessment changes called for under the Dodd-Frank Act. The final rate schedule went into effect on April 1, 2011. The deposit insurance initial base assessment rates currently range from 2.5 basis points (for a financial institution in Risk Category I) to 45 basis points (for financial institutions in Risk Category IV or large, highly complex institutions), but may be higher under certain conditions. The base for deposit insurance assessments has been changed under the Dodd-Frank Act and the FDIC’s implementing rules, and is now defined as average consolidated total assets during the assessment period less average tangible equity capital during the assessment period. The banks’ average consolidated total assets and average tangible equity capital are defined in the schedule of quarterly averages in the Consolidated Reports of Condition and Income (“Call Reports”), using a daily averaging method.

In addition, the FDIC collects The Financing Corporation (“FICO”) deposit assessments on assessable deposits. FICO assessments are set quarterly, and in 2011 ranged from 1.02 basis points in the first quarter to 0.68 basis points in the fourth quarter.

In November 2009, the FDIC issued a rule that required all insured depository institutions, with limited exceptions, to prepay their estimated quarterly risk-based assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009 and for all of 2010, 2011 and 2012.

 

63


Table of Contents

The FDIC also adopted a uniform three-basis point increase in assessment rates effective on January 1, 2011. In December 2009, the Company paid $34.3 million in prepaid risk-based assessments, which included $2.2 million related to the fourth quarter of 2009 that would have otherwise been payable in the first quarter of 2010. This amount is included in deposit insurance expense for 2009. The remaining $12.8 million in pre-paid deposit insurance is included in other assets in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2011.

Supervision and Examination. Federal banking agencies have broad enforcement powers, including the power to terminate deposit insurance, impose substantial fines and other civil and criminal penalties, and appoint a conservator or receiver. If, as a result of an examination, the FDIC or the Federal Reserve, as applicable, were to determine that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of any of the banks’ operations had become unsatisfactory, or that any of the banks or their management was in violation of any law or regulation, the FDIC or the Federal Reserve may take a number of different remedial actions as it deems appropriate. These actions include the power to enjoin “unsafe or unsound” practices, to require affirmative actions to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in the bank’s capital, to restrict the bank’s growth, to assess civil monetary penalties against the bank’s officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if the FDIC concludes that such conditions cannot be corrected or there is an imminent risk of loss to depositors, to terminate the bank’s deposit insurance.

Under Nevada, Arizona and California law, the respective state banking supervisory authority has many of the same remedial powers with respect to its state-chartered banks.

Bank of Nevada has been placed under informal supervisory oversight by banking regulators in the form of memorandum of understanding. The oversight requires enhanced supervision by the Board of Directors of the bank, and the adoption or revision of written plans and/or policies addressing such matters as asset quality, credit underwriting and administration, the allowance for loan and lease losses, loan and investment portfolio risks, asset-liability management and loan concentrations, as well as the formulation and adoption of comprehensive strategic plans. The bank is also prohibited from paying dividends or making other distributions to the Company without prior regulatory approval and is required to maintain higher levels of Tier 1 capital than otherwise would be required to be considered well-capitalized under federal capital guidelines. In addition, the bank is required to provide regulators with prior notice of certain management and director changes and, in certain cases, to obtain their non-objection before engaging in a transaction that would materially change its balance sheet composition. The Company believes Bank of Nevada is in full compliance with the requirements of the memorandum of understanding.

Regulation of Non-banking Subsidiaries

Shine Investment Advisory Services, Inc. Shine, a Colorado corporation, are investment advisers that are registered with the SEC under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (“Advisers Act”). Under the Advisers Act, an investment adviser is subject to supervision and inspection by the SEC. A significant element of supervision under the Advisers Act is the requirement to make significant disclosures to the public under Part II of Form ADV of the adviser’s services and fees, the qualifications of its associated persons, financial difficulties and potential conflicts of interests. An investment adviser must keep extensive books and records, including all customer agreements, communications with clients, orders placed and proprietary trading by the adviser or any advisory representative.

Capital Standards

Regulatory Capital Guidelines. The Federal Reserve and the FDIC have risk-based capital adequacy guidelines intended to measure capital adequacy with regard to the degree of risk associated with a banking organization’s operations for transactions reported on the balance sheet as assets and transactions, such as letters of credit and recourse arrangements, that are reported as off-balance-sheet items. The Company and its subsidiary banks are required to comply with these capital adequacy standards. Under these guidelines, the nominal dollar amounts of assets on the balance sheet and credit-equivalent amounts of off- balance-sheet items are multiplied by one of several risk adjustment percentages. These range from 0.0% for assets with low credit risk, such as cash and certain U.S. government securities, to 100.0% for assets with relatively higher credit risk, such as business loans. A banking organization’s risk-based capital ratios are obtained by dividing its Tier 1 capital and total qualifying capital (Tier 1 capital and a limited amount of Tier 2 capital) by its total risk-adjusted assets certain and off-balance-sheet items. Tier 1 capital consists of common stock, retained earnings, non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, trust preferred securities up to a certain limit, and minority interests in certain subsidiaries, less most other intangible assets. Tier 2 capital consists of preferred stock not qualifying as Tier 1 capital, limited amounts of subordinated debt, other qualifying term debt, a limited amount of the allowance for loan and lease losses and certain other instruments that have some characteristics of equity. The inclusion of elements of Tier 2 capital as qualifying capital is subject to certain other requirements and limitations of the federal banking supervisory agencies. Since December 31, 1992, the Federal Reserve and the FDIC have required a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-adjusted assets and certain off-balance-sheet items of 4.0% and a minimum ratio of qualifying total capital to risk-adjusted assets and certain off-balance-sheet items of 8.0%.

 

64


Table of Contents

The Federal Reserve and the FDIC require banking organizations to maintain a minimum amount of Tier 1 capital relative to average total assets, referred to as the leverage ratio. The principal objective of the leverage ratio is to constrain the maximum degree to which a bank holding company may leverage its equity capital base. For a banking organization rated in the highest of the five categories used by regulators to rate banking organizations, the minimum leverage ratio of Tier 1 capital to total assets is 3.0%. However, an institution with a 3.0% leverage ratio would be unlikely to receive the highest rating since a strong capital position is a significant part of the regulators’ rating criteria. All banking organizations not rated in the highest category must maintain an additional capital cushion of 100 to 200 basis points. The Federal Reserve and the FDIC have the discretion to set higher minimum capital requirements for specific institutions. Furthermore, the Federal Reserve has previously indicated that it may consider a “tangible Tier 1 capital leverage ratio” (thereby deducting all intangibles from Tier 1 capital) and other indicators of capital strength in evaluating proposals for expansion or new activities. The Company’s tier one leverage ratio at December 31, 2011 was 9.8%. A bank that does not achieve and maintain the required capital levels may be issued a capital directive by the Federal Reserve or the FDIC, as appropriate, to ensure the maintenance of required capital levels.

The federal regulatory authorities’ risk-based capital guidelines are based upon the 1988 capital accord (“Basel I”) of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (the “Basel Committee”). The Basel Committee is a committee of central banks and bank supervisors/regulators from the major industrialized countries that develops broad policy guidelines for use by each country’s supervisors in determining the supervisory policies they apply. In 2004, the Basel Committee published a new capital accord (“Basel II”) to replace Basel I. Basel II provides two approaches for setting capital standards for credit risk – an internal ratings-based approach tailored to individual institutions’ circumstances and a standardized approach that bases risk weightings on external credit assessments to a much greater extent than permitted in existing risk-based capital guidelines. Basel II also would set capital requirements for operational risk and refine the existing capital requirements for market risk exposures. In July 2010, the Basel Committee adopted the key design elements for Basel III and, in September 2010, adopted the transition measures. The requirements of the Dodd-Frank Act have largely surpassed the regulatory requirements called for by Basel III. Regulators have begun the process of adopting standards required under the Dodd-Frank Act to remove reliance on credit rating agencies. This reliance is important in Basel III, and regulators are considering the impact of this requirement in international standards.

Prompt Corrective Action. Federal banking agencies possess broad powers to take corrective and other supervisory action to resolve the problems of insured depository institutions, including institutions that fall below one or more of the prescribed minimum capital ratios described above. The federal banking regulators are required to take “prompt corrective action” with respect to capital-deficient institutions. An institution that is classified based upon its capital levels as well-capitalized, adequately capitalized, or undercapitalized may be treated as though it was in the next lower capital category if its primary federal banking supervisory authority, after notice and opportunity for hearing, determines that an unsafe or unsound condition or practice warrants such treatment. At each successively lower capital category, an insured depository institution is subject to additional restrictions. A bank holding company must guarantee that a subsidiary bank that adopts a capital restoration plan will meet its plan obligations, in an amount not to exceed 5% of the subsidiary bank’s assets or the amount required to meet regulatory capital requirements, whichever is less. Any capital loans made by a bank holding company to a subsidiary bank are subordinated to the claims of depositors in the bank and to certain other indebtedness of the subsidiary bank. In the event of the bankruptcy of a bank holding company, any commitment by the bank holding company to a federal banking regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank would be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and would be entitled to priority of payment.

In addition to measures that may be taken under the prompt corrective action provisions, federal banking regulatory authorities may bring enforcement actions against banks and bank holding companies for unsafe or unsound practices in the conduct of their businesses or for violations of any law, rule or regulation, any condition imposed in writing by the appropriate federal banking regulatory authority or any written agreement with the authority. Possible enforcement actions include the appointment of a conservator or receiver, the issuance of a cease-and-desist order that could be judicially enforced, the termination of insurance of deposits (in the case of a depository institution), the imposition of civil money penalties, the issuance of directives to increase capital, the issuance of formal and informal agreements, including memoranda of understanding, the issuance of removal and prohibition orders against institution-affiliated parties and the enforcement of such actions through injunctions or restraining orders. In addition, a bank holding company’s inability to serve as a source of strength for its subsidiary banks could serve as an additional basis for a regulatory action against the bank holding company.

Under Nevada law, if the stockholders’ equity of a Nevada state-chartered bank becomes impaired, the Nevada Commissioner must require the bank to make the impairment good within three months after receiving notice from the Nevada Commissioner. If the impairment is not made good, the Nevada Commissioner may take possession of the bank and liquidate it.

Dividends. Western Alliance has never declared or paid cash dividends on its common stock. Western Alliance currently intends to retain any future earnings for future growth and does not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. Any determination in the future to pay dividends will be at the discretion of Western Alliance’s board of directors and will depend on the company’s earnings, financial condition, results of operations, business prospects, capital requirements, regulatory restrictions, contractual restrictions and other factors that the board of directors may deem relevant.

 

65


Table of Contents

Western Alliance’s ability to pay dividends is subject to the regulatory authority of the Federal Reserve. The supervisory concern of the Federal Reserve focuses on a bank holding company’s capital position, its ability to meet its financial obligations as they come due, and its capacity to act as a source of financial strength to its subsidiaries. In addition, Federal Reserve policy discourages the payment of dividends by a bank holding company that are not supported by current operating earnings.

As a Nevada corporation, Western Alliance also is subject to limitations under Nevada law on the payment of dividends. Under Nevada corporate law, section 78.288 of the Nevada Revised Statutes provides that no cash dividend or other distribution to shareholders, other than a stock dividend, may be made if, after giving effect to the dividend, the corporation would not be able to pay its debts as they become due or, unless specifically allowed by the articles of incorporation, the corporation’s total assets would be less than the sum of its total liabilities and the claims of preferred stockholders upon dissolution of the corporation.

From time to time, Western Alliance may become a party to financing agreements and other contractual obligations that have the effect of limiting or prohibiting the declaration or payment of dividends such as the Series B Preferred Stock it issued pursuant to the SBLF. So long as the SBLF Preferred Stock remains outstanding, the Company may only declare and pay dividends on its common stock if: (1) SBLF Preferred Stock dividend payments are current, and (2) the Company’s Tier 1 capital following payment of the common stock dividend would remain at or above the applicable threshold provided in Schedule A of the Certificate of Designations for the SBLF Preferred Stock (Exhibits 3.8 and 3.9 attached hereto and incorporated herein by this reference). Additional restrictions on common stock dividends apply if the Company does not timely pay dividends on the SBLF Preferred Stock. Holding company expenses and obligations with respect to its outstanding trust preferred securities and corresponding subordinated debt also may limit or impair Western Alliance’s ability to declare and pay dividends.

Since Western Alliance has no significant assets other than the voting stock of its subsidiaries, it currently depends on dividends from its bank subsidiaries and, to a lesser extent, its non-bank subsidiaries, for a substantial portion of its revenue and as the primary sources of its cash flow. The ability of a state non-member bank to pay cash dividends is not restricted by federal law or regulations. For example, under the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Act (“FDIA”), an insured institution may not pay a dividend if payment would cause it to become undercapitalized or if it is already undercapitalized. Furthermore, the FDIC has issued a policy statement indicating that banks should generally pay dividends only out of current operating earnings. In addition, the memorandum of understanding to which Bank of Nevada is subject prohibits the payment of dividends or other distributions to the Company without prior regulatory approval.

State laws also impose restrictions on the ability of each of Western Alliance’s subsidiary banks to pay dividends:

 

   

Under sections 661.235 and 661.240 of the Nevada Revised Statutes, Bank of Nevada and First Independent Bank of Nevada may not pay dividends unless the bank’s surplus fund, not including any initial surplus fund, equals the bank’s initial stockholders’ equity, plus 10% of the previous year’s net profits, and the dividend would not reduce the bank’s stockholders’ equity below the initial stockholders’ equity of the bank, which must be at least 6% of the total deposit liability of the bank.

 

   

Under section 6-187 of the Arizona Revised Statutes, Alliance Bank of Arizona may pay dividends on the same basis as any other Arizona corporation. Under section 10-640 of the Arizona Revised Statutes, a corporation may not make a distribution to shareholders if to do so would render the corporation insolvent or unable to pay its debts as they become due. However, an Arizona bank may not declare a non-stock dividend out of capital surplus without the approval of the Arizona Superintendent.

 

   

Under section 642 of the California Financial Code, Torrey Pines Bank and Alta Alliance Bank may not, without the prior approval of the California Commissioner, make a distribution to its shareholders in an amount exceeding the bank’s retained earnings or its net income during its last three fiscal years, less any previous distributions made during that period by the bank or its subsidiaries, whichever is less. Under section 643 of the California Financial Code, the California Commissioner may approve a larger distribution, but in no event to exceed the bank’s net income during the year, net income during the prior fiscal year or retained earnings, whichever is greatest.

Redemption. A bank holding company may not purchase or redeem its equity securities without the prior written approval of the Federal Reserve if the purchase or redemption combined with all other purchases and redemptions by the bank holding company during the preceding 12 months equals or exceeds 10% of the bank holding company’s consolidated net worth. However, prior approval is not required if the bank holding company is well-managed, not the subject of any unresolved supervisory issues and both before and immediately after the purchase or redemption is well-capitalized.

 

66


Table of Contents

Increasing Competition in Financial Services

The Dodd-Frank Act has established new standards for branching by out-of-state banks. Under the new standard, a bank may establish a de novo branch in any location in any state where a bank chartered in that state would be permitted to locate a branch.

Selected Regulation of Banking Activities

Transactions with Affiliates. Banks are subject to restrictions imposed by Sections 23A and 23B of Federal Reserve Act and regulations adopted by the Federal Reserve thereunder with regard to extensions of credit to affiliates, investments in securities issued by affiliates and the use of affiliates’ securities as collateral for loans to any borrower. Specifically, the Company’s subsidiary banks may only engage in lending and other “covered transactions” with non-bank and non-savings bank affiliates to the following extent: (a) in the case of any single such affiliate, the aggregate amount of covered transactions of the applicable subsidiary bank and its subsidiaries may not exceed 10% of the capital stock and surplus of the applicable subsidiary bank; and (b) in the case of all affiliates, the aggregate amount of covered transactions of the applicable subsidiary bank and its subsidiaries may not exceed 20% of the capital stock and surplus of the applicable subsidiary bank. Covered transactions are also subject to certain collateralization requirements. “Covered transactions” are defined by statute to include a loan or extension of credit, as well as a purchase of securities issued by an affiliate, a purchase of assets (unless otherwise exempted by the Federal Reserve) from the affiliate, the acceptance of securities issued by the affiliate as collateral for a loan, and the issuance of a guarantee, acceptance or letter of credit on behalf of an affiliate. The Dodd-Frank Act has expanded the definition of covered transactions and increased the timing and other aspects of the collateral requirements associated with covered transactions. All covered transactions, including certain additional transactions (such as transactions with a third party in which an affiliate has a financial interest), must be conducted on prevailing market terms and on terms substantially the same, or at least as favorable, to the bank as those prevailing at that time for comparable transactions with or involving other non-affiliated persons. These laws and regulations may limit the ability of Western Alliance to obtain funds from its subsidiary banks for its cash needs, including funds for payment of dividends, interest and operational expenses.

Insider Credit Transactions. Banks also are subject to certain restrictions regarding extensions of credit to executive officers, directors or principal shareholders of a bank and its affiliates or to any related interests of such persons (i.e., insiders). All extensions of credit to insiders must be made on substantially the same terms and pursuant to the same credit underwriting procedures as are applicable to comparable transactions with persons who are neither insiders nor employees, and must not involve more than the normal risk of repayment or present other unfavorable features. Insider loans also are subject to certain lending limits, restrictions on overdrafts to insiders and requirements for prior approval by the bank’s board of directors. In addition to enhancing restrictions on insider transactions, the Dodd-Frank Act increases the types of transactions with insiders subject to restrictions, including certain asset sales with insiders.

Lending Limits. In addition to the limits set forth above, state banking law generally limits the amount of funds that a bank may lend to a single borrower. Under Nevada law, the total obligations owed to a bank by one person generally may not exceed 25% of stockholders’ tangible equity. Under Arizona law, the obligations of one borrower to a bank may not exceed 20% of the bank’s capital, plus an additional 10% of its capital if the additional amounts are fully secured by readily marketable collateral. Under California law, the obligations of any one borrower to a bank generally may not exceed 25% of an amount equal to the sum of the bank’s shareholders’ equity, allowance for loan losses, capital notes and debentures, provided that the total unsecured obligations may not exceed 15% of such amount.

Cross-Guarantee Provisions. Each insured depository institution “controlled” (as defined in the BHC Act) by the same bank holding company can be held liable to the FDIC for any loss incurred, or reasonably expected to be incurred, by the FDIC due to the default of any other insured depository institution controlled by that holding company and for any assistance provided by the FDIC to any of those banks that is in danger of default. Such a “cross-guarantee” claim against a depository institution is generally superior in right of payment to claims of the holding company and its affiliates against that depository institution. As a result, one or more of the Company’s subsidiary banks may be required by the FDIC to satisfy the claims of another subsidiary bank if such a default were to ever occur.

Banking Agency Loan Guidance. In December 2006, the Federal Reserve, FDIC and other federal banking agencies issues final guidance on sound risk management practices for concentrations in commercial real estate (“CRE”) lending. The CRE guidance provided supervisory criteria, including numerical indicators to direct examiners in identifying institutions with potentially significant CRE loan concentrations that may warrant greater supervisory scrutiny. The CRE criteria do not constitute limits on CRE lending, but the CRE guidance does provide certain additional expectations, such as enhanced risk management practices and levels of capital, for banks with concentrations in CRE lending. The FDIC issued additional guidance in March 2008 reinforcing the 2006 guidance and addressing steps institutions with potentially significant CRE concentrations should take to reduce or mitigate the risk of the concentration.

During 2007, the Federal Reserve, FDIC and other federal banking agencies issued final guidance on subprime mortgage lending to address issues relating to certain subprime mortgages, especially adjustable-rate mortgage (“ARM”) products that can cause payment shock. The subprime guidance described the prudent safety and soundness and consumer protection standards that the regulators expect banks and financial institutions to follow to ensure borrowers obtain loans they can afford to repay.

 

67


Table of Contents

Tying Arrangements. Western Alliance and its subsidiary banks are prohibited from engaging in certain tying arrangements in connection with any extension of credit, sale or lease of property or furnishing of services. With certain exceptions for traditional banking services, Western Alliance’s subsidiary banks may not condition an extension of credit to a customer on a requirement that the customer obtain additional credit, property or services from the bank, Western Alliance or any of Western Alliance’s other subsidiaries, that the customer provide some additional credit, property or services to the bank, Western Alliance or any of Western Alliance’s other subsidiaries or that the customer refrain from obtaining credit, property or other services from a competitor.

Regulation of Management. Federal law sets forth circumstances under which officers or directors of a bank or bank holding company may be removed by the institution’s primary federal banking supervisory authority. Federal law also prohibits a management official of a bank or bank holding company from serving as a management official with an unaffiliated bank or bank holding company that has offices within a specified geographic area that is related to the location of the bank’s offices and the asset size of the institutions.

Safety and Soundness Standards. Federal law imposes upon banks certain non-capital safety and soundness standards. The federal banking agencies issued joint guidelines for safe and sound banking operations. These standards cover internal controls, information systems, internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate risk exposure, earnings asset growth, compensation and benefits. Additional standards apply to asset quality, earnings and stock valuation. An institution that fails to meet these standards must develop a plan, acceptable to its regulators, specifying the steps that the institution will take to meet the standards. Failure to submit or implement such a plan may subject the institution to regulatory sanctions.

Consumer Protection Laws and Regulations

The banking regulatory authorities have increased their attention in recent years to compliance with the consumer protection laws and their implementing regulations. Examination and enforcement have become more intense in nature, and insured institutions have been advised to monitor carefully compliance with such laws and regulations. The bank is subject to many federal consumer protection statutes and regulations, some of which are discussed below. The Dodd-Frank Act created the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (“Bureau”), which has rulemaking and oversight authority of the federal consumer financial protection laws. On July 21, 2011, the rulemaking and certain enforcement authority for enumerated federal consumer financial protection laws was transferred to the Bureau. As a result of this transfer, the Bureau now has significant interpretive and enforcement authority with respect to many of the federal laws and regulations under which we operate. In accordance with this authority, the Bureau has officially transferred many of the regulations formally maintained by the Federal Reserve and the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development, to a new chapter of Title 12 of the Code of Federal Regulations maintained by the Bureau, many of which deal with consumer credit, account disclosures and residential mortgage lending. Although the Bureau did not make significant or substantive changes to the rules as part of this transfer, it now has authority to promulgate guidance and interpretations of these rules and regulations in a manner that could differ from prior interpretations from other federal regulatory bodies.

Community Reinvestment Act. The Community Reinvestment Act (“CRA”) and its implementing regulations are intended to encourage insured depository institutions, while operating safely and soundly, to help meet the credit needs of their communities. The CRA specifically directs the federal regulatory agencies, when examining insured depository institutions, to assess a bank’s record of helping meet the credit needs of its entire community, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods, consistent with safe and sound banking practices. The CRA further requires the agencies to take a financial institution’s record of meeting its community credit needs into account when evaluating applications for, among other things, domestic branches, mergers or acquisitions, or holding company formations. A CRA rating other than “outstanding” or “satisfactory” can substantially delay or block a transaction. Based upon their most recent CRA examinations, Bank of Nevada received a rating of “outstanding”; First Independent Bank of Nevada received a rating of “outstanding”; Alliance Bank of Arizona received a rating of “satisfactory”; Torrey Pines Bank received a rating of “needs to improve”; and Alta Alliance Bank received a rating of “satisfactory.”

Equal Credit Opportunity Act. The Equal Credit Opportunity Act generally prohibits discrimination in any credit transaction, whether for consumer or business purposes, on the basis of race, color, religion, national origin, sex, marital status, age (except in limited circumstances), receipt of income from public assistance programs, or good faith exercise of any rights under the Consumer Credit Protection Act.

Truth in Lending Act. The Truth in Lending Act (“TILA”) is designed to ensure that credit terms are disclosed in a meaningful way so that consumers may compare credit terms more readily and knowledgeably. As a result of TILA, all creditors must use the same credit terminology to express rates and payments, including the annual percentage rate, the finance charge, the amount financed, the total of payments and the payment schedule, among other things.

 

68


Table of Contents

Fair Housing Act. The Fair Housing Act (“FHA”) regulates many practices, and makes it unlawful for any lender to discriminate in its housing-related lending activities against any person because of race, color, religion, national origin, sex, handicap or familial status. A number of lending practices have been found by the courts to be illegal under the FHA, including some practices that are not specifically mentioned in the FHA.

Home Mortgage Disclosure Act. The Home Mortgage Disclosure Act (“HMDA”) grew out of public concern over credit shortages in certain urban neighborhoods and provides public information that is intended to help to show whether financial institutions are serving the housing credit needs of the neighborhoods and communities in which they are located. The HMDA also includes a “fair lending” aspect that requires the collection and disclosure of data about applicant and borrower characteristics as a way of identifying possible discriminatory lending patterns and enforcing anti-discrimination statutes. Beginning with data reported for 2005, the amount of information that financial institutions collect and disclose concerning applicants and borrowers has expanded, which has increased the attention that HMDA data receives from state and federal banking supervisory authorities, community-oriented organizations and the general public.

Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act. The Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act (“RESPA”) requires lenders to provide borrowers with disclosures regarding the nature and cost of real estate settlements. RESPA also prohibits certain abusive practices, such as kickbacks and fee-splitting without providing settlement services.

Penalties under the above laws may include fines, reimbursements and other penalties. Due to heightened regulatory concern related to compliance with these laws generally, Western Alliance and its subsidiary banks may incur additional compliance costs or be required to expend additional funds for investments in its local community.

Predatory Lending

“Predatory lending” is a far-reaching concept and potentially covers a broad range of behavior. As such, it does not lend itself to a concise or comprehensive definition. However, predatory lending typically involves one or more of the following elements:

 

   

making unaffordable loans based on the borrower’s assets rather than the borrower’s ability to repay an obligation;

 

   

inducing a borrower to refinance a loan repeatedly in order to charge high points and fees each time the loan is refinanced, or loan flipping; and

 

   

engaging in fraud or deception to conceal the true nature of the loan obligation from an unsuspecting or unsophisticated borrower.

The Home Ownership Equity and Protection Act of 1994 (“HOEPA”) and regulations adopted by the Federal Reserve thereunder require certain disclosures and extend additional protection to borrowers in closed end consumer credit transactions, such as home repairs or renovation, that are secured by a mortgage on the borrower’s primary residence. The HOEPA disclosures and protections are applicable to such “high cost” transactions with any of the following features:

 

   

interest rates for first lien mortgage loans more than eight percentage points above the yield on U.S. Treasury securities having a comparable maturity;

 

   

interest rates for subordinate lien mortgage loans more than 10 percentage points above the yield on U.S. Treasury securities having a comparable maturity; or

 

   

total points and fees paid in connection with the credit transaction exceed the greater of either 8% of the loan amount or a specified dollar amount that is inflation-adjusted each year.

HOEPA prohibits or restricts numerous credit practices including loan flipping by the same lender or loan servicer within a year of the loan being refinanced. Lenders are presumed to have violated the law unless they document that the borrower has the ability to repay. Lenders that violate the rules face cancellation of loans and penalties equal to the finance charges paid. HOEPA also regulates so-called “reverse mortgages.”

In December 2007, the Federal Reserve issued proposed rules under HOEPA in order to address recent practices in the subprime mortgage market. The proposed rules would require disclosures and additional protections or prohibitions on certain practices connected with “higher-priced mortgages,” which the proposed rules define as closed-end mortgage loans that are secured by a consumer’s principal dwelling that carry interest rates that exceed the yield on comparable U.S. Treasury securities by at least 3 percentage points for first-lien loans, or 5 percentage points for subordinate-lien loans.

Privacy

Under the Gramm Leach Bliley Act (“GLBA”), all financial institutions, including Western Alliance, its bank subsidiaries and certain of their non-banking affiliates and subsidiaries are required to establish policies and procedures to restrict the sharing of non-public customer data with non-affiliated parties at the customer’s request and to protect customer data

 

69


Table of Contents

from unauthorized access. In addition, the Fair Credit Reporting Act of 1971 (“FCRA”) includes many provisions concerning national credit reporting standards and permits consumers, including customers of Western Alliance’s subsidiary banks, to opt out of information-sharing for marketing purposes among affiliated companies. The Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act of 2004 amended certain provisions of the FRCA and requires banks and other financial institutions to notify their customers if they report negative information about them to a credit bureau or if they are granted credit on terms less favorable than those generally available. The Federal Reserve and the Federal Trade Commission have extensive rulemaking authority under the FCRA, and Western Alliance and its subsidiary banks are subject to these provisions. Western Alliance has developed policies and procedures for itself and its subsidiaries to maintain compliance and believes it is in compliance with all privacy, information sharing and notification provisions of the GLBA Act and the FCRA.

Under California law, every business that owns or licenses personal information about a California resident must maintain reasonable security procedures and policies to protect that information. All customer records that contain personal information and that are no longer required to be retained must be destroyed. Any person that conducts business in California maintains customers’ personal information in unencrypted computer records and experiences a breach of security with regard to those records must promptly disclose the breach to all California residents whose personal information was or is reasonably believed to have been acquired by unauthorized persons as a result of such breach. Any person who maintains computerized personal data for others and experiences a breach of security must promptly inform the owner or licensee of the breach. A business may not provide personal information of its customers to third parties for direct mailing purposes unless the customer “opts in” to such information sharing. A business that fails to provide this privilege to its customers must report the uses made of its customers’ data upon a customer’s request.

Compliance

In order to assure that Western Alliance and its subsidiary banks are in compliance with the laws and regulations that apply to their operations, including those summarized herein, Western Alliance and each of its subsidiary banks employs a compliance officer. Western Alliance is regularly reviewed by the Federal Reserve and the subsidiary banks are regularly reviewed by their respective state and federal banking agencies, as part of which their compliance with applicable laws and regulations is assessed.

Corporate Governance and Accounting Legislation

Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act (“SOX”) was adopted for the stated purpose to increase corporate responsibility, enhance penalties for accounting and auditing improprieties at publicly traded companies, and protect investors by improving the accuracy and reliability of corporate disclosures pursuant to the securities laws. It applies generally to all companies that file or are required to file periodic reports with the SEC under the Exchange Act, which includes Western Alliance. Under SOX, the SEC and securities exchanges adopted extensive additional disclosure, corporate governance and other related rules. Among its provisions, SOX subjects bonuses issued to top executives to disgorgement if a subsequent restatement of a company’s financial statements was due to corporate misconduct, prohibits an officer or director from misleading or coercing an auditor, prohibits insider trades during pension fund “blackout periods,” imposes new criminal penalties for fraud and other wrongful acts and extends the period during which certain securities fraud lawsuits can be brought against a company or its officers.

Anti-Money Laundering and Anti-Terrorism Legislation

Congress enacted the Bank Secrecy Act of 1970 (the “BSA”) to require financial institutions, including Western Alliance and its subsidiary banks, to maintain certain records and to report certain transactions to prevent such institutions from being used to hide money derived from criminal activity and tax evasion. The BSA establishes, among other things: (a) record keeping requirements to assist government enforcement agencies in tracing financial transactions and flow of funds; (b) reporting requirements for Suspicious Activity Reports and Currency Transaction Reports to assist government enforcement agencies in detecting patterns of criminal activity; (c) enforcement provisions authorizing criminal and civil penalties for illegal activities and violations of the BSA and its implementing regulations; and (d) safe harbor provisions that protect financial institutions from civil liability for their cooperative efforts.

Title III of the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 (the “USA PATRIOT Act”) amended the BSA and incorporates anti-terrorist financing provisions into the requirements of the BSA and its implementing regulations. Among other things, the USA PATRIOT Act requires all financial institutions, including Western Alliance, its subsidiary banks and several of their non-banking affiliates and subsidiaries, to institute and maintain a risk-based anti-money laundering compliance program that includes a customer identification program, provides for information sharing with law enforcement and between certain financial institutions by means of an exemption from the privacy provisions of the GLB Act, prohibits U.S. banks and broker-dealers from maintaining accounts with foreign “shell” banks, establishes due diligence and enhanced due diligence requirements for certain foreign correspondent banking and foreign private banking accounts and imposes additional record keeping requirements for certain correspondent banking arrangements. The USA PATRIOT Act also grants broad authority to the Secretary of the Treasury to take actions to combat money laundering, and federal bank regulators are required to evaluate the effectiveness of an applicant in combating money laundering in determining

 

70


Table of Contents

whether to approve any application submitted by a financial institution. Western Alliance and its affiliates have adopted policies, procedures and controls to comply with the BSA and the USA PATRIOT Act, and they engage in very few transactions of any kind with foreign financial institutions or foreign persons.

The Treasury’s Office of Foreign Asset Control (“OFAC”) administers and enforces economic and trade sanctions against targeted foreign countries, entities and individuals based on U.S. foreign policy and national security goals. As a result, financial institutions, including Western Alliance, its subsidiary banks and several of their non-banking affiliates and subsidiaries, must scrutinize transactions to ensure that they do not represent obligations of, or ownership interests in, entities owned or controlled by sanctioned targets. In addition, Western Alliance, its subsidiary banks and several of their non-banking affiliates and subsidiaries restrict transactions with certain targeted countries except as permitted by OFAC.

Regulatory Reform

As noted throughout, the requirements of the Dodd-Frank Act call for a number of rulemakings, studies and regulatory guidance from federal regulators. Additionally, some rulemaking, regulatory and oversight functions currently exercised by the Federal banking agencies, such as the Federal Reserve and the FDIC, will be transferred to the Bureau, which will be tasked with rulemaking and, in some cases, oversight and examination for consumer financial protection laws. The Company and its subsidiary banks continue to monitor this ongoing regulatory process to determine the level of impact that it will have on its operations and activities.

Although the Dodd-Frank Act contains some specific timelines for the Federal regulatory agencies to follow, it remains unclear whether the agencies will be able to meet these deadlines and when rules will be proposed and finalized. While our current assessment is that the Dodd-Frank Act and the implementing regulations will not have a material effect on the Company, given the uncertainty associated with the manner in which the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act will be implemented, the full extent of the impact such requirements will have on our operations is unclear. The changes resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act may impact the profitability of our business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. These changes may also require us to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any changes necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements. Failure to comply with the new requirements would negatively impact our results of operations and financial condition. While we cannot predict what effect any presently contemplated or future changes in the laws or regulations or their interpretations would have on us, these changes could be materially adverse to our investors.

 

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

For a discussion of quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk, please see Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure about Market Risk” on page 56.

 

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

Our consolidated financial statements and supplementary data included in this annual report begin at page 74 immediately following the index to consolidated financial statements page to this annual report.

 

71


Table of Contents

McGladrey & Pullen, LLP

Certified Public Accountants

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders

Western Alliance Bancorporation

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Western Alliance Bancorporation and Subsidiaries (collectively referred to herein as the Company) as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission, and our report dated March 2, 2012 expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

/s/ McGLADREY & PULLEN, LLP

Phoenix, Arizona

March 2, 2012

 

72


Table of Contents

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

     PAGE  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     72   

Consolidated Financial Statements

     73   

Consolidated Balance Sheets

     74   

Consolidated Statements of Operations

     75   

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

     77   

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity

     78   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

     79   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     81   

 

73


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     (in thousands, except per share  
     amounts)  

Assets:

    

Cash and due from banks

   $ 116,866      $ 87,984   

Federal funds sold

     —          918   

Interest-bearing demand deposits in other financial institutions

     38,129        127,844   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

     154,995        216,746   

Money market investments

     7,343        37,733   

Investment securities—measured, at fair value

     6,515        14,301   

Investment securities—available-for-sale, at fair value; amortized cost of $1,198,185 at December 31, 2011 and $1,187,608 at December 31, 2010

     1,190,385        1,172,913   

Investment securities—held-to-maturity, at amortized cost; fair value of $290,035 at December 31, 2011 and $47,996 at December 31, 2010

     286,258        48,151   

Investments in restricted stock, at cost

     33,520        36,877   

Loans:

    

Held for investment, net of deferred fees

     4,780,069        4,240,542   

Less: allowance for credit losses

     99,170        110,699   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total loans

     4,680,899        4,129,843   

Premises and equipment, net

     105,546        114,372   

Goodwill

     25,925        25,925   

Other intangible assets

     9,807        13,366   

Other assets acquired through foreclosure, net

     89,104        107,655   

Bank owned life insurance

     133,898        129,808   

Deferred tax assets, net

     61,724        79,860   

Prepaid expenses

     16,470        24,741   

Other assets

     42,093        41,501   

Discontinued operations, assets held for sale

     59        91   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 6,844,541      $ 6,193,883   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities:

    

Deposits:

    

Non-interest-bearing demand

   $ 1,558,211      $ 1,443,251   

Interest-bearing

     4,100,301        3,895,190   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deposits

     5,658,512        5,338,441   

Customer repurchase agreements

     123,626        109,409   

Other borrowings

     353,321        72,964   

Junior subordinated debt, at fair value

     36,985        43,034   

Other liabilities

     35,414        27,861   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     6,207,858        5,591,709   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies (Note 12)

    

Stockholders’ equity:

    

Preferred stock—par value $.0001 and liquidation value per share of $1,000; 20,000,000 authorized; 141,000 issued and outstanding at December 31, 2011 and 140,000 at December 31, 2010

     141,000        130,827   

Common stock—par value $.0001; 200,000,000 authorized; 82,361,655 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2011 and 81,668,565 at December 31, 2010

     8        8   

Surplus

     743,780        739,561   

Retained deficit

     (243,512     (258,800

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

     (4,593     (9,422
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     636,683        602,174   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

   $ 6,844,541      $ 6,193,883   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See the accompanying notes.

 

74


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands except per share amounts)  

Interest income:

      

Loans, including fees

   $ 261,443      $ 255,626      $ 248,098   

Investment securities—taxable

     28,712        22,818        24,318   

Investment securities—non-taxable

     2,013        122        404   

Dividends—taxable

     1,124        617        680   

Dividends—non-taxable

     2,570        1,359        1,287   

Other

     729        1,271        1,236   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

     296,591        281,813        276,023   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest expense:

      

Deposits

     27,977        41,329        61,905   

Customer repurchase agreements

     336        538        3,629   

Other borrowings

     8,282        3,745        3,234   

Junior subordinated and subordinated debt

     2,328        3,648        4,966   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest expense

     38,923        49,260        73,734   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

     257,668        232,553        202,289   

Provision for credit losses

     46,188        93,211        149,099   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

     211,480        139,342        53,190   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-interest income:

      

Securities impairment charges, net

     (226     (1,186     (45,831

Portion of impairment charges recognized in other comprehensive loss (before taxes)

     —          —          2,047   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net securities impairment charges recognized in earnings

     (226     (1,186     (43,784

Gain on sales of securities, net

     4,798        19,757        16,100   

Mark to market gains (losses), net

     5,621        (369     3,631   

Gain on extinguishment of debt

     —          3,000        —     

Service charges and fees

     9,102        8,969        8,172   

Trust and investment advisory fees

     2,537        4,003        9,287   

Other fee revenue

     3,453        3,324        2,754   

Income from bank owned life insurance

     5,372        3,299        2,193   

Operating lease income

     1,878        3,793        4,066   

Other

     1,922        2,246        2,016   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-interest income

     34,457        46,836        4,435   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-interest expense:

      

Salaries and employee benefits

     93,140        86,586        91,504   

Occupancy expense, net

     19,972        19,580        20,802   

Net loss on sales/valuations of repossessed assets and bank premises, net

     24,592        28,826        21,274   

Goodwill impairment

     —          —          49,671   

Insurance

     11,045        15,475        12,525   

Loan and repossessed asset expense

     8,126        8,076        6,363   

Legal, professional and director fees

     7,678        7,591        8,973   

Marketing

     4,676        4,061        4,915   

Data processing

     3,566        3,374        4,274   

Intangible amortization

     3,559        3,604        3,781   

Customer service

     3,336        4,256        4,290   

Merger/restructure expenses

     1,564        1,651        —     

Operating lease depreciation

     1,201        2,506        3,229   

Other

     13,143        11,172        11,376   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-interest expense

     195,598        196,758        242,977   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before provision income taxes

     50,339        (10,580     (185,352

Income tax provision (benefit)

     16,849        (6,410     (38,453
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     33,490        (4,170     (146,899

Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax benefit

     (1,996     (3,025     (4,507
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

     31,494        (7,195     (151,406

Dividends and accretion on preferred stock

     16,206        9,882        9,742   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) available to common shareholders

   $ 15,288      $ (17,077   $ (161,148
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

75


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

(continued)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

Income (loss) per share—basic and diluted

      

Continuing operations

   $ 0.21      $ (0.19   $ (2.66

Discontinued

     (0.02     (0.04     (0.08
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 0.19      $ (0.23   $ (2.74

Average number of common shares—basic

     80,909        75,083        58,836   

Average number of common shares—diluted

     81,183        75,083        58,836   

Dividends declared per common share

   $ —        $ —        $ —     

See the accompanying notes.

 

76


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands)  

Net income (loss)

   $ 31,494      $ (7,195   $ (151,406
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), net:

      

Unrealized gain (loss) on securities AFS, net

     7,194        (2,865     13,422   

Impairment loss on securities, net

     144        736        32,858   

Unrealized gain on cash flow hedge, net

     519        —          —     

Realized gain on sale of securities AFS included in income, net

     (3,028     (12,698     (7,536
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net other comprehensive income (loss)

     4,829        (14,827     38,744   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

   $ 36,323      $ (22,022   $ (112,662
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amount of impairment losses reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income into earnings

   $ 226      $ 1,186      $ 43,784   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax benefit related to impairment losses

   $ 82      $ 450      $ 10,926   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See the accompanying notes.

 

77


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

                                   Accumulated              
                                   Other     Retained     Total  
    Preferred Stock     Common Stock           Comprehensive     Earnings     Shareholders’  
    Shares     Amount     Shares      Amount     Surplus     Income (Loss)     (Deficit)     Equity  
    (in thousands)  

Balance, December 31, 2008:

    140      $ 125,203        38,601       $ 4      $ 484,205      $ (28,491   $ (85,424   $ 495,497   

Adoption of ASC 320

    —          —          —           —          —          (4,848     4,848        —     

Net loss

    —          —          —           —          —          —          (151,406     (151,406

Issuance of common stock, net (1)

    —          —          33,441         3        191,056        —          —          191,059   

Exercise of stock options

    —          —          28         —          78        —          —          78   

Stock-based compensation

    —          —          247         —          3,283        —          —          3,283   

Restricted stock grants, net

    —          —          187         —          5,470        —          —          5,470   

Accretion on preferred stock discount

    —          2,742        —           —          —          —          (2,742     —     

Dividends on preferred stock

    —          —          —           —          —          —          (7,000     (7,000

Other comprehensive income, net

    —          —          —           —          —          38,744        —          38,744   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2009

    140        127,945        72,504         7        684,092        5,405        (241,724     575,725   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

    —          —          —           —          —          —          (7,195     (7,195

Issuance of common stock, net (2)

    —          —          8,050         1        47,573        —          —          47,574   

Exercise of stock options

    —          —          30         —          164        —          —          164   

Exercise of common stock warrants

    —          —          162         —          195        —          —          195   

Stock-based compensation

    —          —          276         —          3,126        —          —          3,126   

Restricted stock grants, net

    —          —          647         —          4,411        —          —          4,411   

Accretion on preferred stock discount

    —          2,882        —           —          —          —          (2,882     —     

Dividends on preferred stock

    —          —          —           —          —          —          (7,000     (7,000

Other comprehensive income, net

    —          —          —           —          —          (14,827     —          (14,827
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2010

    140        130,827        81,669         8        739,561        (9,422     (258,800     602,174   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

    —          —          —           —          —          —          31,494        31,494   

Exercise of stock options

    —          —          53         —          362        —          —          362   

Stock-based compensation

    —          —          304         —          2,692        —          —          2,692   

Restricted stock grants, net

    —          —          336         —          1,580        —          —          1,580   

Preferred stock redemption and accelerated accretion of preferred stock discount

    (140     (133,086     —           —          —          —          (6,914     (140,000

Issuance of preferred stock

    141        141,000        —           —          —          —          —          141,000   

Dividends on preferred stock

    —          —          —           —          —          —          (7,033     (7,033

Accretion on preferred stock discount

    —          2,259        —           —          —          —          (2,259     —     

Repurchase of warrant

    —          —          —           —          (415     —          —          (415

Other comprehensive loss, net

    —          —          —           —          —          4,829        —          4,829   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2011

    141      $ 141,000        82,362       $ 8      $ 743,780      $ (4,593   $ (243,512   $ 636,683   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Net of offering costs of $9,582
(2) Net of offering costs of $2,738

See the accompanying notes.

 

78


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands)  

Cash flows from operating activities:

      

Net income (loss)

   $ 31,494      $ (7,195   $ (151,406

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to cash provided by operating activities:

      

Provision for credit losses

     46,188        93,211        149,099   

Depreciation and amortization

     10,623        14,091        15,489   

Stock-based compensation

     4,272        7,537        8,753   

Deferred income taxes and income taxes receivable

     15,303        (7,592     (46,300

Net amortization of discounts and premiums for investment securities

     8,339        6,309        1,664   

Goodwill impairment

     —          —          49,671   

Securities impairment

     226        1,186        43,784   

(Gains)/Losses on:

      

Sales of securities, AFS

     (4,798     (19,757     (16,100

Derivatives

     238        269        263   

Sale of repossessed assets, net

     24,022        29,224        21,274   

Sale of premises and equipment, net

     673        (398     (112

Sale of loans, net

     (103     (16     (328

Sale of subsidiary, net

     —          (568     (54

Extinguishment of debt

     —          (3,000     —     

Changes in:

      

Other assets

     3,518        (40,994     (63,571

Other liabilities

     7,910        (72,411     66,555   

Fair value of assets and liabilities measured at fair value

     (5,621     369        (3,631

Servicing rights, net

     191        35        37   

Other, net

     —          —          (332
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

     142,475        300        74,755   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

      

Proceeds from loan sales

     1,851        —          13,242   

Proceeds from sale of securities measured at fair value

     2,907        29,415        22,419   

Principal pay downs and maturities of securities measured at fair value

     4,919        15,609        39,664   

Proceeds from sale of available-for-sale securities

     506,162        492,159        88,489   

Principal pay downs and maturities of available-for-sale securities

     324,160        867,667        117,757   

Purchase of available-for-sale securities

     (843,813     (1,790,489     (503,285

Purchases of securities held-to-maturity

     (239,627     (45,000     —     

Proceeds from maturities of securities held-to-maturity

     640        3,686        495   

Loan originations and principal collections, net

     (646,583     (339,331     (112,143

Investment in money market

     30,390        16,296        (54,029

Liquidation (purchase) of restricted stock

     3,357        4,501        (1,174

Sale and purchase of premises and equipment, net

     1,089        1,422        4,951   

Proceeds from sale of other real estate owned and repossessed assets , net

     42,120        33,777        15,418   

Other, net

     —          —          (46
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash (used) in investing activities

     (812,428     (710,288     (368,242
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

79


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(continued)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands)  

Cash flows from financing activities:

      

Net increase in deposits

     320,071        616,339        938,116   

Deposits purchased from the FDIC

     —          —          131,720   

Net increase/(decrease) in borrowings

     294,217        (127,368     (703,986

Proceeds from issuance of common stock options and stock warrants

     362        359        78   

Proceeds from issuance stock, net

     —          47,574        191,268   

Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock

     141,000        —          —     

Redemption of preferred stock

     (140,000     —          —     

Repurchase of warrant

     (415     —          —     

Cash dividends paid on preferred stock

     (7,033     (7,000     (6,833
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     608,202        529,904        550,363   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents

     (61,751     (180,084     256,876   

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     216,746        396,830        139,954   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

   $ 154,995      $ 216,746      $ 396,830   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental disclosure:

      

Cash paid (received) during the period for:

      

Interest

   $ 40,301      $ 47,354      $ 73,851   

Income taxes

     —          —          (47,249

Non-cash investing and financing activity:

      

Transfers to other assets acquired through foreclosure, net

     47,591        87,310        68,802   

Change in unrealized holding loss on AFS securities, net of tax

     4,310        (15,489     34,558   

Change in unrealized holding gain on cash flow hedge, net of tax

     519        —          —     

Change in OTTI on HTM securities, net of tax

     —          662        (662

See the accompanying notes.

 

80


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Nature of Operation

Western Alliance Bancorporation (“WAL” or “the Company”), incorporated under the laws of the state of Nevada, is a bank holding company providing full service banking and related services to locally owned businesses, professional firms, real estate developers and investors, local non-profit organizations, high net worth individuals and other consumers through its three wholly owned subsidiary banks: Bank of Nevada, operating in Nevada, Western Alliance Bank, operating in Arizona and Northern Nevada and Torrey Pines Bank, operating in California. In addition, its non-bank subsidiaries, Shine Investment Advisory Services, Inc. and Western Alliance Equipment Finance, offer an array of financial products and services aimed at satisfying the needs of small to mid-sized businesses and their proprietors, including financial planning, investment advice, and equipment finance nationwide. These entities are collectively referred to herein as the Company.

Basis of Presentation

The accounting and reporting policies of the Company are in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”) and conform to practices within the financial services industry. The accounts of the Company and its consolidated subsidiaries are included in these Consolidated Financial Statements. All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated.

Use of estimates in the preparation of financial statements

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant changes in the near term relate to the determination of the allowance for credit losses; fair value of other real estate owned; determination of the valuation allowance related to deferred tax assets; impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets and other than temporary impairment on securities. Although Management believes these estimates to be reasonably accurate, actual amounts may differ. In the opinion of Management, all adjustments considered necessary have been reflected in the financial statements during their preparation.

Principles of consolidation

WAL has 10 wholly-owned subsidiaries: Bank of Nevada (“BON”), Western Alliance Bank (“WAB”), Torrey Pines Bank (“TPB”), which are all banking subsidiaries; Western Alliance Equipment Finance, Inc. (“WAEF”), which provides equipment finance services; and six unconsolidated subsidiaries used as business trusts in connection with issuance of trust-preferred securities. In addition, WAL maintains an 80 percent interest in Shine Investment Advisory Services Inc. (“Shine”), a registered investment advisor. WAL divested formerly wholly-owned subsidiary Premier Trust, Inc. as of September 1, 2010.

BON has three wholly-owned subsidiaries: BW Real Estate, Inc. which operates as a real estate investment trust and holds certain of BON’s real estate loans and related securities; BON Investments, Inc., which holds certain securities; and BW Nevada Holdings, LLC, which owns the Company’s 2700 West Sahara Avenue, Las Vegas, Nevada location.

WAB has one wholly-owned subsidiary, WAB Investments, Inc., which holds certain securities and TPB has one wholly-owned subsidiary, TPB Investments, Inc., which holds certain securities.

The Company does not have any other entities that should be considered for consolidation. All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

Reclassifications

Certain amounts in the consolidated financial statements as of and for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 have been reclassified to conform to the current presentation. The reclassifications have no effect on net income or stockholders’ equity as previously reported.

Cash and cash equivalents

For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, amounts due from banks (including cash items in process of clearing) and federal funds sold. Cash flows from loans originated by the Company and deposits are reported net.

The Company maintains amounts due from banks, which at times may exceed federally insured limits. The Company has not experienced any losses in such accounts.

 

81


Table of Contents

Cash reserve requirements

Depository institutions are required by law to maintain reserves against their transaction deposits. The reserves must be held in cash or with the Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”). The amount of the reserve varies by bank as the banks are permitted to meet this requirement by maintaining the specified amount as an average balance over a two-week period. The total of reserve balances was approximately $18.4 million both as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.

Investment securities

Investment securities may be classified as held-to-maturity (“HTM”), available-for-sale (“AFS”) or trading. The appropriate classification is initially decided at the time of purchase. Securities classified as held-to-maturity are those debt securities the Company has both the intent and ability to hold to maturity regardless of changes in market conditions, liquidity needs or general economic conditions. These securities are carried at amortized cost. The sale of a security within three months of its maturity date or after at least 85 percent of the principal outstanding has been collected is considered a maturity for purposes of classification and disclosure.

Securities classified as AFS or trading are reported as an asset on the Consolidated Balance Sheets at their estimated fair value. As the fair value of AFS securities changes, the changes are reported net of income tax as an element of other comprehensive income (“OCI”), except for impaired securities. When AFS securities are sold, the unrealized gain or loss is reclassified from OCI to non-interest income. The changes in the fair values of trading securities are reported in non-interest income. Securities classified as AFS are both equity and debt securities the Company intends to hold for an indefinite period of time, but not necessarily to maturity. Any decision to sell a security classified as AFS would be based on various factors, including significant movements in interest rates, changes in the maturity mix of the Company’s assets and liabilities, liquidity needs, decline in credit quality, and regulatory capital considerations.

Interest income is recognized based on the coupon rate and increased by accretion of discounts earned or decreased by the amortization of premiums paid over the contractual life of the security using the interest method. For mortgage-backed securities, estimates of prepayments are considered in the constant yield calculations.

In estimating whether there are any other than temporary impairment losses, management considers 1) the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than amortized cost, 2) the financial condition and near term prospects of the issuer, 3) the impact of changes in market interest rates, and 4) the intent and ability of the Company to retain its investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value and it is not more likely than not the Company would be required to sell the security.

Declines in the fair value of individual debt securities available for sale that are deemed to be other than temporary are reflected in earnings when identified. The fair value of the debt security then becomes the new cost basis. For individual debt securities where the Company does not intend to sell the security and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, the other than temporary decline in fair value of the debt security related to 1) credit loss is recognized in earnings, and 2) market or other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income or loss. Credit loss is recorded if the present value of cash flows is less than amortized cost. For individual debt securities where the Company intends to sell the security or more likely than not will not recover all of its amortized cost, the other than temporary impairment is recognized in earnings equal to the entire difference between the securities cost basis and its fair value at the balance sheet date. For individual debt securities for which a credit loss has been recognized in earnings, interest accruals and amortization and accretion of premiums and discounts are suspended when the credit loss is recognized. Interest received after accruals have been suspended is recognized on a cash basis.

Restricted stock

The Company’s subsidiary banks are members of the Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) system and maintain an investment in capital stock of the FHLB based on the borrowing capacity used by each bank. The Company’s subsidiary banks also maintain an investment in their primary correspondent bank. These investments are considered equity securities with no actively traded market. Therefore, the shares are considered restricted investment securities. These investments are carried at cost, which is equal to the value at which they may be redeemed. The dividend income received from the stock is reported in interest income. Our investment in FHLB stock is carried at cost. We conduct a periodic review and evaluation of our FHLB stock to determine if any impairment exists.

Derivative financial instruments

Derivatives are recognized on the balance sheet at their fair value, with changes in fair value reported in current-period earnings. These instruments consist primarily of interest rate swaps.

Certain derivative transactions that meet specified criteria qualify for hedge accounting. The Company occasionally purchases a financial instrument or originates a loan that contains an embedded derivative instrument. Upon purchasing the instrument or originating the loan, the Company assesses whether the economic characteristics of the embedded

 

82


Table of Contents

derivative are clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the remaining component of the financial instrument (i.e., the host contract) and whether a separate instrument with the same terms as the embedded instrument would meet the definition of a derivative instrument. When it is determined that (1) the embedded derivative possesses economic characteristics that are not clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the host contract, and (2) a separate instrument with the same terms would qualify as a derivative instrument, the embedded derivative is separated from the host contract and carried at fair value. However, in cases where (1) the host contract is measured at fair value, with changes in fair value reported in current earnings or (2) the Company is unable to reliably identify and measure an embedded derivative for separation from its host contract, the entire contract is carried on the balance sheet at fair value and is not designated as a hedging instrument.

Loans, interest and fees from loans

The Company generally holds loans for investment and has the intent and ability to hold loans until their maturity. Therefore, they are reported at book value. Net loans are stated at the amount of unpaid principal, reduced by unearned loan fees and allowance for credit losses.

Interest income on loans is accrued daily using the effective interest method and recognized over the terms of the loans. Loan fees collected for the origination of loans less direct loan origination costs (net deferred loan fees) are amortized over the contractual life of the loan through interest income. If the loan has scheduled payments, the amortization of the net deferred loan fee is calculated using the interest method over the contractual life of the loan. If the loan does not have scheduled payments, such as a line of credit, the net deferred loan fee is recognized as interest income on a straight-line basis over the contractual life of the loan commitment. Commitment fees based on a percentage of a customer’s unused line of credit and fees related to standby letters of credit are recognized over the commitment period.

When loans are repaid, any remaining unamortized balances of unearned fees, deferred fees and costs and premiums and discounts paid on purchased loans are accounted for though interest income.

Nonaccrual loans: For all loan types except credit cards, when a borrower discontinues making payments as contractually required by the note, the Company must determine whether it is appropriate to continue to accrue interest. Generally, the Company places loans in a nonaccrual status and ceases recognizing interest income when the loan has become delinquent by more than 90 days or when Management determines that the full repayment of principal and collection of interest is unlikely. The Company may decide to continue to accrue interest on certain loans more than 90 days delinquent if they are well secured by collateral and in the process of collection. Credit card loans and other personal loans are typically charged off no later than 180 days delinquent.

For all loan types, when a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, all interest accrued but uncollected is reversed against interest income in the period in which the status is changed. Subsequent payments received from the customer are applied to principal and no further interest income is recognized until the principal has been paid in full or until circumstances have changed such that payments are again consistently received as contractually required. The Company occasionally recognizes income on a cash basis for non-accrual loans in which the collection of the remaining principal balance is not in doubt.

Impaired loans: A loan is identified as impaired when it is probable that interest and principal will not be collected according to the contractual terms of the original loan agreement. These loans generally have balances greater than $250,000 and are rated substandard or worse. An exception to this would be any known impaired loans regardless of balance. Most impaired loans are classified as nonaccrual. However, there are some loans that are termed impaired due to doubt regarding collectability according to contractual terms, but are both fully secured by collateral and are current in their interest and principal payments. These impaired loans are not classified as nonaccrual. Impaired loans are measured for reserve requirements in accordance with ASC Topic 310, Receivables, based on the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate or, as a practical expedient, at the loan’s observable market price or the fair value of the collateral less applicable disposition costs if the loan is collateral dependent. The amount of an impairment reserve, if any, and any subsequent changes are charged against the allowance for credit losses.

Troubled Debt Restructured Loans: A troubled debt restructured loan is a loan on which the Bank, for reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, grants a concession to the borrower that the Bank would not otherwise consider. The loan terms that have been modified or restructured due to a borrower’s financial situation include, but are not limited to, a reduction in the stated interest rate, an extension of the maturity or renewal of the loan at an interest rate below current market, a reduction in the face amount of the debt, a reduction in the accrued interest, extensions, deferrals, renewals and rewrites. A troubled debt restructured loan is also considered impaired. Generally, a loan that is modified at an effective market rate of interest may no longer be disclosed as a troubled debt restructuring in years subsequent to the restructuring if it is not impaired based on the terms specified by the restructuring agreement.

 

83


Table of Contents

Allowance for credit losses

Credit risk is inherent in the business of extending loans and leases to borrowers. Like other financial institutions, the Company must maintain an adequate allowance for credit losses. The allowance for credit losses is established through a provision for credit losses charged to expense. Loans are charged against the allowance for credit losses when Management believes that the contractual principal or interest will not be collected. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. The allowance is an amount believed adequate to absorb probable losses on existing loans that may become uncollectable, based on evaluation of the collectability of loans and prior credit loss experience, together with other factors. The Company formally re-evaluates and establishes the appropriate level of the allowance for credit losses on a quarterly basis.

The Company’s allowance for credit loss methodology incorporates several quantitative and qualitative risk factors used to establish the appropriate allowance for credit losses at each reporting date. Quantitative factors include our historical loss experience, delinquency and charge-off trends, collateral values, changes in the level of nonperforming loans and other factors. Qualitative factors include the economic condition of our operating markets and the state of certain industries. Specific changes in the risk factors are based on perceived risk of similar groups of loans classified by collateral type, purpose and term. An internal one-year and three-year loss history are also incorporated into the allowance calculation model. Due to the credit concentration of our loan portfolio in real estate secured loans, the value of collateral is heavily dependent on real estate values in Nevada, Arizona and California, which have declined substantially from their peak. While management uses the best information available to make its evaluation, future adjustments to the allowance may be necessary if there are significant changes in economic or other conditions. In addition, the FDIC and state bank regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their examination processes, periodically review our subsidiary banks’ allowances for credit losses, and may require us to make additions to our allowance based on their judgment about information available to them at the time of their examinations. Management regularly reviews the assumptions and formulae used in determining the allowance and makes adjustments if required to reflect the current risk profile of the portfolio.

The allowance consists of specific and general components. The specific allowance relates to impaired loans. In general, impaired loans include those where interest recognition has been suspended, loans that are more than 90 days delinquent but because of adequate collateral coverage, income continues to be recognized, and other criticized and classified loans not paying substantially according to the original contract terms. For such loans, an allowance is established when the discounted cash flows, collateral value or observable market price of the impaired loan are lower than the carrying value of that loan, pursuant to FASB ASC 310, Receivables (“ASC 310”). Loans not collateral dependent are evaluated based on the expected future cash flows discounted at the original contractual interest rate. The amount to which the present value falls short of the current loan obligation will be set up as a reserve for that account or charged-off.

The Company uses an appraised value method to determine the need for a reserve on impaired, collateral dependent loans and further discounts the appraisal for disposition costs. Due to the rapidly changing economic and market conditions of the regions within which we operate, the Company obtains independent collateral valuation analysis on a regular basis for each loan, typically every six months.

The general allowance covers all non-impaired loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for the various qualitative and quantitative factors listed above. The change in the allowance from one reporting period to the next may not directly correlate to the rate of change of the nonperforming loans for the following reasons:

1. A loan moving from impaired performing to impaired nonperforming does not mandate an increased reserve. The individual account is evaluated for a specific reserve requirement when the loan moves to impaired status, not when it moves to nonperforming status, and is reevaluated at each subsequent reporting period. Because our nonperforming loans are predominately collateral dependent, reserves are primarily based on collateral value, which is not affected by borrower performance but rather by market conditions.

2. Not all impaired accounts require a specific reserve. The payment performance of the borrower may require an impaired classification, but the collateral evaluation may support adequate collateral coverage. For a number of impaired accounts in which borrower performance has ceased, the collateral coverage is now sufficient because a partial charge off of the account has been taken. In those instances, neither a general reserve nor a specific reserve is assessed.

Transfers of financial assets

Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when control over the assets has been surrendered. Control over transferred assets is deemed surrendered when 1) the assets have been isolated from the Company, 2) the transferee obtains the right to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and 3) the Company no longer maintains effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase the transferred assets before maturity.

 

84


Table of Contents

Off-balance sheet instruments

In the ordinary course of business, the Company has entered into off-balance sheet financial instruments consisting of commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit. Such financial instruments are recorded in the consolidated financial statements when they are funded. They involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk in excess of amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets. Losses would be experienced when the Company is contractually obligated to make a payment under these instruments and must seek repayment from the borrower, which may not be as financially sound in the current period as they were when the commitment was originally made. Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. The Company enters into credit arrangements that generally provide for the termination of advances in the event of a covenant violation or other event of default. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The Company evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the Company upon extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation of the party. The commitments are collateralized by the same types of assets used as loan collateral.

As with outstanding loans, the Company applies qualitative factors and utilization rates to its off-balance sheet obligations in determining an estimate of losses inherent in these contractual obligations. The estimate for credit losses on off-balance sheet instruments is included within other liabilities and the charge to income that establishes this liability is include in non-interest expense.

Other assets acquired through foreclosure

Other assets acquired through foreclosure consist primarily of properties acquired as a result of, or in-lieu-of, foreclosure. Properties or other assets (primarily repossessed assets formerly leased) are classified as other real estate owned and other repossessed property and are initially reported at fair value of the asset less estimated selling costs. Subsequent write downs are based on the lower of carrying value or fair value, less estimated costs to sell the property. Costs relating to the development or improvement of the assets are capitalized and costs relating to holding the assets are charged to non-interest expense. Property is evaluated regularly to ensure the recorded amount is supported by its current fair value and valuation allowances.

Premises and equipment

Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation is computed principally by the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the terms of the lease or the estimated lives of the improvements, whichever is shorter. Depreciation and amortization is computed using the following estimated lives:

 

     Years

Bank premises

   31

Equipment and furniture

   3 - 10

Leasehold improvements

   3 - 10

Management periodically reviews premises and equipment in order to determine if facts and circumstances suggest that the value of an asset is not recoverable.

Goodwill

The Company recorded as goodwill the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired in accordance with applicable guidance. As per this guidance, a two-step process is outlined for impairment testing of goodwill. Impairment testing is generally performed annually, as well as when an event triggering impairment may have occurred. The first step tests for impairment, while the second step, if necessary, measures the impairment. The resulting impairment amount if any is charged to current period earnings as non-interest expense.

Other intangible assets

The Company’s intangible assets consist of core deposit intangible assets, investment advisory and credit card intangibles, and are amortized over periods ranging from 6 to 12 years. The Company evaluates the remaining useful lives of its core deposit intangible assets each reporting period, as required by FASB ASC 350, Intangibles—Goodwill and Other, to determine whether events and circumstances warrant a revision to the remaining period of amortization. If the estimate of an intangible asset’s remaining useful life has changed, the remaining carrying amount of the intangible asset is amortized prospectively over that revised remaining useful life. The Company has not revised its estimates of the useful lives of its core deposit intangibles during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 or 2009.

 

85


Table of Contents

Income taxes

Western Alliance Bancorporation and its subsidiaries, other than BW Real Estate, Inc., file a consolidated federal tax return. Due to tax regulations, several items of income and expense are recognized in different periods for tax return purposes than for financial reporting purposes. These items represent “temporary differences.” Deferred taxes are provided on an asset and liability method whereby deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary differences and tax credit carry-forwards and deferred tax liabilities are recognized for taxable temporary differences. Temporary differences are the differences between the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and their tax bases. Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in the opinion of Management, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted for the effect of changes in tax laws and rates on the date of enactment.

Although realization is not assured, the Company believes that the realization of the recognized net deferred tax asset of $61.7 million at December 31, 2011 is more likely than not based on expectations as to future taxable income and based on available tax planning strategies as defined in FASB ASC 740, Income Taxes (‘ASC 740”) that could be implemented if necessary to prevent a carryforward from expiring.

The most significant source of these timing differences are the credit loss reserve and net operating loss carryforwards, which account for substantially all of the net deferred tax asset.

As a result of the losses incurred in 2009 and 2010, the Company is in a three-year cumulative pretax loss position at December 31, 2011. A cumulative loss position is considered significant negative evidence in assessing the realizability of a deferred tax asset. The Company has concluded that there is sufficient positive evidence to overcome this negative evidence. This positive evidence includes Company forecasts, exclusive of tax planning strategies, that show full utilization of the net operating losses by the end of 2013 based on current projections. In addition, the Company has evaluated tax planning strategies, including potential sales of businesses and assets in which it could realize the excess of appreciated value over the tax basis of its assets. The amount of deferred tax assets considered realizable, however, could be significantly reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are significantly lower than forecasted due to deterioration in market conditions.

Based on the above discussion, it is more likely than not that the Company will fully utilize deferred federal and state tax assets pertaining to the existing net operating loss carryforwards and any NOL that would be created by the reversal of the future net deductions that have not yet been taken on a tax return.

Bank owned life insurance

Bank owned life insurance is stated at its cash surrender value with changes recorded in other non-interest income in the consolidated statements of operations. The face amount of the underlying policies including death benefits was $324.7 million and $324.0 million as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. There are no loans offset against cash surrender values, and there are no restrictions as to the use of proceeds.

Customer repurchase agreements

The Company occasionally enters into repurchase agreements with customers whereby it pledges securities against overnight investments made from the customer’s excess collected funds. The Company records these at the amount of cash received in connection with the transaction.

Stock compensation plans

The Company has the 2005 Stock Incentive Plan (the “Incentive Plan”), as amended, which is described more fully in Note 13, “Stockholder’s Equity.” Compensation expense for stock options and non-vested restricted stock awards is based on the fair value of the award on the measurement date, which, for the Company, is the date of the grant and is recognized ratably over the service period of the award. Prior to the Company’s initial public offering (“IPO”), the Company used the minimum value method to calculate the fair value of stock options. Subsequent to the Company’s IPO, the Company utilizes the Black-Scholes option-pricing model to calculate the fair value of stock options. The fair value of non-vested restricted stock awards is the market price of the Company’s stock on the date of grant.

During the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, the Company granted stock options to the directors of its subsidiaries. Directors of subsidiaries do not meet the definition of an employee under FASB ASC 718, Compensation. Accordingly, the Company applies FASB ASC 505, Equity to determine the measurement date for options granted to these directors. Therefore, the expense related to these options is re-measured each reporting date until the options are vested.

 

86


Table of Contents

The following table illustrates the effect on net income and earnings per share had compensation cost for all of the stock-based compensation plans been determined based on the grant date fair values of awards:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010     2009  
     (in thousands, except per share amounts)  

Net income (loss):

       

Net income (loss) available to common stockholders

   $ 15,288       $ (17,077   $ (161,148

Deduct stock-based employee compensation expense determined under the minimum value method for all awards issued prior to the IPO

     —           (34     (423

Related tax benefit for nonqualified stock options

     —           4        51   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pro forma

   $ 15,288       $ (17,107   $ (161,520
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Earnings (loss) per share:

       

Basic—as reported

   $ 0.19       $ (0.23   $ (2.74

Basic—pro forma

     0.19         (0.23     (2.75

Diluted—as reported

     0.19         (0.23     (2.74

Diluted—pro forma

     0.19         (0.23     (2.75

See Note 13, “Stockholder’s Equity” for further discussion of stock options, stock warrants and restricted stock awards.

Preferred stock

On November 21, 2008, as part of the Capital Purchase Program established by the U.S. Department of the Treasury (“Treasury”) under the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 (“EESA”), the Company entered into a Letter Agreement with Treasury pursuant to which the Company issued and sold to Treasury (i) 140,000 shares of the Company’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, par value $0.0001 per share, having a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share (the “Series A Preferred Stock”) and (ii) a ten-year warrant to purchase up to 1,574,213 shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.0001 per share, at an initial exercise price of $13.34 per share, for an aggregate purchase price of $140.0 million. The proceeds received were allocated to the preferred stock and additional paid-in-capital based on their relative fair values. The resulting discount on the preferred stock was amortized against retained earnings and was reflected in the Company’s consolidated statement of income as “Accretion on preferred stock discount,” resulting in additional dilution to the Company’s earnings per share. The warrant was included in the Company’s diluted average common shares outstanding (subject to anti-dilution). Both the preferred stock and warrant were accounted for as additions to the Company’s regulatory Tier 1 and Total capital.

The Company was permitted to redeem the Series A Preferred Stock prior to February 15, 2012 if (i) the Company raised aggregate gross proceeds in one or more Qualified Equity Offerings (as defined below) in excess of $35 million and (ii) the aggregate redemption price did not exceed the aggregate net cash proceeds from such Qualified Equity Offerings. Any redemption is subject to the consent of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System. A Qualified Equity Offering is the sale and issuance for cash by the Company, to persons other than the Company or any Company subsidiary after the closing, of shares of perpetual preferred stock, common stock or any combination of such stock, that, in each case, qualify as and may be included in Tier 1 capital of the Company at the time of issuance under the applicable risk-based capital guidelines of the Board of Governors of the FRB. The Company successfully completed a Qualified Equity Offering in May 2009. As a result, the number of the shares of common stock underlying the portion of the warrant then held by Treasury was reduced by one-half of the shares of common stock to 787,107.

The Company fully redeemed the $140 million, or 140,000 shares plus accrued and unpaid dividends, of Series A Preferred Stock. As a result of the redemption, the Company recorded a one-time $6.9 million charge to retained earnings in the form of accelerated deemed dividend to account for the difference between the amount at which the preferred stock sale had been initially recorded and its redemption price. Following this redemption, the remaining warrant to purchase 787,107 shares of the Company’s common stock were repurchased from Treasury at auction on November 18, 2011 for $0.4 million, and subsequently retired.

On September 27, 2011, the Company received $141.0 million from the issuance of 141,000 shares of non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, Series B, par value of $.0001 per share and a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share, to the U.S. Treasury Department pursuant to participation in the U.S. Department of Treasury’s Small Business Lending Fund Program (SBLF). Initially established at 5%, the dividend rate can vary from as low as 1% to 9% in part depending upon the Company’s success in qualifying small business lending.

 

87


Table of Contents

No other shares of preferred stock are issued and outstanding. The Board of Directors has the authority, without further action by the stockholders, to issue preferred stock in one or more series and to fix the number of shares, designations, preferences, powers, and relative, participating, optional or other special rights. The issuance of additional preferred stock could decrease the amount of earnings and assets available for distribution to holders of common stock or adversely affect the rights and powers, including voting rights, of the holders of common stock, and may have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of the Company.

Investment Advisory and Trust Services

The Company had a trust subsidiary, Premier Trust, until September 1, 2010. In addition, the Company held interests in two registered investment advisors that have fiduciary responsibility for the assets they manage on behalf of customers. The Company divested 75% of its interest in Miller/Russell & Associates on December 31, 2009. In August 2010, the Company sold an additional 0.1%-interest in MRA to certain members of the MRA management team.

These assets are not owned by the Company and are not reflected in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets. Trust income was recorded on a cash basis and investment advisory service income was recorded on an accrual basis. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, Shine had $337.6 million and $357.4 million, respectively, in assets under management.

Fair values of financial instruments

The Company uses fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain assets and liabilities. FASB ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures (“ASC 820”) establishes a framework for measuring fair value, establishes a three-level valuation hierarchy for disclosure of fair value measurement and enhances disclosure requirements for fair value measurements. The valuation hierarchy is based upon the transparency of inputs to the valuation of an asset or liability as of the measurement date. The Company uses various valuation approaches, including market, income and/or cost approaches. ASC 820 establishes a hierarchy for inputs used in measuring fair value that maximizes the use of observable inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs by requiring that observable inputs be used when available. Observable inputs are inputs that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on market data obtained from sources independent of the Company. Unobservable inputs are inputs that reflect the Company’s assumptions about the factors market participants would consider in pricing the asset or liability developed based on the best information available in the circumstances. The hierarchy is broken down into three levels based on the reliability of inputs, as follows:

 

   

Level 1—Observable quoted prices in active markets that are accessible at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities.

 

   

Level 2—Observable quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active, matrix pricing or model-based valuation techniques where all significant assumptions are observable, either directly or indirectly in the market.

 

   

Level 3—Model-based techniques where all significant assumptions are not observable, either directly or indirectly, in the market. These unobservable assumptions reflect our own estimates of assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques may include use of discounted cash flow models and similar techniques.

The availability of observable inputs varies based on the nature of the specific financial instrument. To the extent that valuation is based on models or inputs that are less observable or unobservable in the market, the determination of fair value requires more judgment. Accordingly, the degree of judgment exercised by the Company in determining fair value is greatest for instruments categorized in Level 3. In certain cases, the inputs used to measure fair value may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In such cases, for disclosure purposes, the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement in its entirety falls is determined based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety.

Fair value is a market-based measure considered from the perspective of a market participant who holds the asset or owes the liability rather than an entity-specific measure. When market assumptions are available, ASC 820 requires the Company to make assumptions regarding the assumptions that market participants would use to estimate the fair value of the financial instrument at the measurement date.

FASB ASC 825, Financial Instruments (“ASC 825”) requires disclosure of fair value information about financial instruments, whether or not recognized in the balance sheet, for which it is practicable to estimate that value.

Management uses its best judgment in estimating the fair value of the Company’s financial instruments; however, there are inherent limitations in any estimation technique. Therefore, for substantially all financial instruments, the fair value estimates presented herein are not necessarily indicative of the amounts the Company could have realized in a sales transaction at December 31, 2011 or 2010. The estimated fair value amounts for 2011 and 2010 have been measured as of period-end, and have not been reevaluated or updated for purposes of these consolidated financial statements subsequent to those dates. As such, the estimated fair values of these financial instruments subsequent to the reporting date may be different than the amounts reported at the period-end.

 

88


Table of Contents

The information in Note 17, “Fair Value of Financial Instruments,” should not be interpreted as an estimate of the fair value of the entire Company since a fair value calculation is only required for a limited portion of the Company’s assets and liabilities.

Due to the wide range of valuation techniques and the degree of subjectivity used in making the estimate, comparisons between the Company’s disclosures and those of other companies or banks may not be meaningful.

The following methods and assumptions were used by the Company in estimating the fair value of its financial instruments:

Cash and cash equivalents

The carrying amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheets for cash and due from banks and federal funds sold approximates their fair value.

Securities

The fair values of U.S. Treasuries, corporate bonds, mutual funds, and exchange-listed preferred stock are based on quoted market prices and are categorized as Level 1 of the fair value hierarchy.

The fair value of other investment securities were determined based on matrix pricing. Matrix pricing is a mathematical technique that utilizes observable market inputs including, for example, yield curves, credit ratings and prepayment speeds. Fair values determined using matrix pricing are generally categorized as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy.

The Company owns certain collateralized debt obligations (“CDOs”) for which quoted prices are not available. Quoted prices for similar assets are also not available for these investment securities. In order to determine the fair value of these securities, the Company has estimated the future cash flows and discount rate using observable market inputs adjusted based on assumptions regarding the adjustments a market participant would assume necessary for each specific security. As a result, the resulting fair values have been categorized as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy

Restricted stock

The Company’s subsidiary banks are members of the Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) system and maintain an investment in capital stock of the FHLB. The Company’s subsidiary banks also maintain an investment in their primary correspondent bank. These investments are carried at cost since no ready market exists for them, and they have no quoted market value. The Company conducts a periodic review and evaluation of our FHLB stock to determine if any impairment exists.

Loans

Fair value for loans is estimated based on discounted cash flows using interest rates currently being offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers with similar credit quality with adjustments that the Company believes a market participant would consider in determining fair value based on a third party independent valuation. As a result, the fair value for loans disclosed in Note 17, “Fair Value of Financial Instruments,” is categorized as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

Accrued interest receivable and payable

The carrying amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheets for accrued interest receivable and payable approximate their fair value. Accrued interest receivable and payable fair value measurements disclosed in Note 17 “Fair Value of Financial Instruments,” are classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

Derivative financial instruments

All derivatives are recognized on the balance sheet at their fair value. The fair value for derivatives is determined based on market prices, broker-dealer quotations on similar product or other related input parameters. As a result, the fair values have been categorized as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy.

Deposit liabilities

The fair value disclosed for demand and savings deposits is by definition equal to the amount payable on demand at their reporting date (that is, their carrying amount) which the Company believes a market participant would consider in determining fair value. The carrying amount for variable-rate deposit accounts approximates their fair value. Fair values for fixed-rate certificates of deposit are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered on certificates to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on these deposits. The fair value measurement of the deposit liabilities disclosed in Note 17, “Fair Value of Instruments,” is categorized as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

 

89


Table of Contents

Federal Home Loan Bank and Federal Reserve advances and other borrowings

The fair values of the Company’s borrowings are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, based on the market rates for similar types of borrowing arrangements. The FHLB and FRB advances and other borrowings have been categorized as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

Junior subordinated and subordinated debt

Junior subordinated debt and subordinated debt are valued by comparing interest rates and spreads to benchmark indices offered to institutions with similar credit profiles to our own and discounting the contractual cash flows on our debt using these market rates. The junior subordinated debt and subordinated debt have been categorized as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

Off-balance sheet instruments

Fair values for the Company’s off-balance sheet instruments (lending commitments and standby letters of credit) are based on quoted fees currently charged to enter into similar agreements, taking into account the remaining terms of the agreements and the counterparties’ credit standing.

Earnings per share

Diluted earnings per share is based on the weighted average outstanding common shares during each year, including common stock equivalents. Basic earnings per share is based on the weighted average outstanding common shares during the year.

Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per share, based on the weighted average outstanding shares, are summarized as follows:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011      2010     2009  
     (in thousands, except per share amounts)  

Basic:

       

Net income (loss) available to common stockholders

   $ 15,288       $ (17,077   $ (161,148

Average common shares outstanding

     80,909         75,083        58,836   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Earnings (loss) per share

   $ 0.19       $ (0.23   $ (2.74
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted:

       

Net income (loss) available to common stockholders

   $ 15,288       $ (17,077   $ (161,148

Average common shares outstanding

     81,183         75,083        58,836   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Earnings (loss) per share

   $ 0.19       $ (0.23   $ (2.74
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, all stock warrants, stock options and restricted stock were considered anti-dilutive and excluded for purposes of calculating diluted loss per share.

Recent accounting pronouncements

In December 2010, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued guidance within the Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2010-20 “Disclosures about the Credit Quality of Financing Receivables and the Allowance for Credit Losses.” ASU 2010-20 requires entities to provide disclosures designed to facilitate financial statement users’ evaluation of (i) the nature of credit risk inherent in the entity’s portfolio of financing receivables, (ii) how that risk is analyzed and assessed in arriving at the allowance for credit losses, and (iii) the changes and reasons for those changes in the allowance for credit losses. Disclosures must be disaggregated by portfolio segment, the level at which an entity develops and documents a systematic method for determining its allowance for credit losses, and class of financing receivable, which is generally a disaggregation of portfolio segment. The required disclosures include, among other things, a roll forward of the allowance for credit losses as well as information about modified, impaired, nonaccrual and past due loans and credit quality indicators. ASU 2010-20 became effective for the Company’s financial statements as of December 31, 2010, as it relates to disclosures required as of the end of a reporting period. Disclosures that relate to activity during a reporting period are required for the Company’s financial statements that include periods beginning on or after January 1, 2011. The adoption of this guidance did not have any impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In April 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-02 “A Creditor’s Determination of Whether a Restructuring is a Troubled Debt Restructuring.” ASU 2011-02 clarifies when a loan modification or restructuring is considered a troubled debt restructuring. This guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after June 15, 2011, and will be applied retrospectively to the beginning of the annual period of adoption. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

 

90


Table of Contents

In April 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-03 “Reconsideration of Effective Control for Repurchase Agreements.” The amendments in ASU 2011-03 remove from the assessment of effective control (1) the criterion requiring the transferor to have the ability to repurchase or redeem the financial assets on substantially the agreed terms, even in the event of default by the transferee, and (2) the collateral maintenance implementation guidance related to that criterion. This guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after December 15, 2011, and will be applied prospectively to transactions or modifications of existing transactions that occur on or after the effective date. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In May 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-04 “Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs.” The amendments in ASU 2011-04 generally represent clarifications of Topic 820, Fair Value Measurement but also include some instances where a particular principle or requirement for measuring fair value or disclosing information about fair value measurements has changed. This update results in common principles and requirements for measuring fair value and for disclosing information about fair value measurements in accordance with U.S. GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”). This guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after December 15, 2011, and will be applied prospectively. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of the adoption of this guidance but does not anticipate a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In June 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-05 “Presentation of Comprehensive Income.” The amendments in ASU 2011-05 to Topic 220, Comprehensive Income, allow an entity the option to present the total comprehensive income, the components of net income, and the components of other comprehensive income either in a single continuous statement of comprehensive income or in two separate but consecutive statements. In both choices, an entity is required to present each component of net income along with total net income, each component of other comprehensive income along with a total for other comprehensive income, and a total amount for comprehensive income. This update eliminates the option to present the components of other comprehensive income as part of the statement of changes in stockholders’ equity. The amendments do not change the items that must be reported in other comprehensive income or when an item of other comprehensive income must be reclassified to net income. This guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after December 15, 2011, and will be applied retrospectively. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows and will only impact the presentation of other comprehensive income in the consolidated financial statements.

In September 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-08 “Testing Goodwill for Impairment.” The amendments in this update to Topic 350, Intangibles-Goodwill and Other, will allow an entity to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is necessary to perform the two-step quantitative goodwill impairment test. An entity would not be required to calculate the fair value of a reporting unit unless the entity determines, based on a qualitative assessment, that it is more likely than not that its fair value is less than its carrying amount. The amendments include a number of events and circumstances for an entity to consider in conducting the qualitative assessment. This guidance is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. Companies may elect to early adopt. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In December 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-10 “De-recognition of in Substance Real Estate – a Scope Clarification.” The amendments to Topic 360, Property, Plant, and Equipment, resolve the diversity in practice when a parent ceases to have a controlling financial interest in a subsidiary that is in substance real estate as a result of default on the subsidiary’s nonrecourse debt. This guidance is effective for annual and interim periods beginning after June 15, 2012. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

In December 2011, the FASB issued guidance within the ASU 2011-11 “Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities.” The update to Topic 210, Balance Sheet, requires enhanced disclosures to enable users of the financial statements to evaluate the effect or potential effect of netting arrangements on an entity’s financial position. This guidance is effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after January 1, 2013. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of operations, its consolidated balance sheet, or its consolidated statement of cash flows.

 

91


Table of Contents

2. MERGERS, AQUISITIONS AND DISPOSITIONS

Bank Subsidiary Mergers

As of December 31, 2010, the Company merged its Alta Alliance Bank subsidiary into its Torrey Pines Bank subsidiary, and its First Independent Bank of Nevada subsidiary into its Alliance Bank of Arizona subsidiary. As part of the latter merger, Alliance Bank of Arizona was renamed Western Alliance Bank doing business as Alliance Bank of Arizona (in Arizona) and First Independent Bank (in Nevada). As the bank mergers did not meet the definition of a business combination under the guidance of ASC 805, Business Combinations, the entities were combined in a method similar to a pooling of interests. There were $1.6 million and $1.7 million of merger related expenses in the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

Premier Trust Disposition

The Company divested its wholly owned subsidiary Premier Trust, Inc as of September 1, 2010 and recorded a $0.6 million gain on sale.

PartnersFirst Discontinued Operations

In the first quarter of 2010, the Company decided to discontinue its affinity credit card platform, PartnersFirst, and has presented certain activities as discontinued operations. The Company transferred certain assets with balances at December 31, 2010 of $0.1 million to held-for-sale and reported a portion of its operations as discontinued. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had $38.9 million and $45.6 million, respectively, of outstanding credit card loans which will have continuing cash flows related to the collection of these loans. These credit card loans are included in loans held for investment as of December 31, 2011 and 2010

The following table summarizes the operating results of the discontinued operations for the periods indicated:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands)  

Affinity card revenue

   $ 1,482      $ 1,808      $ 1,823   

Non-interest expenses

     (4,923     (7,023     (9,483
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (3,441     (5,215     (7,660

Income tax benefit

     (1,445     (2,190     (3,153
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

   $ (1,996   $ (3,025   $ (4,507
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Miller/Russell Disposition

Effective December 31, 2009, the Company sold a 75% interest in Miller/Russell & Associates, Inc (“MRA”) to certain members of the Miller/Russell management team for $2.7 million. In August 2010, the Company sold an additional 0.1%-interest in MRA to certain members of the MRA management team. The Company retains a 24.9% non-controlling interest in the post merger Miller/Russell Acquisition LLC. Western Alliance Bank, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company provided the buyers with a $2.1 million secured term loan for the purchase. For the year ended December 31, 2009, MRA contributed a small loss to the consolidated operations of the Company and was deconsolidated from the consolidated balance sheet. The Company retained the 24.9% non-controlling interest at cost, which approximated fair value at the close of the transaction and records its prorata share of income.

 

92


Table of Contents

3. INVESTMENT SECURITIES

Carrying amounts and fair values of investment securities at December 31, 2011 and 2010 are summarized as follows:

 

     December 31, 2011  
     (in thousands)  
            Gross      Gross        
     Amortized      Unrealized      Unrealized     Fair  
Securities held-to-maturity    Cost      Gains      (Losses)     Value  
     (in thousands)  

Collateralized debt obligations

   $ 50       $ 972       $ —        $ 1,022   

Corporate bonds

     102,785         171         (2,029     100,927   

Municipal obligations (1)

     181,923         4,695         (32     186,586   

CRA investments

     1,500         —           —          1,500   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 286,258       $ 5,838       $ (2,061   $ 290,035   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

            OTTI                     
            Recognized                     
            in Other     Gross      Gross        
     Amortized      Comprehensive     Unrealized      Unrealized     Fair  
Securities available-for-sale    Cost      Loss     Gains      (Losses)     Value  
     (in thousands)  

U.S. Government-sponsored agency securities

   $ 155,898       $ —        $ 368       $ (55   $ 156,211   

Municipal obligations (1)

     5,555         —          47         (16     5,586   

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     59,661         —          1,157         (6,142     54,676   

Mutual funds (2)

     28,978         —          65         (179     28,864   

Corporate securities

     5,000         —          —           (425     4,575   

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities (3)

     855,828         —          9,095         (339     864,584   

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     26,953         (1,811     1,815         (1,173     25,784   

Private label commercial mortgage-backed securities

     5,461         —          —           (30     5,431   

Trust preferred securities

     32,016         —          —           (10,857     21,159   

CRA investments

     22,835         —          680         —          23,515   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 1,198,185       $ (1,811   $ 13,227       $ (19,216   $ 1,190,385   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securities measured at fair value

            

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities (3)

  

       $ 6,515   
            

 

 

 

 

(1) These consist of revenue obligations.
(2) These are investment grade corporate bonds.
(3) These are primarily agency collateralized mortgage obligations.

For additional information on the fair value changes of the securities measured at fair value, see the trading securities table in Note 16 “Fair Value Accounting”.

 

93


Table of Contents

 

     December 31, 2010  
            Gross      Gross        
     Amortized      Unrealized      Unrealized     Fair  
Securities held-to-maturity    Cost      Gains      (Losses)     Value  
     (in thousands)  

Collateralized debt obligations

   $ 276       $ 459       $ —        $ 735   

Corporate bonds

     45,000         —           (632     44,368   

Municipal obligations

     1,375         18         —          1,393   

Other

     1,500         —           —          1,500   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 48,151       $ 477       $ (632   $ 47,996   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

            OTTI                     
            Recognized                     
            in Other     Gross      Gross        
     Amortized      Comprehensive     Unrealized      Unrealized     Fair  
Securities available-for-sale    Cost      Loss     Gains      (Losses)     Value  
     (in thousands)  

U.S. Government-sponsored agency securities

   $ 280,299       $ —        $ 622       $ (3,329   $ 277,592   

Municipal obligations

     312         —          1         (11     302   

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     66,255         —          1,410         (422     67,243   

Corporate securities

     5,000         —          —           (93     4,907   

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     772,217         —          5,804         (8,632     769,389   

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     9,203         (1,811     1,811         (1,092     8,111   

Trust preferred securities

     32,057         —          —           (8,931     23,126   

Other

     22,265         —          99         (121     22,243   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 1,187,608       $ (1,811   $ 9,747       $ (22,631   $ 1,172,913   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securities measured at fair value

            

U.S. Government-sponsored agency securities

             $ 2,511   

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

  

            11,790   
            

 

 

 
             $ 14,301   
            

 

 

 

The Company conducts an other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) analysis on a quarterly basis. The initial indication of OTTI for both debt and equity securities is a decline in the market value below the amount recorded for an investment, and the severity and duration of the decline. Another potential indication of OTTI is a downgrade below investment grade. In determining whether an impairment is OTTI, the Company considers the length of time and the extent to which the market value has been below cost, recent events specific to the issuer, including investment downgrades by rating agencies and economic conditions of its industry, and the Company’s ability and intent to hold the investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery. For marketable equity securities, the Company also considers the issuer’s financial condition, capital strength, and near-term prospects.

For debt securities and for adjustable-rate preferred stock (“ARPS”) that are treated as debt securities for the purpose of OTTI analysis, the Company also considers the cause of the price decline (general level of interest rates and industry- and issuer-specific factors), the issuer’s financial condition, near-term prospects and current ability to make future payments in a timely manner, the issuer’s ability to service debt, and any change in agencies’ ratings at evaluation date from acquisition date and any likely imminent action. For ARPS with a fair value below cost that is not attributable to the credit deterioration of the issuer, such as a decline in cash flows from the security or a downgrade in the security’s rating below investment grade, the Company may avoid recognizing an OTTI charge by asserting that it has the intent and ability to retain its investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value.

Gross unrealized losses at December 31, 2011 are primarily caused by interest rate fluctuations, credit spread widening and reduced liquidity in applicable markets. The Company has reviewed securities on which there is an unrealized loss in accordance with its accounting policy for OTTI described above and recorded impairment charges totaling $0.2 million, $1.2 million, and $43.8 million for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. For 2011 and 2010, the impairment charges related to unrealized losses in the Company’s collateralized debt obligations (“CDO”) portfolio. For 2009, this includes $36.4 million related to impairment losses in the Company’s ARPS, $3.4 million related to impairment losses to the Company’s CDO portfolio and $4.0 million related to the Company’s collateralized mortgage obligation (“CMO”) portfolio.

 

94


Table of Contents

The Company does not consider any other securities to be other-than-temporarily impaired as of December 31, 2011 and 2010. OTTI is reassessed quarterly. No assurance can be made that additional OTTI will not occur in future periods.

Information pertaining to securities with gross unrealized losses at December 31, 2011 and 2010, aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous loss position follows:

 

     December 31, 2011  
     Less Than Twelve Months      Over Twelve Months  
     Gross             Gross         
     Unrealized      Fair      Unrealized      Fair  
     Losses      Value      Losses      Value  
     (in thousands)  

Securities held-to-maturity

           

Corporate bonds

   $ 2,029       $ 77,931       $ —         $ —     

Municipal obligations

     32         7,774         —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 2,061       $ 85,705       $ —         $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     December 31, 2011  
     Less Than Twelve Months      Over Twelve Months  
     Gross             Gross         
     Unrealized      Fair      Unrealized      Fair  
     Losses      Value      Losses      Value  
     (in thousands)  

Securities available-for-sale

           

U.S. Government-sponsored agency securities

   $ 55       $ 9,944       $ —         $ —     

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     6,142         26,335         —           —     

Mutual funds

     179         15,879         —           —     

Corporate securities

     425         4,575         —           —     

Direct U.S obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     222         54,668         117         15,239   

Municipal obligations

     16         2,640         —           —     

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     465         20,045         708         5,034   

Private label commercial mortgage-backed securities

     30         5,431         —           —     

Trust preferred securities

     —           —           10,857         21,159   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 7,534       $ 139,517       $ 11,682       $ 41,432   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     December 31, 2010  
     Less Than Twelve Months      Over Twelve Months  
     Gross             Gross         
     Unrealized      Fair      Unrealized      Fair  
     Losses      Value      Losses      Value  
     (in thousands)  

Securities held-to-maturity

           

Corporate bonds

   $ 632       $ 39,368       $ —         $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 632       $ 39,368       $ —         $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

95


Table of Contents
     December 31, 2010  
     Less Than Twelve Months      Over Twelve Months  
     Gross             Gross         
     Unrealized      Fair      Unrealized      Fair  
     Losses      Value      Losses      Value  
     (in thousands)  

Securities available-for-sale

           

U.S. Government-sponsored agency securities

   $ 3,329       $ 173,561       $ —         $ —     

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     422         21,549         —           —     

Corporate securities

     93         4,907         —           —     

Direct U.S obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     8,562         425,248         69         8,798   

Municipal obligations

     11         206         —           —     

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     2         1,990         1,091         6,121   

Trust preferred securities

     —           —           8,931         23,126   

Other

     121         6,129         —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 12,540       $ 633,590       $ 10,091       $ 38,045   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company’s unrealized losses relate primarily to interest rates. The total number of securities in an unrealized loss position at December 31, 2011 was 106 compared to 132 at December 31, 2010. In analyzing an issuer’s financial condition, management considers whether the securities are issued by the federal government or its agencies, whether downgrades by bond rating agencies have occurred, and industry analysis reports. Since material downgrades have not occurred and management does not intend to sell the debt securities for the foreseeable future, none of the securities described in the above table or in this paragraph were deemed to be other than temporarily impaired.

At December 31, 2011, the net unrealized loss on trust preferred securities classified as AFS was $10.9 million, compared with $8.9 million at December 31, 2010. The Company actively monitors its debt and other structured securities portfolios classified as AFS for declines in fair value.

The amortized cost and fair value of securities as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, by contractual maturities, are shown below. The actual maturities of the mortgage-backed securities may differ from their contractual maturities because the loans underlying the securities may be repaid without any penalties due to borrowers that have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. Therefore, these securities are listed separately in the maturity summary.

 

     December 31, 2011      December 31, 2010  
     Amortized      Estimated      Amortized      Estimated  
     Cost      Fair Value      Cost      Fair Value  
     (in thousands)  

Securities held to maturity

           

Due in one year or less

   $ 1,500       $ 1,500       $ 1,500       $ 1,500   

After one year through five years

     8,389         8,093         999         1,011   

After five years through ten years

     114,748         114,098         40,376         39,843   

After ten years

     161,621         166,344         5,276         5,642   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 286,258       $ 290,035       $ 48,151       $ 47,996   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities available for sale

           

Due in one year or less

   $ 52,815       $ 53,399       $ 35,270       $ 35,875   

After one year through five years

     20,445         20,635         8,434         8,663   

After five years through ten years

     134,935         135,420         294,027         291,243   

After ten years

     134,162         116,347         77,660         67,743   

Mortgage backed securities

     855,828         864,584         772,217         769,389   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,198,185       $ 1,190,385       $ 1,187,608       $ 1,172,913   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

96


Table of Contents

The following tables summarize the Company’s investment ratings position as December 31, 2011 and 2010.

 

     As of December 31, 2011  
     AAA      Split-rated
AAA/AA+
     AA+ to AA-      A+ to A-      BBB+ to BBB-      BB+ and below      Totals  
     (in thousands)  

Municipal obligations

   $ 8,273       $ —         $ 109,159       $ 60,949       $ 8,855       $ 273       $ 187,509   

Direct U.S. obligations & GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     —           871,099         —           —           —           —           871,099   

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     13,349         —           4,104         6,438         —           1,893         25,784   

Private label commercial mortgage-backed securities

     5,431         —           —           —           —           —           5,431   

Mutual funds (3)

     —           —           —           —           28,864         —           28,864   

U.S. Government-sponsored agency securities

     —           156,211         —           —           —           —           156,211   

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     —           —           —           —           46,530         7,126         53,656   

Trust preferred securities

     —           —           —           —           21,159         —           21,159   

Collateralized debt obligations

     —           —           —           —           —           50         50   

Corporate bonds

     2,695         —           15,130         64,535         15,000         —           97,360   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total (1) (2)

   $ 29,748       $ 1,027,310       $ 128,393       $ 131,922       $ 120,408       $ 9,342       $ 1,447,123   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) The Company used the average credit rating of the combination of S&P, Moody’s and Fitch in the above table where ratings differed.
(2) Securities values are shown at carrying value as of December 31, 2011. Unrated securities consist of CRA investments with a carrying value of $23.5 million, an HTM Corporate security with a carrying value of $10.0 million, one ARPS with a carrying value of $1.0 million and an other investment of $1.5 million.
(3) At lease 80% of mutual funds are investment grade corporate bonds.

 

     As of December 31, 2010  
     AAA      AA+ to AA-      A+ to A-      BBB+ to BBB-      BB+ and below      Totals  
     (in thousands)  

Municipal obligations

   $ 40       $ 1,375       $ —         $ —         $ 262       $ 1,677   

Direct U.S. obligations & GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     781,179         —           —           —           —           781,179   

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     5,796         —           —           —           2,315         8,111   

U.S. Government-sponsored agency securities

     280,103         —           —           —           —           280,103   

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     —           —           60,263         6,980         —           67,243   

CDOs & trust preferred securities

     —           —           21,681         1,445         276         23,402   

Corporate bonds

     —           5,000         44,907         —           —           49,907   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total (1) (2)

   $ 1,067,118       $ 6,375       $ 126,851       $ 8,425       $ 2,853       $ 1,211,622   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) The Company used the average credit rating of the combination of S&P, Moody’s and Fitch in the above table where ratings differed.
(2) Securities values are shown at carrying value as of December 31, 2010. Unrated securities consist of CRA investments with a carrying value of $22.2 million and an other investment of $1.5 million.

Securities with carrying amounts of approximately $675.0 million and $427.2 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, were pledged for various purposes as required or permitted by law.

As of December 31, 2011, the Company recorded gross gains and losses on sales of investment securities of $5.5 million and $0.5 million respectively, compared to gross gains and losses on sales of securities for the year ended December 31, 2010 of $21.1 million and $4,400, respectively.

 

97


Table of Contents

4. LOANS, LEASES AND ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES

The composition of the Company’s loans held for investment portfolio is as follows:

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate—owner occupied

   $ 1,252,182      $ 1,223,150   

Commercial real estate—non-owner occupied

     1,301,172        1,038,488   

Commercial and industrial

     1,120,107        744,659   

Residential real estate

     443,020        527,302   

Construction and land development

     381,676        451,470   

Commercial leases

     216,475        189,968   

Consumer

     72,504        71,545   

Deferred fees and unearned income,net

     (7,067     (6,040
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     4,780,069        4,240,542   

Allowance for credit losses

     (99,170     (110,699
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,680,899      $ 4,129,843   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table presents the contractual aging of the recorded investment in past due loans by class of loans excluding deferred fees:

 

     December 31, 2011  
     Current      30-59 Days
Past Due
     60-89 Days
Past Due
     Over 90 days
Past Due
     Total
Past Due
     Total  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

                 

Owner occupied

   $ 1,235,707       $ 3,150       $ 2,488       $ 10,837       $ 16,475       $ 1,252,182   

Non-owner occupied

     1,168,616         —           2,365         5,051         7,416         1,176,032   

Multi-family

     124,855         —           —           285         285         125,140   

Commercial and industrial

                 

Commercial

     1,114,881         683         1,146         3,397         5,226         1,120,107   

Leases

     216,475         —           —           —           —           216,475   

Construction and land development

                 

Construction

     210,843         —           —           3,434         3,434         214,277   

Land

     151,618         6,217         375         9,189         15,781         167,399   

Residential real estate

     424,086         2,349         4,030         12,555         18,934         443,020   

Consumer

     70,759         376         602         767         1,745         72,504   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total loans

   $ 4,717,840       $ 12,775       $ 11,006       $ 45,515       $ 69,296       $ 4,787,136   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

98


Table of Contents

 

     December 31, 2010  
     Current      30-59 Days
Past Due
     60-89 Days
Past Due
     Over 90 days
Past Due
     Total Past
Due
     Total  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

                 

Owner occupied

   $ 1,195,219       $ 2,512       $ 10,314       $ 15,105       $ 27,931       $ 1,223,150   

Non-owner occupied

     947,784         1,111         1,022         5,543         7,676         955,460   

Multi-family

     80,857         —           —           2,407         2,407         83,264   

Commercial and industrial

                 

Commercial

     741,337         1,644         135         1,543         3,322         744,659   

Leases

     189,968         —           —           —           —           189,968   

Construction and land development

                 

Construction

     219,382         —           —           22,300         22,300         241,682   

Land

     199,773         338         —           9,678         10,016         209,789   

Residential real estate

     491,275         8,574         3,208         24,008         35,790         527,065   

Consumer

     69,027         655         460         1,403         2,518         71,545   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total loans

   $ 4,134,622       $ 14,834       $ 15,139       $ 81,987       $ 111,960       $ 4,246,582   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table presents the recorded investment in nonaccrual loans and loans past due ninety days or more and still accruing interest by class of loans:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010  
     Non-accrual      Loans past
due 90 days
or more and
still accruing
     Non-accrual      Loans past
due 90 days
or more and

still accruing
 
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

           

Owner occupied

   $ 21,153       $ 439       $ 25,316       $ —     

Non-owner occupied

     16,250         —           12,189         —     

Multi-family

     616         —           2,752         —     

Commercial and industrial

           

Commercial

     6,818         523         7,349         151   

Leases

     592         —           —           —     

Construction and land development

           

Construction

     14,446         —           22,300         —     

Land

     14,367         860         14,223         —     

Residential real estate

     15,747         —           32,638         —     

Consumer

     403         767         232         1,307   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 90,392       $ 2,589       $ 116,999       $ 1,458   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The reduction in interest income associated with loans on nonaccrual status was approximately $6.3 million, $6.0 million and $8.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

The Company utilizes an internal asset classification system as a means of reporting problem and potential problem loans. Under the Company’s risk rating system, the Company classifies problem and potential problem loans as “Watch,” “Substandard,” “Doubtful”, and “Loss,” which correspond to risk ratings six, seven, eight, and nine, respectively. Substandard loans include those characterized by well defined weaknesses and carry the distinct possibility that the Company will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. Loans classified as Doubtful, or risk rated eight, have all the weaknesses inherent in those classified Substandard with the added characteristic that the weaknesses present make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions and values, highly questionable and improbable. The final rating of Loss covers loans considered uncollectible and having such little recoverable value that it is not practical to defer writing off the asset. Loans that do not currently expose the Company to

 

99


Table of Contents

sufficient risk to warrant classification in one of the aforementioned categories, but possess weaknesses that deserve management’s close attention, are deemed to be Watch, or risk rated six. Risk ratings are updated, at a minimum, quarterly. The following tables present loans by risk rating:

 

     December 31, 2011  
     Pass      Watch      Substandard      Doubtful      Loss      Total  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

                 

Owner occupied

   $ 1,139,776       $ 67,220       $ 45,186       $  —         $  —         $ 1,252,182   

Non-owner occupied

     1,103,593         33,470         38,969         —           —           1,176,032   

Multi-family

     123,917         414         809         —           —           125,140   

Commercial and industrial

                 

Commercial

     1,067,602         20,657         31,648         200         —           1,120,107   

Leases

     215,778         105         592         —           —           216,475   

Construction and land development

                 

Construction

     193,248         3,087         17,942         —           —           214,277   

Land

     120,858         8,551         37,990         —           —           167,399   

Residential real estate

     405,398         12,637         24,985         —           —           443,020   

Consumer

     68,546         971         2,987         —           —           72,504   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,438,716       $ 147,112       $ 201,108       $ 200       $ —         $ 4,787,136   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     December 31, 2011  
     Pass      Watch      Substandard      Doubtful      Loss      Total  
     (in thousands)  

Current

   $ 4,429,291       $ 143,908       $ 144,641       $ —         $  —         $ 4,717,840   

Past due 30—59 days

     6,475         661         5,639         —           —           12,775   

Past due 60—89 days

     2,950         2,104         5,952         —           —           11,006   

Past due 90 days or more

     —           439         44,876         200         —           45,515   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,438,716       $ 147,112       $ 201,108       $ 200       $  —         $ 4,787,136   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     December 31, 2010  
     Pass      Watch      Substandard      Doubtful      Loss      Total  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

                 

Owner occupied

   $ 1,075,051       $ 89,731       $ 58,368       $ —         $  —         $ 1,223,150   

Non-owner occupied

     883,867         27,785         43,807         —           —           955,460   

Multi-family

     78,442         —           4,823         —           —           83,264   

Commercial and industrial

                 

Commercial

     699,177         27,252         17,426         804         —           744,659   

Leases

     186,262         51         3,655         —           —           189,968   

Construction and land development

                 

Construction

     200,375         12,086         29,220         —           —           241,682   

Land

     141,916         19,070         48,803         —           —           209,789   

Residential real estate

     460,591         17,647         48,828         —           —           527,065   

Consumer

     69,339         1,284         921         —           —           71,545   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,795,020       $ 194,905       $ 255,853       $ 804       $ —         $ 4,246,582   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

100


Table of Contents

 

     December 31, 2010  
     Pass      Watch      Substandard      Doubtful      Loss      Total  
     (in thousands)  

Current

   $ 3,785,145       $ 188,555       $ 160,318       $ 607       $  —         $ 4,134,622   

Past due 30—59 days

     6,000         1,875         6,959         —           —           14,834   

Past due 60—89 days

     2,459         4,474         8,158         49         —           15,139   

Past due 90 days or more

     1,418         1         80,418         148         —           81,987   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,795,022       $ 194,905       $ 255,853       $ 804       $ —         $ 4,246,582   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The table below reflects recorded investment in loans classified as impaired:

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     (in thousands)  

Impaired loans with a specific valuation allowance under ASC 310

   $ 28,631      $ 45,316   

Impaired loans without a specific valuation allowance under ASC 310

     180,860        193,019   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans

   $ 209,491      $ 238,335   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Valuation allowance related to impaired loans

   $ (10,377   $ (13,440
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net impaired loans were $209.5 million at December 31, 2011, a net decrease of $28.8 million from December 31, 2010. This decrease is primarily attributable to a decrease in commercial real estate and residential real estate impaired loans, which were $123.9 million and $42.4 million, respectively, at December 31, 2010 compared to $90.7 million and $28.8 million, respectively, at December 31, 2011, a decrease of $33.2 million and $13.6 million, respectively. Impaired construction and land, commercial and industrial and consumer loans increased from $58.4 million, $12.8 million and $0.7 million, respectively, at December 31, 2010, to $61.9 million, $25.7 million and $2.3 million, respectively, at December 31, 2011.

The following table presents the impaired loans by class:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

     

Owner occupied

   $ 46,780       $ 51,157   

Non-owner occupied

     43,123         67,959   

Multi-family

     809         4,823   

Commercial and industrial

     

Commercial

     25,138         9,148   

Leases

     592         3,655   

Construction and land development

     

Construction

     20,827         31,707   

Land

     41,084         26,708   

Residential real estate

     28,850         42,423   

Consumer

     2,288         755   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 209,491       $ 238,335   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

A valuation allowance is established for an impaired loan when the fair value of the loan is less than the recorded investment. In certain cases, portions of impaired loans are charged-off to realizable value instead of establishing a valuation allowance and are included, when applicable in the table above as “Impaired loans without specific valuation allowance under ASC 310.” The valuation allowance disclosed above is included in the allowance for credit losses reported in the consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.

 

101


Table of Contents

The following table presents average investment in impaired loans and income recognized on impaired loans:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011      2010      2009  
     (in thousands)  

Average balance during the year on impaired loans

   $ 207,957       $ 230,026       $ 263,765   

Interest income recognized on impaired loans

   $ 7,971       $ 7,636       $ 10,459   

Interest recognized on nonaccrual loans, cash basis

   $ 444       $ 2,501       $ 624   

The following table is average investment in impaired loans by loan class:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

     

Owner occupied

   $ 53,637       $ 54,633   

Non-owner occupied

     48,124         43,718   

Multi-family

     1,969         4,977   

Commercial and industrial

     

Commercial

     13,416         11,715   

Leases

     2,767         2,076   

Construction and land development

     

Construction

     26,753         28,930   

Land

     25,071         38,928   

Residential real estate

     35,544         44,286   

Consumer

     676         763   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 207,957       $ 230,026   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table presents interest income on impaired loans by class:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011      2010      2009  
     (in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

        

Owner occupied

   $ 2,631       $ 1,874       $ 2,355   

Non-owner occupied

     1,173         2,466         1,608   

Multi-family

     41         72         162   

Commercial and industrial

        

Commercial

     1,233         737         1,265   

Leases

     185         —           —     

Construction and land development

        

Construction

     952         1,291         3,665   

Land

     907         649         732   

Residential real estate

     803         504         652   

Consumer

     46         43         20   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 7,971       $ 7,636       $ 10,459   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company is not committed to lend significant additional funds on these impaired loans.

 

102


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes nonperforming assets:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010  
     (in thousands)  

Nonaccrual loans

   $ 90,392       $ 116,999   

Loans past due 90 days or more on accrual status

     2,589         1,458   

Troubled debt restructured loans

     112,483         116,696   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total nonperforming loans

     205,464         235,153   

Foreclosed collateral

     89,104         107,655   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total nonperforming assets

   $ 294,568       $ 342,808   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Allowance for Credit Losses

The following table summarizes the allowance for credit losses by portfolio:

 

     For the Years Ended December 31,  
     Construction and
Land Development
     Commercial
Real Estate
     Residential
Real Estate
     Commercial
and Industrial
     Consumer      Total  
     (in thousands)  

2011

                 

Beginning Balance

   $ 20,587       $ 33,043       $ 20,889       $ 30,782       $ 5,398       $ 110,699   

Charge-offs

     11,238         22,128         19,071         9,757         4,469         66,663   

Recoveries

     2,154         2,157         1,060         3,401         174         8,946   

Provision

     2,692         21,959         16,256         1,109         4,172         46,188   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 14,195       $ 35,031       $ 19,134       $ 25,535       $ 5,275       $ 99,170   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2010

                 

Beginning Balance

   $ 29,608       $ 16,279       $ 24,397       $ 31,883       $ 6,456       $ 108,623   

Charge-offs

     23,623         33,821         20,663         17,218         5,213         100,538   

Recoveries

     3,197         1,003         2,039         3,000         164         9,403   

Provision

     11,405         49,582         15,116         13,117         3,991         93,211   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 20,587       $ 33,043       $ 20,889       $ 30,782       $ 5,398       $ 110,699   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2009

                 

Beginning Balance

   $ 28,010       $ 11,870       $ 11,735       $ 19,867       $ 3,345       $ 74,827   

Charge-offs

     35,807         16,756         24,082         38,573         4,270         119,488   

Recoveries

     1,708         230         545         1,529         173         4,185   

Provision

     35,697         20,935         36,199         49,060         7,208         149,099   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 29,608       $ 16,279       $ 24,397       $ 31,883       $ 6,456       $ 108,623   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

103


Table of Contents

The following table presents loans individually evaluated for impairment by class of loans:

 

     December 31, 2011  
     Unpaid
Principal
Balance
     Recorded
Investment
     Partial
Charge-offs
     Allowance
for Credit
Losses Allocated
 
     (in thousands)  

With no related allowance recorded:

           

Commercial real estate

           

Owner occupied

   $ 47,792       $ 41,338       $ 6,454       $ —     

Non-owner occupied

     41,500         36,806         4,694         —     

Multi-family

     213         194         19         —     

Commercial and industrial

           

Commercial

     24,769         22,804         1,965         —     

Leases

     592         592         —           —     

Construction and land development

           

Construction

     21,774         18,821         2,953         —     

Land

     39,177         34,067         5,110         —     

Residential real estate

     32,577         23,950         8,627         —     

Consumer

     2,328         2,288         40         —     

With an allowance recorded:

           

Commercial real estate

           

Owner occupied

     5,572         5,442         130         1,333   

Non-owner occupied

     7,865         6,316         1,549         1,276   

Multi-family

     630         616         14         218   

Commercial and industrial

           

Commercial

     2,516         2,334         182         1,863   

Leases

     —           —           —           —     

Construction and land development

           

Construction

     5,018         2,006         3,012         499   

Land

     7,298         7,017         281         3,002   

Residential real estate

     5,059         4,900         159         2,186   

Consumer

     —           —           —           —     

With an allowance recorded:

           
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 244,680       $ 209,491       $ 35,189       $ 10,377   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

104


Table of Contents

 

     December 31, 2010  
     Unpaid
Principal
Balance
     Recorded
Investment
     Partial
Charge-offs
     Allowance for
Credit
Losses Allocated
 
     (in thousands)  

With no related allowance recorded:

           

Commercial real estate

           

Owner occupied

   $ 38,893       $ 36,811       $ 2,082       $ —     

Non-owner occupied

     72,705         66,156         6,549         —     

Multi-family

     7,087         4,478         2,609         —     

Commercial and industrial

           

Commercial

     9,155         4,780         4,375         —     

Leases

     3,655         3,655         —           —     

Construction and land development

           

Construction

     23,214         19,217         3,997         —     

Land

     31,237         24,807         6,430         —     

Residential real estate

     38,936         32,593         6,343         —     

Consumer

     548         522         26         —     

With an allowance recorded:

           

Commercial real estate

           

Owner occupied

     15,684         14,346         1,338         3,873   

Non-owner occupied

     1,961         1,804         157         530   

Multi-family

     358         346         12         179   

Commercial and industrial

           

Commercial

     4,520         4,367         153         3,170   

Leases

     —           —           —           —     

Construction and land development

           

Construction

     12,490         12,490         —           1,722   

Land

     5,018         1,901         3,117         1,124   

Residential real estate

     11,598         9,830         1,768         2,716   

Consumer

     232         232         —           126   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 277,291       $ 238,335       $ 38,956       $ 13,440   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table presents the balance in the allowance for credit losses and the recorded investment in loans by portfolio segment and based on impairment method:

 

     December 31, 2011  
     Commercial      Commercial                                            
     Real Estate -
Owner
Occupied
     Real Estate -
Non-Owner
Occupied
     Commercial
and
Industrial
     Residential
Real

Estate
     Construction
and Land
Development
     Commercial
Leases
     Consumer      Total  
     (in thousands)  

Allowance for credit losses:

                       

Ending balance attributable to loans individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 1,333       $ 1,494       $ 1,863       $ 2,186       $ 3,501       $ —         $ —         $ 10,377   

Collectively evaluated for impairment

     16,434         15,770         21,605         16,948         10,694         2,067         5,275         88,793   

Acquired with deteriorated credit quality

     —           —           —           —           —           —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total ending allowance

   $ 17,767       $ 17,264       $ 23,468       $ 19,134       $ 14,195       $ 2,067       $ 5,275       $ 99,170   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

105


Table of Contents

 

     December 31, 2010  
     Commercial      Commercial                                            
     Real Estate -      Real Estate -      Commercial      Residential      Construction                       
     Owner      Non-Owner      and      Real      and Land      Commercial                
     Occupied      Occupied      Industrial      Estate      Development      Leases      Consumer      Total  
     (in thousands)  

Allowance for credit losses:

                       

Ending balance attributable to loans individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 3,873       $ 709       $ 3,170       $ 2,716       $ 2,846       $ —         $ 126       $ 13,440   

Collectively evaluated for impairment

     11,108         17,353         23,981         18,173         17,741         3,631         5,272         97,259   

Acquired with deteriorated credit quality

     —           —           —           —           —           —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total ending allowance

   $ 14,981       $ 18,062       $ 27,151       $ 20,889       $ 20,587       $ 3,631       $ 5,398       $ 110,699   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

In the first quarter of 2011, the Company modified its allowance for credit loss calculation to bring the loss factors current instead of a one quarter lag and changed its premium calculation for net graded and watch loans to use a more quantitative method that better reflects the additional risk. The net effect of the change compared to the calculation method used at December 31, 2010 was to increase provision and allowance for credit losses by $3.7 million. The net effect by portfolio segment was to increase provision for credit losses for commercial real estate, construction and land, residential real estate and consumer loan portfolios by $2.0 million, $1.2 million, $0.6 million, and $0.2 million, respectively, and decrease provision for credit losses on the commercial and industrial portfolio by $0.3 million.

Troubled Debt Restructurings (TDR)

A troubled debt restructured loan is a loan on which the Bank, for reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, grants a concession to the borrower that the Bank would not otherwise consider. The loan terms that have been modified or restructured due to a borrower’s financial situation include, but are not limited to, a reduction in the stated interest rate, an extension of the maturity or renewal of the loan at an interest rate below current market, a reduction in the face amount of the debt, a reduction in the accrued interest, extensions, deferrals, renewals and rewrites. The majority of the Bank’s modifications are extension in terms or deferral of payments which result in no lost principal or interest followed by reductions in interest rates or accrued interest. A troubled debt restructured loan is also considered impaired. Generally, a loan that is modified at an effective market rate of interest may no longer be disclosed as a troubled debt restructuring in years subsequent to the restructuring if it is not impaired based on the terms specified by the restructuring agreement.

The following table presents information on the financial effects of troubled debt restructured loans by class for the periods presented:

 

     Year End December 31, 2011  
     Number
of Loans
     Pre-Modification
Outstanding
Recorded Investment
     Forgiven
Principal
Balance
     Lost
Interest
Income (1)
     Post-Modification
Outstanding
Recorded Investment (2)
     Waived Fees
and Other
Expenses
 
     (dollars in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

                 

Owner occupied

     25       $ 24,605       $ —         $ 1,279       $ 23,326       $ 242   

Non-owner occupied

     19         28,993         1,000         421         27,572         267   

Multi-family

     1         214         —           19         195         4   

Commercial and industrial

                 

Commercial

     41         22,211         —           231         21,980         62   

Leases

     —           —           —           —           —           —     

Construction and land development

                 

Construction

     3         12,443         —           1,180         11,263         38   

Land

     15         22,389         281         890         21,218         74   

Residential real estate

     34         17,378         1,010         1,364         15,004         20   

Consumer

     6         2,017         —           9         2,008         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     144       $ 130,250       $ 2,291       $ 5,393       $ 122,566       $ 707   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Lost interest income is processed as a charge-off to loan principal in the Company’s financial statements.
(2) The majority of modifications are extension in terms or deferral of payments and interest concessions.

 

106


Table of Contents

The following table presents TDR loans by class for which there was a payment default during the period:

 

     Year Ended  
     December 31, 2011  
     Number      Recorded  
     of Loans      Investment  
     (dollars in thousands)  

Commercial real estate

     

Owner occupied

     7       $ 2,971   

Non-owner occupied

     3         2,571   

Multi-family

     —           —     

Commercial and industrial

     

Commercial

     —           —     

Leases

     —           —     

Construction and land development

     

Construction

     2         2,463   

Land

     4         2,193   

Residential real estate

     8         2,661   

Consumer

     —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     24       $ 12,859   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

A TDR loan is deemed to have a payment default when it becomes past due 90 days, goes on nonaccrual, or is re-structured again.

As a result of adopting the amendments in ASU No. 2011-02, the Company reassessed all loan modifications that occurred on or after the beginning of the current year for identification as TDRs. The Company identified $10.6 million of additional TDR loans. The amendments in this ASU require prospective application of the impairment measurement guidance for those loans newly identified as impaired. As of December 31, 2011, there was no allowance for credit losses associated with those loans on the basis of a current evaluation of loss. At December 31, 2011 loan commitments outstanding on TDR loans were $0.2 million.

Related Parties

Principal stockholders, directors, and executive officers of the Company, together with companies they control, are considered to be related parties. In the ordinary course of business, the Company has extended credit to these related parties. Federal banking regulations require that any such extensions of credit not be offered on terms more favorable than would be offered to non-related party borrowers of similar creditworthiness. The following table summarizes the aggregate activity in such loans:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     (in thousands)  

Balance, beginning

   $ 36,809      $ 45,513   

New loans

     15,218        12,465   

Repayments and other

     (17,633     (21,169
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, ending

   $ 34,394      $ 36,809   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Included in repayments and other at December 31, 2011 and 2010, were reductions of $8.7 million and $4.1 million, respectively, related to resignations of directors or other related party relationship changes. None of these loans are past due, on nonaccrual status or have been restructured to provide a reduction or deferral of interest or principal because of deterioration in the financial position of the borrower. There were no loans to a related party that were considered classified loans at December 31, 2011 or 2010.

 

107


Table of Contents

Loan commitments outstanding with related parties total approximately $34.4 million and $39.8 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

Loan Purchases and Sales

In 2011 and 2010, the Company had secondary market loan purchases of $75.8 million and $65.8 million, respectively. For 2011, these purchased loans by portfolio type were $55.5 million of commercial leases, $15.1 million of commercial and industrial loans, $4.9 million of owner-occupied commercial real estate, and $0.3 million of non-owner occupied commercial real estate. For 2010, these purchased loans consisted of $61.7 million of commercial leases, $3.1 million non-owner occupied commercial real estate, and $1.0 million of commercial and industrial loans. In addition, the Company periodically acquires newly originated loans at closing through participations or loan syndications. The Company had no significant loan sales in 2011 or 2010. The Company held no loans for sale at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

5. PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     (in thousands)  

Bank premises

   $ 73,716      $ 73,474   

Land and improvements

     30,580        30,580   

Furniture, fixtures and equipment

     49,533        57,423   

Leasehold improvements

     12,519        13,243   

Construction in progress

     982        360   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     167,330        175,080   

Less: accumulated depreciation and amortization

     (61,784     (60,708
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Premises and equipment, net

   $ 105,546      $ 114,372   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Lease Obligations

The Company leases certain premises and equipment under non-cancelable operating leases expiring through 2025. The following is a schedule of future minimum rental payments under these leases at December 31, 2011:

 

     (in thousands)  

2012

   $ 4,923   

2013

     4,501   

2014

     3,143   

2015

     2,954   

2016

     2,540   

Thereafter

     7,346   
  

 

 

 
   $ 25,407   
  

 

 

 

The Company leases the majority of its office locations and many of these leases contain multiple renewal options and provisions for increased rents. Total rent expense of $5.6 million, $5.1 million and $5.4 million is included in occupancy expenses for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Total depreciation expense of $7.1 million, $8.0 million, and $8.5 million is included in occupancy expenses for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

108


Table of Contents

6. OTHER ASSETS ACQUIRED THROUGH FORECLOSURE

The following table represents the changes in other assets acquired through foreclosure:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
           (in thousands)        

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 107,655      $ 83,347      $ 14,545   

Additions

     48,585        93,656        104,610   

Dispositions

     (47,366     (40,674     (17,858

Valuation adjustments in the period, net

     (19,770     (28,674     (17,950
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

   $ 89,104      $ 107,655      $ 83,347   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

At December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, the majority of the Company’s repossessed assets consisted of properties located in Nevada.

7. GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS

Goodwill is created when a company acquires a business. When a business is acquired, the purchased assets and liabilities are recorded at fair value and intangible assets are identified. Excess consideration paid to acquire a business over the fair value of the net assets is recorded as goodwill. During the fourth quarter 2011, the Company reviewed its goodwill for impairment in accordance with FASB ASC 350-20-35, Intangibles – Goodwill and Other. The Company’s annual goodwill impairment testing is October 1. As a result of this process, the Company determined that there was no goodwill impairment. There also was no goodwill impairment in 2010. Total goodwill impairment for the year ended December 31, 2009 was $49.7 million.

During the third quarter 2009, the Company determined that it was necessary to perform an interim test for goodwill impairment on its former subsidiary Miller/Russell and Associates, Inc. As a result of this goodwill impairment test, the Company determined that the Miller/Russell reporting unit was impaired by $0.6 million.

During the first quarter 2009, as a result of the significant decline in the Company’s stock price and depressed economic conditions among financial institutions in general, the Company determined that it was necessary to perform an interim test for goodwill impairment. As a result of the March 31 goodwill impairment test, the Company determined that the Bank of Nevada reporting unit was impaired by $45.0 million.

The goodwill impairment charges had no effect on the Company’s cash balances or liquidity. In addition, because goodwill is not included in the calculation of regulatory capital, the Company’s regulatory ratios were not affected by these non-cash expenses. No assurance can be given that goodwill will not be further impaired in future periods.

Intangible Assets

The following is a summary of acquired intangible assets:

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2011  
     Gross Carrying      Accumulated      Net Carrying  

Subject to amortization:

   Amount      Amortization      Amount  
            (in thousands)         

Core deposit intangibles

   $ 24,579       $ 16,467       $ 8,112   

Other

     3,145         1,450         1,695   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 27,724       $ 17,917       $ 9,807   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

109


Table of Contents

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2010  
     Gross Carrying      Accumulated      Sale of      Net Carrying  

Subject to amortization:

   Amount      Amortization      Premier Trust      Amount  
            (in thousands)         

Core deposit intangibles

   $ 24,579       $ 13,029       $ —         $ 11,550   

Other

     3,779         1,737         226         1,816   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 28,358       $ 14,766       $ 226       $ 13,366   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amortization expense recognized on all amortizable intangibles totaled $3.6 million, $3.6 million and $3.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Below is a summary of estimated aggregate amortization expense over the next five years and thereafter:

 

     Year Ended December 31  
     (in thousands)  

2012

   $ 3,208   

2013

     2,194   

2014

     1,263   

2015

     924   

2016

     924   

Thereafter

     1,294   

8. INCOME TAXES

The cumulative tax effects of the primary temporary differences as of December 31 are shown in the following table:

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     (in thousands)  

Deferred tax assets:

  

Allowance for credit losses

   $ 38,021      $ 40,732   

OREO writedowns

     11,448        8,070   

Net operating loss carryforwards

     20,245        34,291   

Stock based compensation

     5,594        5,102   

Nonaccrual interest

     3,050        3,126   

Credit carryforwards

     2,509        2,509   

Unrealized loss on available for sale securities

     2,448        5,281   

Capital loss carryforwards

     7,724        9,117   

Other

     2,519        1,804   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total gross deferred tax assets

     93,558        110,032   

Deferred tax asset valuation allowance

     (7,596     (7,596
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets

     85,962        102,436   

Deferred tax liabilities:

    

Core deposit intangible

     (3,069     (4,043

Premises and equipment

     (4,873     (5,495

Deferred loan costs

     (2,421     (2,091

FHLB dividend

     (1,948     (1,877

Unrealized gains on financial instruments measured at fair value

     (11,326     (8,445

Other

     (601     (625
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities

     (24,238     (22,576
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred tax asset

   $ 61,724      $ 79,860   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are included in the financial statements at currently enacted income tax rates applicable to the period in which the deferred tax assets or liabilities are expected to be realized or settled. As changes in tax laws or rates are enacted, deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted through the provision for income taxes.

 

110


Table of Contents

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are included in the financial statements at currently enacted income tax rates applicable to the period in which the deferred tax assets or liabilities are expected to be realized or settled. As changes in tax laws or rates are enacted, deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted through the provision for income taxes.

For the year ended December 31, 2011, the net deferred tax assets decreased $18.1 million to $61.7 million. This decrease in the net deferred tax asset was primarily the result of the net operating income of the Company for the year and the resulting usage of the NOL carryforward.

For the year ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, the $7.6 million deferred tax valuation relates to net capital losses on ARPS securities sales.

The deferred tax asset related to federal and state net operating loss carryforwards outstanding at December 31, 2011, available to reduce tax liability in future years total $20.2 million. This is comprised of $16.4 million of tax benefits from federal net operating loss carry forwards that begin to expire in 2029, $1.7 million of tax benefits from California state net operating loss carry forwards that will begin to expire in 2029 (however, California currently has suspended the ability of taxpayers to use loss carryforwards to reduce their current state tax liability), and $2.1 million of tax benefits from Arizona state net operating loss carryforwards that will begin to expire in 2013. In Management’s opinion, it is more likely than not that the results of future operations will generate sufficient taxable income to realize the deferred taxes related to these net operating loss carryforwards.

The provision for income taxes charged to operations consists of the following:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011      2010     2009  
            (in thousands)        

Current

   $ 1,546       $ 1,182      $ 7,847   

Deferred

     15,303         (7,592     (46,300
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total tax provision

   $ 16,849       $ (6,410   $ (38,453
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

The reconciliation between the statutory federal income tax rate and the Company’s effective tax rate are summarized as follows:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
           (in thousands)        

Income tax at statutory rate

   $ 17,619      $ (3,703   $ (64,873

Increase (decrease) resulting from:

      

State income taxes, net of federal benefits

     1,411        (739     (1,641

Dividends received deductions

     (900     (476     (442

Bank-owned life insurance

     (1,431     (1,155     (767

Tax-exempt income

     (867     (280     (338

Nondeductible expenses

     276        340        445   

Nondeductible goodwill impairment

     —          —          17,385   

Deferred tax asset valuation allowance

     —          (2,033     6,200   

Restricted stock write off

     617        1,259        2,057   

Other, net

     124        377        3,521   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 16,849      $ (6,410   $ (38,453
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Uncertain Tax Position

The Company files income tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction and in various states. With few exceptions, the Company is no longer subject to U.S. federal, state or local tax examinations by tax authorities for years before 2007. Although, as described below, the Internal Revenue Service’s examination of the Company’s 2008 net operating loss carryback claim appears to have been resolved in the Company’s favor, it is not yet closed.

When tax returns are filed, it is highly certain that some positions taken would be sustained upon examination by the taxing authorities, while others are subject to uncertainty about the merits of the position taken or the amount of the position that would be ultimately sustained. The benefit of a tax position is recognized in the financial statements in the

 

111


Table of Contents

period in which, based on all available evidence, management believes it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained upon examination, including the resolution of appeals or litigation processes, if any. Tax positions taken are not offset or aggregated with other positions. Tax positions that meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold are measured as the largest amount of tax benefit that is more than 50 percent likely of being realized upon settlement with the applicable taxing authority. The portion of the benefits associated with tax positions taken that exceeds the amount measured as described above would be reflected as a liability for unrecognized tax benefits in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet along with any associated interest and penalties that would be payable to the taxing authorities upon examination.

The Company would recognize interest accrued related to unrecognized tax benefits in tax expense. The Company has not recognized or accrued any interest or penalties for the periods ended December 31, 2011, 2010 or 2009, respectively.

The Company adopted the provisions of FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes, on January 1, 2007, which were incorporated into ASC 740. Management believes that the Company has appropriate support for the income tax positions taken and to be taken on its tax returns and that its accruals for tax liabilities are adequate for all open years based on an assessment of many factors, including past experience and interpretation of tax law applied to the facts of each matter.

The Internal Revenue Service’s Examination Division issued a notice of proposed deficiency on January 10, 2011, proposing a taxable income adjustment of $136.7 million related to deductions taken on our 2008 tax return in connection with the partial worthlessness of collateralized debt obligations, or CDOs. The use of these deductions on the Company’s 2008 tax return resulted in a net operating loss carryback claim for a tax refund of approximately $40.0 million of federal taxes for the 2006 and 2007 taxable periods. The Company filed a protest of the proposed deficiency, which was referred to the Appeals Division of the Internal Revenue Service. The Appellate Conferee has conceded that the Company’s $136.7 million deduction was reasonable and has proposed no further adjustments. However, the case is not yet closed. Due to the size of the refund, the Appellate Conferee is required to submit his formal written recommendation to the Joint Committee on Taxation and will close the case after receiving approval from that committee. The Company has not accrued a reserve for this potential exposure.

9. DEPOSITS

The table below summarizes deposits by type:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010  
     (in thousands)  

Non-interest-bearing demand

   $ 1,558,211       $ 1,443,251   

Interest-bearing demand

     482,729         523,827   

Savings and money market

     2,166,639         1,926,060   

Certificate of deposit ($100,000 or more)

     1,288,681         1,276,369   

Other time deposits

     162,252         168,934   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deposits

   $ 5,658,512       $ 5,338,441   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Of the total deposits at December 31, 2011, $4.21 billion may be immediately withdrawn. Certificates of deposit are the only deposits which have a specified maturity.

 

112


Table of Contents

The summary of the contractual maturities for all time deposits is as follows:

 

     December 31,  
     2011  
     (in thousands)  

2012

   $ 1,348,034   

2013

     93,201   

2014

     8,121   

2015

     290   

2016

     1,287   
  

 

 

 
   $ 1,450,933   
  

 

 

 

The Company through its banks is a member of Certificate Deposit Account Registry Service (“CDARS”), which provides FDIC insurance for large deposits. Federal banking law and regulation places restrictions on depository institutions regarding brokered deposits because of the general concern that these deposits are at a greater risk of being withdrawn, thus posing liquidity risk for institutions that gather brokered deposits in significant amounts. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had $376.0 million and $357.0 million, respectively, of reciprocal CDARS deposits. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company also had $34.6 million and $20.0 million, respectively, of other brokered deposits outstanding.

10. OTHER BORROWINGS

The following table summarizes the Company’s borrowings as of December 31, 2011 and 2010:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010  
     (in thousands)  

Short Term

     

Federal Home Loan Bank advances

   $ 280,000       $ —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Long Term

     

Other long term debt

   $ 75,000       $ 75,000   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company maintains lines of credit with the Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) and Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”). The Company’s borrowing capacity is determined based on collateral pledged, generally consisting of investment securities and loans, at the time of the borrowing. The Company also maintains credit lines with other sources secured by pledged securities. Short-term FHLB and FRB advances had weighted average interest rates of 0.15% and 0.24% for the years ending December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

On August 25, 2010, the Company completed a public offering of $75 million in principal Senior Notes due in 2015 bearing interest of 10%. The net proceeds of the offering were $72.8 million. The weighted average rate on all long term debt was 10.81% and 9.89% in 2011 and 2010, respectively.

The following table summarizes maturities of other borrowed funds:

 

Year ending December 31:

      

2012

   $ 280,000   

2013

     —     

2014

     —     

2015

     75,000   

2016

     —     

Thereafter

     —     
  

 

 

 
   $ 355,000   
  

 

 

 

 

113


Table of Contents

The Banks have entered into agreements with other financial institutions under which they can borrow up to $55.0 million on an unsecured basis. The lending institutions will determine the interest rate charged on borrowings at the time of the borrowing.

As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had additional available credit with the FHLB of approximately $843.4 billion and $676.3 million, respectively, and with the FRB of approximately $696.6 million and $547.0 million, respectively.

11. JUNIOR SUBORDINATED AND SUBORDINATED DEBT

The Company has formed or acquired through mergers six statutory business trusts, which exist for the exclusive purpose of issuing Cumulative Trust Preferred Securities. All of the funds raised from the issuance of these securities were passed to the Company and are reflected in the accompanying balance sheet as junior subordinated debt in the amount of $37.0 million. The junior subordinated debt has contractual balances and maturity dates as follows:

 

            December 31,  

Name of Trust

   Maturity      2011     2010  
            (in thousands)  

BankWest Nevada Capital Trust II

     2033       $ 15,464      $ 15,464   

Intermountain First Statutory Trust I

     2034         7,217        7,217   

WAL Trust No. 1

     2036         10,310        10,310   

First Independent Capital Trust I

     2034         20,619        20,619   

WAL Statutory Trust No. 2

     2037         5,155        5,155   

WAL Statutory Trust No. 3

     2037         7,732        7,732   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
      $ 66,497      $ 66,497   

Unrealized gains on trust preferred securities measured at fair value, net

        (29,512     (23,463
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
      $ 36,985      $ 43,034   
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

The weighted average contractual rate of the junior subordinated debt was 3.61% and 4.43% as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

In the event of certain changes or amendments to regulatory requirements or Federal tax rules, the debt is redeemable in whole. The obligations under these instruments are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the Company and rank subordinate and junior in right of payment to all other liabilities of the Company. The trust preferred securities qualify as Tier 1 Capital for the Company, subject to certain limitations, with the excess being included in total capital for regulatory purposes. During the second quarter of 2010, the Company paid-off $60.0 million of subordinated debt with a weighted average contractual rate of 3.09% and recorded a gain on extinguishment of debt of $3.0 million.

12. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

Unfunded Commitments and Letters of Credit

The Company is party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit. They involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk in excess of amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets.

Lines of credit are obligations to lend money to a borrower. Credit risk arises when the borrowers’ current financial condition may indicate less ability to pay than when the commitment was originally made. In the case of standby letters of credit, the risk arises from the possibility of the failure of the customer to perform according to the terms of a contract. In such a situation, the third party might draw on the standby letter of credit to pay for completion of the contract and the Company would look to its customer to repay these funds with interest. To minimize the risk, the Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations as it would for a loan to that customer.

Standby letters of credit and financial guarantees are conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party in borrowing arrangements. The Company generally has recourse to recover from the customer any amounts paid under the guarantees. Typically, letters of credit issued have expiration dates within one year.

 

114


Table of Contents

A summary of the contractual amounts for unfunded commitments and letters of credit are as follows:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010  
     (in thousands)  

Commitments to extend credit, including unsecured loan commitments of $167,305 at December 31, 2011 and $156,517 at December 31, 2010

   $ 863,120       $ 702,336   

Credit card commitments and financial guarantees

     319,892         322,798   

Standby letters of credit, including unsecured letters of credit of $2,558 at December 31, 2011 and $3,076 at December 31, 2010

     34,768         28,013   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,217,780       $ 1,053,147   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table represents the contractual commitments for lines and letters of credit by maturity at December 31, 2011:

 

     Total      Amount of Commitment Expiration Per Period  
     Amounts      Less Than      1-3      3-5      After  
     Committed      1 Year      Years      Years      5 Years  
     (in thousands)  

Commitments to extend credit

   $ 863,120       $ 488,714       $ 171,473       $ 108,280       $ 94,653   

Credit card commitments and guarantees

     319,892         319,892         —           —           —     

Standby letters of credit

     34,768         —           34,608         160         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,217,780       $ 808,606       $ 206,081       $ 108,440       $ 94,653   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. The Company enters into credit arrangements that generally provide for the termination of advances in the event of a covenant violation or other event of default. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The Company evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the Company upon extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation of the party. The commitments are collateralized by the same types of assets used as loan collateral.

The Company has exposure to credit losses from unfunded commitments and letters of credit. As funds have not been disbursed on these commitments, they are not reported as loans outstanding. Credit losses related to these commitments are not included in the allowance for credit losses reported in Note 4, “Loans, Leases and Allowance for Credit Losses” of these Consolidated Financial Statements and are accounted for as a separate loss contingency as a liability. This loss contingency for unfunded loan commitments and letters of credit was $1.1 million and $0.3 million as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Changes to this liability are adjusted through other non-interest expense.

Concentrations of Lending Activities

The Company’s lending activities are primarily driven by the customers served in the market areas where the Company has branch offices in the States of Nevada, California and Arizona. The Company monitors concentrations within five broad categories: geography, industry, product, call code, and collateral. The Company grants commercial, construction, real estate and consumer loans to customers through branch offices located in the Company’s primary markets. The Company’s business is concentrated in these areas and the loan portfolio includes significant credit exposure to the commercial real estate market of these areas. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, commercial real estate related loans accounted for approximately 61% and 64% of total loans, respectively, and approximately 2% of commercial real estate related loans are secured by undeveloped land. Substantially all of these loans are secured by first liens with an initial loan to value ratio of generally not more than 75%. Approximately 49% and 54% of these commercial real estate loans were owner occupied at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. In addition, approximately 4% and 3% of total loans were unsecured as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

Contingencies

The Company is involved in various lawsuits of a routine nature that are being handled and defended in the ordinary course of the Company’s business. Expenses are being incurred in connection with defending the Company, but in the opinion of Management, based in part on consultation with legal counsel, the resolution of these lawsuits and associated defense costs will not have a material impact on the Company’s financial position, results of operations, or cash flows.

 

115


Table of Contents

13. STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

Preferred Stock

On September 27, 2011, the Company received $141.0 million from the issuance of 141,000 shares of non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, Series B, par value of $.0001 per share and a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share, to the U.S. Treasury Department pursuant to participation in the U.S. Department of Treasury’s Small Business Lending Fund Program (SBLF). Initially established at 5%, the dividend rate can vary from as low as 1% to 9% in part depending upon the Company’s success in qualifying small business lending.

During the third quarter of 2011, the Company fully redeemed the $140 million, or 140,000 shares plus accrued and unpaid dividends, of cumulative Series A preferred stock that was sold to the U.S. Treasury in November 2008 as part of the TARP CPP. As a result of the redemption, the Company recorded a one-time $6.9 million charge to retained earnings in the form of accelerated deemed dividend to account for the difference between the amount at which the preferred stock sale had been initially recorded and its redemption price. Following this redemption, the warrant to purchase 787,106 shares of the Company’s common stock was repurchased from the U.S. Treasury Department at auction on November 18, 2011 for $415,000 and subsequently cancelled.

Common Stock Issuance

In the third quarter of 2010, the Company completed a public offering of 8,050,000 shares of common stock, including 1,050,000 shares pursuant to the underwriter’s over-allotment option, at a public offering price of $6.25 per share, for an aggregate offering price of $50.3 million. The net proceeds of the offering were approximately $47.6 million.

Stock Repurchases

There were no stock repurchases in 2011 or 2010.

Stock Options and Restricted Stock

The 2005 Stock Incentive Plan (the “Incentive Plan”), as amended, gives the Board of Directors the authority to grant up to 6.5 million stock awards consisting of unrestricted stock, stock units, dividend equivalent rights, stock options (incentive and non-qualified), stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, and performance and annual incentive awards. Stock awards available for grant at December 31, 2011 are 0.9 million.

The Incentive Plan contains certain individual limits on the maximum amount that can be paid in cash under the Incentive Plan and on the maximum number of shares of common stock that may be issued pursuant to the Incentive Plan in a calendar year. The maximum number of shares subject to options or stock appreciation rights that can be issued under the Incentive Plan to any person is 150,000 shares in any calendar year. The maximum amount that may be earned as an annual incentive award or other cash award in any fiscal year by any one person is $5.0 million and the maximum amount that may be earned as a performance award or other cash award by any one person is $15.0 million.

The fair value of each option award is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option valuation model that uses the assumptions noted in the following table. The expected volatility is based on the historical volatility of the stock of the Company over the expected life of the Company’s options. The Company estimates the life of the options by calculating the average of the vesting period and the contractual life. The expected life of replacement options was estimated based on the simplified method. The risk-free rate for periods within the contractual life of the option is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of the grant. The dividend rate assumption of zero is based on management’s intention not to pay dividends for the foreseeable future. A summary of the assumptions used in calculating the fair value of option awards during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 are as follows:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

Expected life in years

     4        5        5   

Risk-free interest rate

     1.5     2.5     1.5

Dividends rate

     None        None        None   

Fair value per optional share

   $ 3.94      $ 3.22      $ 3.73   

Volatility

     72     76     58

Stock options granted in 2011 generally have a vesting period of 4 years and a contractual life of 7 years. Restricted stock awards granted in 2011 generally have a vesting period of 3 years. The Company recognizes compensation cost for options with a graded vesting on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for the entire award.

 

116


Table of Contents

A summary of option activity under the Incentive Plan is presented below:

 

     December 31, 2011  
           Weighted      Weighted         
           Average      Average         
           Exercise      Remaining      Aggregate  
           Price      Contractual Term      Intrinsic  
     Shares     (per share)      (in years)      Value  
     (in thousands, except exercise price and contractual terms)  

Outstanding options, beginning of period

     2,532      $ 14.82         

Granted

     39        7.27         

Exercised

     (53     6.81         

Forfeited or expired

     (410     16.06         
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Outstanding options, end of period

     2,108      $ 14.64         2.4       $ 16   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Options exercisable, end of period

     1,846      $ 15.36         2.2       $ 4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Options expected to vest, end of period

     231      $ 9.71         3.9       $ 15   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     December 31, 2010  
           Weighted      Weighted         
           Average      Average         
           Exercise      Remaining      Aggregate  
           Price      Contractual Term      Intrinsic  
     Shares     (per share)      (in years)      Value  
     (in thousands, except exercise price and contractual terms)  

Outstanding options, beginning of period

     2,858      $ 14.71         

Granted

     111        5.21         

Exercised

     (30     5.53         

Forfeited or expired

     (407     12.00         
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Outstanding options, end of period

     2,532      $ 14.82         3.1       $ 352   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Options exercisable, end of period

     2,027      $ 15.56         2.7       $ 262   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Options expected to vest, end of period

     434      $ 12.04         4.7       $ 90   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

A summary of the status of the Company’s unvested shares of restricted stock and changes during the years then ended is presented below:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010  
           Weighted            Weighted  
           Average Grant            Average Grant  
     Shares     Date Fair Value      Shares     Date Fair Value  
     (in thousands, except per share amounts)  

Balance, beginning of period

     1,000      $ 6.61         609      $ 14.29   

Granted

     616        7.16         668        5.55   

Vested

     (202     9.39         (210     24.61   

Forfeited

     (111     6.57         (67     9.17   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

     1,303      $ 6.44         1,000      $ 6.61   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, there was $4.0 million, $6.1 million, and $7.9 million, respectively, of total unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested share-based compensation arrangements granted under the Incentive Plan. That cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.8 years, 1.8 years and 1.7 years, respectively. The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009 were $53,000, $50,000 and $0, respectively. The total fair value of restricted stock that vested during the years

 

117


Table of Contents

ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $1.5 million, $1.3 million and $1.7 million, respectively. The weighted average grant-date fair value of restricted stock granted during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $4.0 million, $3.6 million and $2.7 million, respectively.

Stock Warrants

At December 31, 2011, there were 131,684 warrants outstanding, with an exercise price of $34.56, that expire in August 2013.

The remaining warrants issued to the federal government as part of the TARP Capital Purchase Program preferred stock offering were repurchased at auction and subsequently retired as discussed above.

Salary Shares

In 2011 and 2010, the Company issued salary shares to certain individuals. Total shares issued at December 31, 2011 and 2010 were 105,834 and 88,851, respectively for compensation expense of $0.7 million and $0.6 million, respectively. There were no salary shares issued in 2009. Salary shares are issued as common stock which vests immediately.

14. REGULATORY CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS

The Company and the Banks are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements could trigger certain mandatory or discretionary actions that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Company’s business and financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Company and the Banks must meet specific capital guidelines that involve qualitative measures of their assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and the Banks to maintain minimum amounts and ratios of total and Tier I capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier I leverage (as defined) to average assets (as defined). As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company and the Banks met all capital adequacy requirements to which they are subject.

As of December 31, 2011, the Company and each of its subsidiaries met the minimum capital ratio requirements necessary to be classified as well-capitalized, as defined by the banking agencies. To be categorized as well-capitalized, the Banks must maintain minimum total risk-based, Tier I risk-based and Tier I leverage ratios as set forth in the table below. In addition, the Memorandum of Understanding to which Bank of Nevada is subject requires it to maintain a higher Tier 1 leverage ratio than otherwise required to be considered well-capitalized. At December 31, 2011, Bank of Nevada’s capital level exceeded this elevated requirement.

The actual capital amounts and ratios for the Banks and Company are presented in the following table:

 

                   Risk-      Tangible      Total     Tier 1     Tier 1  
     Total      Tier 1      Weighted      Average      Capital     Capital     Leverage  
     Capital      Capital      Assets      Assets      Ratio     Ratio     Ratio  
     (dollars in thousands)  

December 31, 2011

                  

WAL (Consolidated)

   $ 723,327       $ 651,104       $ 5,749,818       $ 6,636,083         12.6     11.3     9.8

Bank of Nevada

     294,747         266,430         2,232,208         2,818,077         13.2     11.9     9.5

Western Alliance Bank

     231,360         188,328         1,944,738         2,128,033         11.9     9.7     8.9

Torrey Pines Bank

     183,772         151,058         1,541,878         1,641,500         11.9     9.8     9.2

Well-capitalized ratios

                 10.0     6.0     5.0

Minimum capital ratios

                 8.0     4.0     4.0

 

118


Table of Contents

 

December 31, 2010

                    

WAL (Consolidated)

   $ 654,011       $ 591,633       $ 4,941,057       $ 6,198,903         13.2%         12.0%         9.5%   

Bank of Nevada

     278,697         250,907         2,177,357         2,705,631         12.8%         11.5%         9.3%   

Western Alliance Bank

     204,650         162,964         1,492,491         1,955,696         13.7%         10.9%         8.3%   

Torrey Pines Bank

     170,342         135,126         1,215,825         1,453,686         14.0%         11.1%         9.3%   

Well-capitalized ratios

                 10.0%         6.0%         5.0%   

Minimum capital ratios

                 8.0%         4.0%         4.0%   

Additionally, State of Nevada banking regulations restrict distribution of the net assets of Bank of Nevada because such regulations require the sum of the bank’s stockholders’ equity and reserve for loan losses to be at least 6% of the average of the bank’s total daily deposit liabilities for the preceding 60 days. As a result of these regulations, approximately $147.6 million and $145.2 million of Bank of Nevada’s stockholders’ equity was restricted at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

15. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

The Company has a qualified 401(k) employee benefit plan for all eligible employees. Participants are able to defer between 1% and 15% (up to a maximum of $16,500 for those under 50 years of age in 2011) of their annual compensation. The Company may elect to match a discretionary amount each year, which was 50% of the first 6% of the participant’s compensation deferred into the plan. The Company’s total contribution was $1.3 million, $1.2 million and $1.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

In addition, the Company maintains a non-qualified 401(k) restoration plan for the benefit of executives of the Company and certain affiliates. Participants are able to defer a portion of their annual salary and receive a matching contribution based primarily on the contribution structure in effect under the Company’s 401(k) plan, but without regard to certain statutory limitations applicable under the 401(k) plan. The Company’s total contribution to the restoration plan was approximately $11,000, $14,000, and $11,000 for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

16. FAIR VALUE ACCOUNTING

The Company adopted SFAS 159, The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (“SFAS 159”), effective January 1, 2007. This standard was subsequently codified under FASB ASC 825, Financial Instruments (“ASC 825”). At the time of adoption, the Company elected to apply this fair value option (“FVO”) treatment to its junior subordinated debt and certain investment securities. The Company continues to account for these items under the fair value option. Since adoption, there were no financial instruments purchased by the Company which met the ASC 825 fair value election criteria, and therefore, no additional instruments have been added under the fair value option election.

All securities for which the fair value measurement option had been elected are included in a separate line item on the balance sheet entitled “securities measured at fair value.”

ASC 825 establishes a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (level 1 measurements) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (level 3 measurements). The three levels of the fair value hierarchy under ASC 825 are described below:

Level 1—Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets that are accessible at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities;

Level 2—Quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active, matrix pricing, or model-based valuation techniques where all significant assumptions are observable, either directly or indirectly, in the market;

Level 3—Valuation is generated from model-based techniques where all significant assumptions are not observable, either directly or indirectly, in the market. These unobservable assumptions reflect our own estimates of assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques may include use of discounted cash flow models and similar techniques.

In general, fair value is based upon quoted market prices, where available. If such quoted market prices are not available, fair value is based upon internally developed models that primarily use, as inputs, observable market-based parameters. Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value. These adjustments may include amounts to reflect counterparty credit quality and the Company’s creditworthiness, among other things, as well as unobservable parameters. Any such valuation adjustments are applied consistently over time. The Company’s

 

119


Table of Contents

valuation methodologies may produce a fair value calculation that may not be indicative of net realizable value or reflective of future fair values. While management believes the Company’s valuation methodologies are appropriate and consistent with other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date. Furthermore, the reported fair value amounts have not been comprehensively revalued since the presentation dates, and therefore, estimates of fair value after the balance sheet date may differ significantly from the amounts presented herein.

For the year ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, gains and losses from fair value changes included in the Consolidated Statement of Operations were as follows:

 

     Changes in Fair Values for the Year Ended  
     December 31, 2011 for Items Measured at Fair  
     Value Pursuant to Election of the Fair Value Option  

Description

   Unrealized
Gain/(Loss) on
Assets and
Liabilities
Measured at
Fair Value,
Net
     Interest
Income on
Securities
     Interest
Expense on
Junior
Subordinated
Debt
    Total
Changes
Included in
Current-
Period
Earnings
 
            (in thousands)        

Securities measured at fair value

   $ 14       $ 26       $ —        $ 40   

Junior subordinated debt

     6,049         —           (1,043     5,006   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 6,063       $ 26       $ (1,043   $ 5,046   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     Changes in Fair Values for the Year Ended  
     December 31, 2010 for Items Measured at Fair  
     Value Pursuant to Election of the Fair Value Option  

Description

   Unrealized
Gain/(Loss) on
Assets and
Liabilities
Measured at
Fair Value, Net
    Interest
Income  on
Securities
     Interest
Expense on
Junior
Subordinated
Debt
    Total
Changes
Included in
Current-
Period
Earnings
 
           (in thousands)        

Securities measured at fair value

   $ 227      $ 366       $ —        $ 593   

Junior subordinated debt

     (596     —           (1,101     (1,697
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ (369   $ 366       $ (1,101   $ (1,104
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table presents the portion of trading securities losses related to trading securities still held at the reporting date:

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     (in thousands)  

Net gains and (losses) recognized during the period on trading securities

   $ 14      $ 227   

Less: net gains and (losses) recognized during the period on trading securities sold during the period

     190        1,344   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unrealized gains and (losses) recognized during the reporting period on trading securities still held at the reporting date

   $ (176   $ (1,117
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

120


Table of Contents

The difference between the aggregate fair value of junior subordinated debt ($37.0 million) and the aggregate unpaid principal balance thereof ($66.5 million) was $29.5 million at December 31, 2011.

Interest income on securities measured at fair value is accounted for similarly to those classified as available-for-sale and held-to-maturity. Any premiums or discounts are recognized in interest income over the term of the securities. For mortgage-backed securities, estimates of prepayments are considered in the constant yield calculations. Interest expense on junior subordinated debt is also determined under a constant yield calculation.

Fair value on a recurring basis

Financial assets and financial liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis include the following:

AFS Securities: Adjustable-rate preferred securities, one trust preferred security, corporate debt securities and CRA mutual fund investments are reported at fair value utilizing Level 1 inputs. Other securities classified as AFS are reported at fair value utilizing Level 2 inputs. For these securities, the Company obtains fair value measurements from an independent pricing service. The fair value measurements consider observable data that may include dealer quotes, market spreads, cash flows, the U.S. Treasury yield curve, live trading levels, trade execution data, market consensus prepayment speeds, credit information and the bond’s terms and conditions, among other things.

Securities measured at fair value: All of the Company’s securities measured at fair value, the majority of which are mortgage-backed securities, are reported at fair value utilizing Level 2 inputs in the same manner as described above for securities available for sale.

Independent pricing service: Management independently evaluates all of the fair value measurements received from our third party pricing service. This evaluation by management of the fair value of the portfolio is determined through multiple review steps. First, management reviews what has transpired in the market place with regards to interest rates, credit spreads, volatility, mortgage rates etc. and makes an expectation on changes to the securities valuations from the previous quarter. Then management compares expected changes to the actual valuation changes provided to it by its pricing service. Next, management compares a robust sampling of safekeeping marks on securities with the marks provided by our third party pricing service and determines whether there are any notable differences. Then, management compares the prices on Level 1 priced securities to publically available prices to verify those prices are similar. Finally, management discusses the assumptions used for Level 2 priced securities with our vendor. The vendor provides management with observable market data including interest rate curves and mortgage prepayment speed grids, as well as, dealer quote sheets, new bond offering sheets, and historical trade documentation. Management reviews the assumptions and decides whether those assumptions are reasonable. Management may compare interest rates, credit spreads and prepayments speeds used as part of the assumptions to that which management believes are reasonable. Management may price securities using the provided assumptions to determine whether they can develop similar prices on like securities. Any discrepancies with management’s review and the prices provided by the vendor are discussed with the vendor and the Company’s external auditors. Management has formally challenged the prices on several securities but has found that the vendor prices are reasonable.

Subsequent to year-end, management received dealer bids on several level two securities and executed a sale. The sales price received was in-line with the marks previously provided by the independent pricing service at year end.

Annually the company receives a SSAE 16 report from its independent pricing service attesting to the controls placed on the operations of the service from its auditor.

Interest rate swap: Interest rate swaps are reported at fair value utilizing Level 2 inputs. The Company obtains dealer quotations to value its interest rate swaps.

Junior subordinated debt: The Company estimates the fair value of its junior subordinated debt using a discounted cash flow model which incorporates the effect of the Company’s own credit risk in the fair value of the liabilities (Level 3). The Company’s cash flow assumptions were based on the contractual cash flows as the Company anticipates that it will pay the debt according to its contractual terms. The Company evaluated priced offerings on individual issuances of trust preferred securities and estimated the discount rate based, in part, on that information. The Company estimated the discount rate at 6.989%, which is a 641 basis point spread over 3 month LIBOR (0.579% as of December 31, 2011). As of December 31, 2010, the Company estimated the discount rate at 5.873%, which was a 557 basis point spread over 3 month LIBOR (0.303%).

 

121


Table of Contents

The fair value of these assets and liabilities were determined using the following inputs at the periods presented:

 

     Fair Value Measurements at Reporting Date Using:  

December 31, 2011

   Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
     Fair
Value
 
            (in thousands)         

Assets:

        

Securities measured at fair value

           

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

   $ —         $ 6,515       $ —         $ 6,515   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities available for sale

           

U.S. Government-sponsored agency securities

   $ —         $ 156,211       $ —         $ 156,211   

Municipal obligations

     —           5,586         —           5,586   

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     —           864,584         —           864,584   

Mutual funds

     28,864         —           —           28,864   

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     —           25,784         —           25,784   

Private label commercial mortgage-backed securities

     —           5,431            5,431   

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     54,676         —           —           54,676   

Trust preferred

     1,323         19,836         —           21,159   

Corporate debt securities

     4,575         —           —           4,575   

Other

     23,515         —           —           23,515   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 112,953       $ 1,077,432       $ —         $ 1,190,385   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

   $ —         $ 1,729       $ —         $ 1,729   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     (Level 1)      (Level 2)      (Level 3)      Fair
Value
 

Liabilities:

           

Junior subordinated debt

   $ —         $ —         $ 36,985       $ 36,985   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

   $ —         $ 946       $ —         $ 946   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2011, one trust preferred security with a net fair value of $19.8 million transferred from Level 1 to Level 2 due to a change in pricing source from an active trade used at the end of the third quarter 2011 to a pricing service.

 

122


Table of Contents

 

     Fair Value Measurements at Reporting Date Using:  

December 31, 2010

   Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
     Fair
Value
 
            (in thousands)         

Assets:

        

Securities measured at fair value

           

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

   $ —         $ 14,301       $ —         $ 14,301   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities available for sale

           

U.S. Government-sponsored agency securities

   $ —         $ 277,592       $ —         $ 277,592   

Municipal Obligations

     —           302         —           302   

Direct U.S. obligations and GSE residential mortgage-backed securities

     —           769,389         —           769,389   

Private label residential mortgage-backed securities

     —           8,111         —           8,111   

Adjustable-rate preferred stock

     67,243         —           —           67,243   

Trust preferred

     23,126         —           —           23,126   

Corporate debt securities

     4,907         —           —           4,907   

Other

     22,243         —           —           22,243   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 117,519       $ 1,055,394       $ —         $ 1,172,913   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

   $ —         $ 1,396       $ —         $ 1,396   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     (Level 1)      (Level 2)      (Level 3)      Fair
Value
 

Liabilities:

           

Junior subordinated debt

   $ —         $ —         $ 43,034       $ 43,034   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

   $ —         $ 1,396       $ —         $ 1,396   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

123


Table of Contents

 

Fair Value Measurements Using       
Significant Unobservable Inputs       
(Level 3)    Junior  
     Subordinated  
     Debt  
     (in thousands)  

Beginning balance January 1, 2010

   $ (42,438

Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized)

  

Included in earnings

     (596

Included in other comprehensive income

     —     

Purchases, issuances, and settlements, net

     —     

Transfers to held-to-maturity

     —     

Transfers in and/or out of Level 3

     —     
  

 

 

 

Ending balance December 31, 2010

     (43,034

Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized)

  

Included in earnings

     6,049   

Included in other comprehensive income

     —     

Purchases, issuances, and settlements, net

     —     

Transfers to held-to-maturity

     —     

Transfers in and/or out of Level 3

     —     
  

 

 

 

Ending balance December 31, 2011

   $ (36,985
  

 

 

 

The amount of total 2011 gains (losses) for the period included in earnings attributable to the change in unrealized gains (losses)relating to assets still held at the reporting date

   $ 6,049   
  

 

 

 

The amount of total 2010 gains (losses) for the period included in earnings attributable to the change in unrealized gains (losses)relating to assets still held at the reporting date

   $ (596
  

 

 

 

Fair value on a nonrecurring basis

Certain assets are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis; that is, the instruments are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis, but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment). The following table presents such assets carried on the balance sheet by caption and by level within the ASC 825 hierarchy:

 

     Fair Value Measurements Using  
            Quoted Prices                
            in Active      Active         
            Markets for      Markets for      Unobservable  
            Identical Assets      Similar Assets      Inputs  
     Total      (Level 1)      (Level 2)      (Level 3)  
     (in thousands)  

As of December 31, 2011:

        

Impaired loans with specific valuation allowance

   $ 18,254       $ —         $ —         $ 18,254   

Impaired loans without specific valuation allowance

     71,001         —           —           71,001   

Other assets acquired through foreclosure

     89,104         —           —           89,104   

 

124


Table of Contents

 

     Fair Value Measurements Using  
            Quoted Prices                
            in Active      Active         
            Markets for      Markets for      Unobservable  
            Identical Assets      Similar Assets      Inputs  
     Total      (Level 1)      (Level 2)      (Level 3)  
     (in thousands)  

As of December 31, 2010:

        

Impaired loans with specific valuation allowance

   $ 31,876       $ —         $ —         $ 31,876   

Impaired loans without specific valuation allowance

     66,355         —           —           66,355   

Other assets acquired through foreclosure

     107,655         —           —           107,655   

Impaired loans: The specific reserves for collateral dependent impaired loans are based on the fair value of the collateral. The fair value of collateral is determined based on third-party appraisals. In some cases, adjustments are made to the appraised values due to various factors, including age of the appraisal (which are generally obtained every six months), age of comparables included in the appraisal, and known changes in the market and in the collateral. When significant adjustments are based on unobservable inputs, such as when a current appraised value is not available or management determines the fair value of the collateral is further impaired below appraised value and there is no observable market price, the resulting fair value measurement has been categorized as a Level 3 measurement. These Level 3 impaired loans had an aggregate carrying amount of $28.6 million and specific reserves in the allowance for loan losses of $10.4 million at December 31, 2011.

Other assets acquired through foreclosure: Other assets acquired through foreclosure consist of properties acquired as a result of, or in-lieu-of, foreclosure. Properties or other assets classified as other assets acquired through foreclosure and other repossessed property and are initially reported at the fair value determined by independent appraisals using appraised value, less cost to sell. Such properties are generally re-appraised every six months. There is risk for subsequent volatility. Costs relating to the development or improvement of the assets are capitalized and costs relating to holding the assets are charged to expense. The Company had $89.1 million of such assets at December 31, 2011. When significant adjustments were based on unobservable inputs, such as when a current appraised value is not available or management determines the fair value of the collateral is further impaired below appraised value and there is no observable market price, the resulting fair value measurement has been categorized as a Level 3 measurement.

Credit vs. non-credit losses

The Company elected to apply provisions of ASC 320 as of January 1, 2009 to its AFS and HTM investment securities portfolios. The OTTI was separated into (a) the amount of total impairment related to the credit loss, and (b) the amount of the total impairment related to all other factors. The amount of the total OTTI related to the credit loss was recognized in earnings. The amount of the total impairment related to all other factors was recognized in other comprehensive income. The OTTI was presented in the statement of operations with an offset for the amount of the total OTTI that was recognized in other comprehensive income.

If the Company does not intend to sell and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the impaired securities before recovery of the amortized cost basis, the Company recognizes the cumulative effect of initially applying this FASB Staff Position (“FSP”) as an adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings with a corresponding adjustment to accumulated other comprehensive income, including related tax effects. The Company elected to early adopt ASC 320 on its impaired securities portfolio since it provides more transparency in the consolidated financial statements related to the bifurcation of the credit and non-credit losses.

For the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company determined that certain collateralized mortgage debt securities contained credit losses. The impairment credit losses related to these debt securities for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 was $0.2 million. The impairment credit loss related to these debt securities for the twelve months ended December 31, 2010 was $1.2 million.

 

 

125


Table of Contents

The following table presents a rollforward of the amount related to impairment credit losses recognized in earnings for the year ended December 31, 2011 and 2010:

Debt Security Credit Losses

Recognized in Other Comprehensive Income/Earnings

For the Year Ended December 31, 2011

 

     Private Label Mortgage-  
     Backed Securities  
     (in thousands)  

Beginning balance of impairment losses held in other comprehensive income

   $ (1,811

Current period other-then temporary impairment credit losses recognized through earnings

     —     

Reductions for securities sold during the period

     —     

Additions or reductions in credit losses due to change of intent to sell

     —     

Reductions for increases in cash flows to be collected on impaired securities

  
  

 

 

 

Ending balance of net unrealized gains and (losses) held in other comprehensive income

   $ (1,811
  

 

 

 

Debt Security Credit Losses

Recognized in Other Comprehensive Income/Earnings

For the Year Ended December 31, 2010

 

     Debt Obligations  and
Structured Securities
    Private Label Mortgage-
Backed Securities
 
     (in thousands)  

Beginning balance of impairment losses held in other comprehensive income

   $ (544   $ (1,811

Current period other-then temporary impairment credit losses recognized through earnings

     544        —     

Reductions for securities sold during the period

     —          —     

Additions or reductions in credit losses due to change of intent to sell

     —          —     

Reductions for increases in cash flows to be collected on impaired securities

     —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance of net unrealized gains and (losses) held in other comprehensive income

   $ —        $ (1,811
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

126


Table of Contents

17. FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

The estimated fair value of the Company’s financial instruments is as follows:

 

     December 31,  
     2011      2010  
     Carrying      Fair      Carrying      Fair  
     Amount      Value      Amount      Value  
     (in thousands)  

Financial assets:

  

Cash and due from banks

   $ 116,866       $ 116,866       $ 87,984       $ 87,984   

Federal funds sold

     —           —           918         918   

Money market investments

     7,343         7,343         37,733         37,733   

Investment securities—measured at fair value

     6,515         6,515         14,301         14,301   

Investment securities—available for sale

     1,190,385         1,190,385         1,172,913         1,172,913   

Investment securities—held to maturity

     286,258         290,035         48,151         47,996   

Derivatives

     1,729         1,729         1,396         1,396   

Restricted stock

     33,520         33,520         36,877         36,877   

Loans, net

     4,680,899         4,420,006         4,129,843         3,868,852   

Accrued interest receivable

     22,746         22,746         19,433         19,433   

Financial liabilities:

           

Deposits

     5,658,512         5,660,518         5,338,441         5,341,701   

Accrued interest payable

     4,707         4,707         6,085         6,085   

Customer repurchases

     123,626         123,626         109,409         109,409   

FHLB advances

     280,000         280,000         —           —     

Other borrowed funds

     73,321         78,375         72,964         85,454   

Junior subordinated debt

     36,985         36,985         43,034         43,034   

Derivatives

     946         946         1,396         1,396   

Interest rate risk

The Company assumes interest rate risk (the risk to the Company’s earnings and capital from changes in interest rate levels) as a result of its normal operations. As a result, the fair values of the Company’s financial instruments as well as its future net interest income will change when interest rate levels change and that change may be either favorable or unfavorable to the Company.

Interest rate risk exposure is measured using interest rate sensitivity analysis to determine our change in net portfolio value and net interest income resulting from hypothetical changes in interest rates. If potential changes to net portfolio value and net interest income resulting from hypothetical interest rate changes are not within the limits established by the Board of Directors, the Board of Directors may direct management to adjust the asset and liability mix to bring interest rate risk within board-approved limits. As of December 30, 2011, the Company’s interest rate risk profile was within Board-approved limits.

Each of the Company’s subsidiary banks has an Asset and Liability Management Committee charged with managing interest rate risk within Board approved limits. Such limits may vary by bank based on local strategy and other considerations, but in all cases, are structured to prohibit an interest rate risk profile that is significantly asset or liability sensitive. There also exists an Asset and Liability Management Committee at the holding company levels that reviews the interest rate risk of each subsidiary bank, as well as an aggregated position for the entire Company.

Fair value of commitments

The estimated fair value of standby letters of credit outstanding at December 31, 2011 and 2010 is insignificant. Loan commitments on which the committed interest rate is less than the current market rate are also insignificant at December 31, 2011 and 2010.

18. PARENT COMPANY FINANCIAL INFORMATION

The condensed financial statements of the holding company are presented in the following pages.

 

127


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION

Condensed Balance Sheets

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2010  
     (in thousands)  

ASSETS:

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 13,047      $ 2,552   

Securities available for sale

     33,873        62,383   

Investment in subsidiaries

     669,631        612,879   

Other assets

     38,439        45,793   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 754,990      $ 723,607   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:

    

Borrowings

   $ 73,321      $ 72,964   

Accrued interest and other liabilities

     8,001        5,435   

Junior subordinated debt

     36,985        43,034   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     118,307        121,433   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity:

    

Preferred stock

     141,000        130,827   

Common stock

     8        8   

Additional paid-in capital

     743,780        739,561   

Retained deficit

     (243,512     (258,800

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (4,593     (9,422
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     636,683        602,174   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 754,990      $ 723,607   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands)  

Interest and dividend income

   $ 1,502      $ 1,716      $ 1,605   

Interest expense on borrowings

     10,241        5,642        3,113   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest expense

     (8,739     (3,926     (1,508
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income (loss):

      

Income (loss) from consolidated subsidiaries

     45,336        (5,843     (123,859

Fair value gains

     6,050        (540     (17,938

Other income

     4,190        15,263        1,565   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income

     55,576        8,880        (140,232
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Expenses:

      

Salaries and employee benefits

     13,751        10,256        7,325   

Other

     11,342        9,662        4,224   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other expense

     25,093        19,918        11,549   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income tax benefit

     21,744        (14,964     (153,289

Income tax benefit (expense)

     9,750        7,769        1,883   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

     31,494        (7,195     (151,406

Preferred stock dividends

     7,033        7,000        7,000   

Accretion on preferred stock discount

     9,173        2,882        2,742   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) available to common stockholders

   $ 15,288      $ (17,077   $ (161,148
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

128


Table of Contents

WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION

Condensed Statements of Cash Flows

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  
     (in thousands)  

Cash Flows from Operating Activities:

      

Net income (loss)

   $ 31,494      $ (7,195   $ (151,406

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash used in operating activities:

      

Equity in net undistributed (earnings) losses of consolidated subsidiaries

     (45,336     5,843        123,859   

Dividends received from subsidiaries

     4,192        517        4,370   

Stock-based compensation expense

     1,237        1,268        1,296   

Trust preferred securities fair value (gains) losses

     (6,049     596        600   

Net amortization of premiums on investment securities

     201        112        478   

Securities impairment

     —          —          1,463   

Gain on sale of securities

     (50     (11,681     (4,415

(Increase) decrease in other assets

     40,858        16,535        (4,332

Deferred taxes

     (1,343     (4,096     (15,261

Increase in other liabilities

     2,923        2,483        17,852   

Other, net

     —          —          5,380   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

     28,127        4,382        (20,116
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash Flows from Investing Activities:

      

Purchases of securities

     (5,000     (23,568     (304,790

Proceeds from sales/maturities of securities

     3,159        52,815        226,495   

Purchase of premises and equipment

     (155     (37     —     

Proceeds from business divestitures

     —          2,284        2,700   

Investment in subsidiaries

     (8,000     (120,500     (124,792

Purchase of other repossesed assets, net

     (4,965     (50,836     —     

Proceeds from sale of other repossesed assets,net

     3,415        2,387        —     

Other

     —          —          (78
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (11,546     (137,455     (200,465
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash Flows from Financing Activities:

      

Net (repayments) proceeds from borrowings

     —          72,844        —     

Proceeds from exercise of stock options and stock warrants

     362        359        78   

Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock

     141,000        —          —     

Redemption of preferred stock

     (140,000     —          —     

Dividends paid

     (7,033     (7,000     (6,833

Repurchase of warrant

     (415     —          —     

Proceeds from stock issuances, net

     —          47,574        191,268   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities

     (6,086     113,777        184,513   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     10,495        (19,296     (36,068

Cash and Cash Equivalents, beginning of year

     2,552        21,848        57,916   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents, end of year

   $ 13,047      $ 2,552      $ 21,848   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

129


Table of Contents

19. SEGMENTS

The Company provides a full range of banking and investment advisory services through its consolidated subsidiaries. Applicable guidance provides that the identification of reportable segments be on the basis of discreet business units and their financial information to the extent such units are reviewed by the entity’s chief decision maker.

The Company adjusted segment reporting composition during 2010 to more accurately reflect the way the Company manages and assesses the performance of the business. During 2010, the Company sold its wholly owned trust subsidiary, discontinued a portion of its credit card services, and merged from five bank subsidiaries to three.

The re-defined structure at December 31, 2010 consists of the following segments: “Bank of Nevada”, “Western Alliance Bank”, “Torrey Pines Bank” and “Other” (Western Alliance Bancorporation holding company, Western Alliance Equipment Finance, Shine Investment Advisory Services, Inc., Premier Trust until September 1, 2010, and the discontinued operations). All prior period balances were reclassified to reflect the change in structure.

The accounting policies of the reported segments are the same as those of the Company as described in Note 1, “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies.” Transactions between segments consist primarily of borrowed funds and loan participations. Federal funds purchased and sold and other borrowed funding transactions that resulted in inter-segment profits were eliminated for reporting consolidated results of operations. Loan participations were recorded at par value with no resulting gain or loss. The Company allocated centrally provided services to the operating segments based upon estimated usage of those services.

The Company does not have a single external customer from which it derives 10 percent or more of its revenues.

The following is a summary of selected operating segment information as of and for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009:

 

                              Inter-        
                              segment     Consoli-  
     Bank     Western     Torrey            elimi-     dated  
     of Nevada     Alliance Bank     Pines Bank*     Other      nations     Company  
     (dollars in millions)  

At December 31, 2011

  

Assets

   $ 2,877.6      $ 2,234.7      $ 1,728.4      $ 762.3       $ (758.5   $ 6,844.5   

Gross loans and deferred fees, net

     1,859.1        1,644.9        1,318.9        —           (42.8     4,780.1   

Less: Allowance for credit losses

     (61.0     (21.7     (16.5     —           —          (99.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loans

     1,798.1        1,623.2        1,302.4        —           (42.8     4,680.9   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Goodwill

     23.2        —          —          2.7         —          25.9   

Deposits

     2,377.3        1,877.5        1,416.8        —           (13.1     5,658.5   

FHLB advances

     115.0        55.0        110.0        —           —          280.0   

Stockholders’ equity

     320.8        192.7        152.8        644.0         (673.6     636.7   

No. of branches

     11        16        12        —           —          39   

No. of FTE

     405        222        214        101         —          942   

 

130


Table of Contents

 

 

     (in thousands)  

Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2011:

            

Net interest income

   $ 107,316      $ 82,949      $ 76,143      $ (8,740   $ —        $ 257,668   

Provision for credit losses

     29,623        10,076        6,489        —          —          46,188   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss) after provision for credit losses

     77,693        72,873        69,654        (8,740     —          211,480   

Non-interest income

     17,221        7,378        5,085        12,781        (8,008     34,457   

Non-interest expense

     (85,813     (49,517     (41,559     (26,717     8,008        (195,598
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

     9,101        30,734        33,180        (22,676     —          50,339   

Income tax expense (benefit)

     1,626        10,890        13,676        (9,343     —          16,849   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income(loss) from continuing operations

     7,475        19,844        19,504        (13,333     —          33,490   

Loss from discontinued operations, net

     —          —          —          (1,996     —          (1,996
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 7,475      $ 19,844      $ 19,504      $ (15,329   $ —        $ 31,494   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

* Excludes discontinued operations

 

                             Inter-        
                             segment     Consoli-  
     Bank     Western     Torrey           elimi-     dated  
     of Nevada     Alliance Bank     Pines Bank*     Other     nations     Company  
                 (dollars in millions)              

At December 31, 2010:

          

Assets

   $ 2,771.4      $ 1,927.5      $ 1,452.2      $ 731.0      $ (714.2   $ 6,167.9   

Gross loans and deferred fees, net

     1,914.1        1,305.4        1,063.8        —          (42.8     4,240.5   

Less: Allowance for credit losses

     (73.5     (20.4     (16.8     —          —          (110.7
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loans

     1,840.6        1,285.0        1,047.0        —          (42.8     4,129.8   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Goodwill

     23.2        —          —          2.7        —          25.9   

Deposits

     2,388.3        1,671.1        1,281.6        —          (2.6     5,338.4   

Stockholders’ equity

     310.6        163.3        135.5        609.6        (616.8     602.2   

No. of branches

     12        16        11        —          —          39   

No. of FTE

     421        225        203        59        —          908   
     (in thousands)  

Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2010:

            

Net interest income

   $ 104,536      $ 69,223      $ 62,714      $ (3,920   $ —        $ 232,553   

Provision for credit losses

     76,669        6,374        10,168        —          —          93,211   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

     27,867        62,849        52,546        (3,920     —          139,342   

Non-interest income

     21,053        9,369        4,489        13,598        (1,673     46,836   

Noninterest expense

     (90,336     (51,270     (38,893     (17,932     1,673        (196,758
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

     (41,416     20,948        18,142        (8,254     —          (10,580

Income tax expense (benefit)

     (15,010     8,147        7,825        (7,372     —          (6,410
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income(loss) from continuing

       —             

operations

     (26,406     12,801        10,317        (882     —          (4,170

Loss from discontinued operations, net

     —          —          —          (3,025     —          (3,025
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ (26,406   $ 12,801      $ 10,317      $ (3,907   $ —        $ (7,195
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

* Excludes discontinued operations

 

131


Table of Contents

 

                             Inter-        
                             segment     Consoli-  
     Bank     Western     Torrey           elimi-     dated  
     of Nevada     Alliance Bank     Pines Bank*     Other     nations     Company  
     (in thousands)  

Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2009:

            

Net interest income

   $ 106,014      $ 52,521      $ 45,205      $ (1,451   $ —        $ 202,289   

Provision for credit losses

     104,859        30,450        13,790        0        —          149,099   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

     1,155        22,071        31,415        (1,451     —          53,190   

Non-interest income

     6,093        5,617        4,319        (7,009     (4,585     4,435   

Goodwill impairment charge

     (45,000     —          —          (4,670     —          (49,670

Noninterest expense

     (87,977     (51,832     (40,383     (17,700     4,585        (193,307
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

     (125,729     (24,144     (4,649     (30,830     —          (185,352

Income tax expense (benefit)

     (28,074     (8,542     (1,386     (451     —          (38,453
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income(loss) from continuing operations

     (97,655     (15,602     (3,263     (30,379     —          (146,899

Loss from discontinued operations, net

     —          —          —          (4,507     —          (4,507
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ (97,655   $ (15,602   $ (3,263   $ (34,886   $ —        $ (151,406
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

* Excludes discontinued operations

20. QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)

 

     December 31,  
     2011  
     Fourth     Third     Second     First  
     Quarter     Quarter     Quarter     Quarter  
     (in thousands, except per share amounts)  

Interest and dividend income

   $ 76,846      $ 74,133      $ 73,646      $ 71,966   

Interest expense

     8,147        9,548        10,360        10,868   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

     68,699        64,585        63,286        61,098   

Provision for loan losses

     13,076        11,180        11,891        10,041   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

     55,623        53,405        51,395        51,057   

Non-interest income (loss)

     4,948        13,082        9,597        6,830   

Non-interest expenses

     (50,963     (45,481     (51,008     (48,146
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

     9,608        21,006        9,984        9,741   

Income tax expense (benefit)

     2,011        7,514        3,295        4,029   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     7,597        13,492        6,689        5,712   

Loss from discontinued operations net of tax benefit

     (496     (481     (460     (559
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

     7,101        13,011        6,229        5,153   

Dividends and accretion on preferred stock

     1,781        9,419        2,503        2,503   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) available to common shareholders

   $ 5,320      $ 3,592      $ 3,726      $ 2,650   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Earnings (loss) per share:

        

Basic

   $ 0.07      $ 0.04      $ 0.05      $ 0.03   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted

   $ 0.07      $ 0.04      $ 0.05      $ 0.03   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

132


Table of Contents

 

     December 31,  
     2010  
     Fourth     Third     Second     First  
     Quarter     Quarter     Quarter     Quarter  
     (in thousands, except per share amounts)  

Interest and dividend income

   $ 72,374      $ 70,705      $ 70,000      $ 68,734   

Interest expense

     11,463        11,237        12,544        14,016   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

     60,911        59,468        57,456        54,718   

Provision for loan losses

     18,384        22,965        23,115        28,747   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

     42,527        36,503        34,341        25,971   

Non-interest income (loss)

     (720     12,167        20,760        14,629   

Non-interest expenses

     (56,545     (46,109     (53,262     (40,843
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

     (14,738     2,561        1,839        (243

Income tax expense (benefit)

     (4,580     (79     (190     (1,562
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     (10,158     2,640        2,029        1,319   

Loss from discontinued operations net of tax benefit

     (657     (631     (802     (935
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

     (10,815     2,009        1,227        384   

Dividends and accretion on preferred stock

     2,484        2,466        2,466        2,466   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) available to common shareholders

   $ (13,299   $ (457   $ (1,239   $ (2,082
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Earnings (loss) per share:

        

Basic

   $ (0.17   $ (0.01   $ (0.02   $ (0.03
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted

   $ (0.17   $ (0.01   $ (0.02   $ (0.03
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

133


Table of Contents

 

 

ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.

 

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

As of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K, an evaluation was carried out by the Company’s management, with the participation of its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e), under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Based upon that evaluation, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report. No changes were made to the Company’s internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) during the last fiscal quarter that materially affected, or are reasonably likely to affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

MANAGEMENTS REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

The management of Western Alliance Bancorporation (“the Company”) is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. The Company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of the Company’s financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

As of December 31, 2011, management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on the criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting established in “Internal Control-Integrated Framework” issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). Based on this assessment, management determined that the Company maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on those criteria.

McGladrey & Pullen, LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm that audited the consolidated financial statements of the Company included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K has issued an attestation report on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011. The report, which expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, is included herein.

 

134


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders

Western Alliance Bancorporation

We have audited Western Alliance Bancorporation’s (the Company) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Western Alliance Bancorporation’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (a) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (b) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (c) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, Western Alliance Bancorporation maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements of Western Alliance Bancorporation and our report dated March 2, 2012 expressed an unqualified opinion.

/s/ McGLADREY & PULLEN, LLP

Phoenix, Arizona

March 2, 2012

 

135


Table of Contents
ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION

Not applicable.

PART III

 

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on April 24, 2012.

The Company has adopted a Code of Conduct applicable to all of our directors and employees, including the principal executive officer, principal financial officer and principal accounting officer. A copy of the Code of Conduct is available on the Company’s website at www.westernalliancebancorp.com.

 

ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on April 24, 2012.

 

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on April 24, 2012.

 

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on April 24, 2012.

 

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

The information required by this item is incorporated by reference from the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on April 24, 2012.

 

136


Table of Contents

PART IV

 

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

(1) The following financial statements are incorporated by reference from Item 8 hereto:

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     Page 72   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010

     Page 74   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the three years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

     Page 75   

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the three years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

     Page 77   

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for the three years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

     Page 78   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the three years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

     Page 79   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     Page 81   

(2) Financial Statement Schedules

Not applicable.

On the Exhibit Index, a “±” identifies each management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement required to be filed as an exhibit to this Annual Report.

EXHIBITS

 

3.1    Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Amendment No. 1 to Western Alliance’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the SEC on June 7, 2005).
3.2    Amended and Restated By-Laws (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008).
3.3    Certificate of Designations for the Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, of Western Alliance Bancorporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 25, 2008).
3.4    Amended and Restated By-Laws (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008).
3.5    Amendment to Amended and Restated By-Laws (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 20, 2010).
3.6    Certificate of Amendment to Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of Western Alliance Bancorporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on May 3, 2010).
3.7    Certificate of Amendment to Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of Western Alliance Bancorporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 30, 2010).
3.8    Certificate of Designations for the Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B, of Western Alliance Bancorporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Western Alliance Bancorporation’s Form 8-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on September 28, 2011).

 

137


Table of Contents
3.9    Certificate of Correction to the Certificate of Designations for the Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B, of Western Alliance Bancorporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.9 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 8, 2011).
4.1    Form of common stock certificate (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Amendment No. 3 to Western Alliance’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the SEC on June 27, 2005).
4.2    Form of Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, stock certificate (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 25, 2008).
4.3    Form of Warrant to purchase shares of Western Alliance Bancorporation common stock, dated December 12, 2003, together with a schedule of warrant holders (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 to Western Alliance’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 28, 2005). ±
4.4    Warrant, dated November 21, 2008, by and between Western Alliance Bancorporation and the United States Department of the Treasury (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 25, 2008).
4.5    Senior Debt Indenture, dated August 25, 2010, between Western Alliance Bancorporation and Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, as trustee. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on August 25, 2010).
4.6    First Supplemental Indenture, dated August 25, 2010, between Western Alliance Bancorporation and Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, as trustee. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on August 25, 2010).
4.7    Form of 10.00% Senior Notes due 2015 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on August 25, 2010).
4.8    Form of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B, stock certificate.
10.5    Western Alliance Bancorporation 2005 Stock Incentive Plan, as amended (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to Western Alliance’s Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed with the SEC on March 17, 2009). ±
10.6    Form of BankWest Nevada Corporation Incentive Stock Option Plan Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to Western Alliance’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 28, 2005). ±
10.7    Form of Western Alliance Incentive Stock Option Plan Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to Western Alliance’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 28, 2005). ±
10.8    Form of Western Alliance 2002 Stock Option Plan Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to Western Alliance’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 28, 2005). ±
10.9    Form of Western Alliance 2002 Stock Option Plan Agreement (with double trigger acceleration clause) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to Western Alliance’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 28, 2005). ±
10.10    Form of Indemnification Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to Western Alliance’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 28, 2005). ±
10.11    Form of Non-Competition Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to Western Alliance’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 28, 2005). ±
10.13    Securities Purchase Agreement, dated September 29, 2008, by and among Western Alliance Bancorporation and certain other parties thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 2, 2008).
10.14    Registration Rights Agreement, dated September 29, 2008, by and among Western Alliance Bancorporation and certain other parties thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 2, 2008).

 

138


Table of Contents

 

10.15    Letter Agreement, dated November 21, 2008, between Western Alliance Bancorporation and the United States Department of the Treasury, and the Securities Purchase Agreement – Standard Terms attached thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 25, 2008).
10.17    Western Alliance Bancorporation 2009 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 10, 2009). ±
10.18    Western Alliance Bancorporation 2010 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 16, 2010). ±
10.19    Western Alliance Bancorporation 2011 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10,19 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 7, 2011). ±
10.20    Western Alliance Bancorporation 2012 Annual Bonus Plan. ±
10.22    Bank of Nevada 2009 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 10. 2009). ±
10.23    Bank of Nevada 2010 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 16, 2010). ±
10.25    Torrey Pines Bank 2009 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 10. 2009). ±
10.26    Torrey Pines Bank 2010 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 16, 2010). ±
10.27    First Independent Bank of Nevada 2009 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 10, 2009). ±
10.28    First Independent Bank of Nevada 2010 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 16, 2010). ±
10.29    Alliance Bank of Arizona 2009 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 10, 2009). ±
10.30    Alliance Bank of Arizona 2010 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 16, 2010). ±
10.31    Alta Alliance Bank 2009 Annual Bonus Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 10, 2009). ±
10.32    Alta Alliance Bank 2010 Annual Bonus Plan. ±(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 16, 2010)
10.33    Underwriting Agreement, dated May 14, 2009, by and between Western Alliance Bancorporation and Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K/A filed with the SEC on August 10, 2009).
10.34    Employment letter dated April 2, 2010, between Western Alliance Bancorporation and Kenneth Vecchione (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10 to Western Alliance’s Form 10-Q/A filed with the SEC on August 18, 2010).
10.35    Underwriting Agreement, dated August 19, 2010, by and between Western Alliance Bancorporation and Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on August 24, 2010).
10.36    Underwriting Agreement, dated August 20, 2010, by and among Western Alliance Bancorporation and Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc. and Goldman, Sachs & Co. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on August 25, 2010).

 

139


Table of Contents
10.37    Small Business Lending Fund – Securities Purchase Agreement, dated September 27, 2011, between Western Alliance Bancorporation and the Secretary of the Treasury (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 27, 2011).
10.38    Repurchase Agreement, dated September 27, 2011, between Western Alliance Bancorporation and the United States Department of the Treasury (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Western Alliance’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 27, 2011).
21.1    List of Subsidiaries of Western Alliance Bancorporation.
23.1    Consent of McGladrey & Pullen, LLP.
24.1    Power of Attorney (see signature page).
31.1    CEO Certification Pursuant Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-a4(a).
31.2    CFO Certification Pursuant Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a).
32    CEO and CFO Certification Pursuant 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002.

99.1 Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 111(b)(4) of the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008.

99.2 Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 111(b)(4) of the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008.

Stockholders may obtain copies of exhibits by writing to: Dale Gibbons, Western Alliance Bancorporation, One East Washington Street Suite 1400, Phoenix, AZ 85004.

 

140


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

    WESTERN ALLIANCE BANCORPORATION

March 2, 2012

    By:     /s/ Robert Sarver
      Robert Sarver
      Chairman of the Board and
      Chief Executive Officer

KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Robert Sarver and Dale Gibbons, and each of them, his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him or her and in his or her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in and about the premises, as fully and to all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or his or her substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed by the following persons on behalf of the registrant in their listed capacities on March 2, 2012.

 

141


Table of Contents

 

Name

  

Title

/S/     Robert Sarver        

Robert Sarver

  

Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer

(Principal Executive Officer)

/S/     Dale Gibbons        

Dale Gibbons

  

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

(Principal Financial Officer)

/S/    J. Kelly Ardrey Jr.        

J. Kelly Ardrey Jr.

  

Senior Vice President and Chief Accounting Officer

/S/    Kenneth A. Vecchione        

Kenneth A Vecchione

  

President and Chief Operating Officer

/S/    Bruce D. Beach        

Bruce D. Beach

  

Director

/S/    William S. Boyd        

William S. Boyd

  

Director

/S/    Steven J. Hilton        

Steven J. Hilton

  

Director

/S/    Marianne Boyd Johnson        

Marianne Boyd Johnson

  

Director

/S/    Cary Mack        

Cary Mack

  

Director

/S/    Todd Marshall        

Todd Marshall

  

Director

/S/    M. Nafees Nagy        

M. Nafees Nagy

  

Director

/S/    James Nave        

James Nave

  

Director

/S/    John Peter Sande III        

John Peter Sande III

  

Director

/S/    Donald D. Snyder        

Donald D. Snyder

  

Director

/S/    Sung Won Sohn        

Sung Won Sohn

  

Director

 

142